* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download emerald capital designated activity company series prospectus
United States housing bubble wikipedia , lookup
Investment fund wikipedia , lookup
Syndicated loan wikipedia , lookup
Moral hazard wikipedia , lookup
Investment management wikipedia , lookup
Federal takeover of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac wikipedia , lookup
Present value wikipedia , lookup
Shadow banking system wikipedia , lookup
Credit rationing wikipedia , lookup
Global financial system wikipedia , lookup
Interbank lending market wikipedia , lookup
Interest rate ceiling wikipedia , lookup
Global saving glut wikipedia , lookup
Interest rate swap wikipedia , lookup
Business valuation wikipedia , lookup
Systemic risk wikipedia , lookup
Securitization wikipedia , lookup
Mark-to-market accounting wikipedia , lookup
Derivative (finance) wikipedia , lookup
Dated 31 May 2017 EMERALD CAPITAL DESIGNATED ACTIVITY COMPANY (incorporated with limited liability in Ireland, and formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited) SERIES PROSPECTUS SERIES NO: 2017-02 USD 35,000,000 Fixed Rate The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Credit Linked Notes due 2026 issued pursuant to its Emerging Markets Secured Note Issuance Programme arranged by CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED The attention of investors is drawn to the section headed “Risk Factors” on page 4 of this Series Prospectus Citi This Series Prospectus, under which the Series No. 2017-02 Fixed Rate The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Credit Linked Notes due 2026 (the “Notes”) are issued, incorporates by reference, and should be read in conjunction with the Base Prospectus dated 19 August 2016 (the “Base Prospectus”) relating to the issuance by Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company (formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited) (the “Issuer”) of secured notes under the Emerging Markets Secured Note Issuance Programme (the “Programme”). Terms defined in the Base Prospectus have the same meaning in this Series Prospectus. This Series Prospectus has been approved by the Central Bank of Ireland (the “Central Bank”), as competent authority under Directive 2003/71/EC (as amended) (the “Prospectus Directive”). The Central Bank only approves this Series Prospectus as meeting the requirements imposed under Irish and EU law pursuant to the Prospectus Directive. This Series Prospectus constitutes a “prospectus” for the purposes of Regulation 13 of the Prospectus (Directive 2003/71/EC) Regulations 2005 and Article 5 of the Prospectus Directive and for the purpose of giving information with regard to the Issuer which is necessary to enable investors to make an informed assessment of the assets and liabilities, financial position, profit and losses and prospects of the Issuer. Application has been made to the Irish Stock Exchange for the Notes to be admitted to the Official List and to trading on its Main Securities Market. This Series Prospectus is to be read in conjunction with all documents which are deemed to be incorporated herein by reference. The Notes are cash-settled credit linked notes. In connection with the Notes, the Issuer has entered into a swap confirmation (the “Credit Default Swap Confirmation”) documenting a credit default swap transaction referencing a Reference Entity (the “Credit Default Swap”) and a swap confirmation (the “Asset Swap Confirmation” and together with the Credit Default Swap Confirmation, the “Swap Confirmations”) documenting an asset swap transaction (the “Asset Swap”) under the ISDA Master Agreement including the Schedule (as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) in the form of the Swap Terms (August 2016 Version) relating to the Programme (as such Schedule may have been amended by the Swap Confirmations) (the ISDA Master Agreement, the Schedule thereto and the Swap Confirmations together, the “Swap Agreement”) with Citigroup Global Markets Limited (“CGML”, in such capacity, the “Swap Counterparty”). The Forms of the Swap Confirmations in relation to the Credit Default Swap and the Asset Swap are as set out in Annexes 4 and 5 hereto. The Scheduled Maturity Date of the Notes is expected to fall on or around 22 June 2026. However, the actual maturity date of the Notes may be extended beyond the Scheduled Maturity Date in certain circumstances where the Swap Counterparty determines that a Credit Event or related events have occurred or may occur on or prior to the Scheduled Maturity Date and delivers a Potential Credit Event Notice or where the Termination Date of the Credit Default Swap falls after the Scheduled Termination Date of the Credit Default Swap. Noteholders will not receive any additional amounts in respect of any such postponement. See paragraph 39 of the Terms and Conditions of the Notes below. Capitalised terms used but not otherwise defined herein or in the Base Prospectus have the meaning given to them in Annex 1 and, if not defined in Annex 1, such terms shall have the meaning given to them in the Swap Agreement. The Annexes to this Series Prospectus form part of, and should be read together with, this Series Prospectus. Investors are advised to refer to the forms of the Credit Default Swap Confirmation and Asset Swap Confirmation attached as Annexes 4 and 5, respectively. The delivery of this Series Prospectus at any time does not imply that any information contained herein is correct at any time subsequent to the date hereof. The Issuer accepts responsibility for the information contained in this Series Prospectus. To the best of the knowledge and belief of the Issuer (which has taken all reasonable care to ensure that 1 such is the case) the information contained in this Series Prospectus is in accordance with the facts and does not omit anything likely to affect the import of such information. No person has been authorised to give any information or to make any representation other than those contained in this Series Prospectus in connection with the issue and sale of the Notes and, if given or made, such information or representation must not be relied upon as having been authorised by the Issuer or CGML (in such capacity, the “Dealer”). The net proceeds of this issue were USD 35,000,000, which were applied by the Issuer to purchase the Initial Collateral on the Issue Date. The Notes have not been and will not be registered under the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), no person has registered nor will register as a commodity pool operator of the Issuer under the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act of 1936, as amended (the “CEA”), and the rules of the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission thereunder, and the Notes may not be offered, sold, pledged or otherwise transferred within the United States or to, or for the account or benefit of, any person who is (i) a U.S. person (as such term is defined under Rule 902(k)(1) of Regulation S under the Securities Act), (ii) not a Non-United States person (as defined in Rule 4.7 under the CEA, but excluding, for the purposes of subsection (D) thereof, the exception to the extent that it would apply to persons who are not Non-United States persons) or (iii) a U.S. person (as defined in the credit risk retention regulations issued under Section 15G of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934). For a description of certain further restrictions on offers and sales of Notes and distribution of the Base Prospectus and the Series Prospectus, see “Subscription and Sale and Transfer Restrictions” in the Base Prospectus. If the Issuer is deemed to be a covered fund, then, in the absence of regulatory relief, the provisions of the Volcker Rule and its related regulatory provisions will impact the ability of U.S. banking institutions to hold an ownership interest in the Issuer or enter financial transactions with the Issuer. Investors are required to independently consider the potential impact of the Volcker Rule in respect of any investment in the Notes. See “Risk Factors – U.S. Regulatory considerations – Risks relating to U.S. Volcker Rule” below. This Series Prospectus does not constitute, and may not be used for the purposes of, an offer or solicitation by anyone in any jurisdiction in which such offer or solicitation is not authorised or to any person to whom it is unlawful to make such offer or solicitation, and no action is being taken to permit an offering of the Notes or the distribution of this Series Prospectus in any jurisdiction where such action is required. The credit ratings included or referred to in the Series Prospectus have been either issued or endorsed by Moody’s Investors Service Limited (“Moody’s”), Standard & Poor’s Credit Market Services Europe Limited (“S&P”) and Fitch Ratings Limited (“Fitch”) unless otherwise stated. Moody’s, S&P and Fitch are established in the European Union and registered under Regulation (EC) 1060/2009 on credit rating agencies. A rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and may be subject to revision, suspension or withdrawal at any time by the assigning rating agency. In this Series Prospectus, references to “EUR” are to the single currency adopted and retained by certain member states of the European Community pursuant to the Treaty establishing the European Community, as amended by the Treaty on European Union, and references to “USD” are to United States Dollars. 2 TABLE OF CONTENTS RISK FACTORS ................................................................................................................................ 4 INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE ............................................................................................. 29 TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE NOTES ................................................................................ 30 Annex 1 Defined Terms ................................................................................................................... 47 Annex 2 Security and Collateral ...................................................................................................... 49 Annex 3 The Swap Agreement ........................................................................................................ 52 Annex 4 Form of the Credit Default Swap Confirmation ................................................................. 57 Annex 5 Form of the Asset Swap Confirmation .............................................................................. 68 Annex 6 Description of the Issuer ................................................................................................... 74 DESCRIPTION OF THE SWAP COUNTERPARTY........................................................................ 76 SUBSCRIPTION AND SALE AND TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS .................................................. 77 GENERAL INFORMATION ............................................................................................................. 79 3 RISK FACTORS THE CONSIDERATIONS SET OUT BELOW ARE NOT, AND ARE NOT INTENDED TO BE, A COMPREHENSIVE LIST OF ALL CONSIDERATIONS RELEVANT TO A DECISION TO PURCHASE OR HOLD ANY NOTES. PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD ALSO READ THE BASE PROSPECTUS, THE RISK FACTORS SET OUT THEREIN AND THE DETAILED INFORMATION SET OUT ELSEWHERE IN THIS SERIES PROSPECTUS. The Issuer believes that the following factors may affect its ability to fulfil its obligations under the Notes issued under the Programme. The Issuer is not in a position to express a view on the likelihood of any contingency highlighted by a risk factor occurring. Factors which the Issuer believes may be material for the purpose of assessing the market risks associated with Notes issued under the Programme are also described below. The Issuer believes that the factors described below represent the principal risks inherent in investing in Notes issued under the Programme, but the inability of the Issuer to pay interest, principal or other amounts on or in connection with the Notes may occur for other reasons and the Issuer does not represent that the statements below regarding the risks of holding the Notes are exhaustive. Prospective investors should also read the detailed information set out elsewhere in this Series Prospectus (including any documents incorporated by reference herein) and reach their own views prior to making any investment decision. This Series Prospectus, read together with the information incorporated herein, identifies in general terms certain information that a prospective investor should consider prior to making an investment in the Notes. However, a prospective investor should, without any reliance on Citigroup Global Markets Limited or its affiliates, conduct its own thorough analysis (including its own accounting, legal and tax analysis) prior to deciding whether to invest in the Notes as any evaluation of the suitability for an investor of an investment in the Notes depends upon a prospective investor’s particular financial and other circumstances, as well as on the specific terms of the Notes and, if it does not have experience in financial, business and investment matters sufficient to permit it to make such a determination, it should consult with its financial adviser prior to deciding to make an investment on the suitability of the Notes. This Series Prospectus is not, and does not purport to be, investment advice, and neither the Issuer nor Citigroup Global Markets Limited makes any recommendation as to the suitability of the Notes. The provision of this Series Prospectus to prospective investors is not based on any prospective investor’s individual circumstances and should not be relied upon as an assessment of suitability for any prospective investor of the Notes. Even if the Issuer or Citigroup Global Markets Limited possesses limited information as to the objectives of any prospective investor in relation to any transaction, series of transactions or trading strategy, this will not be deemed sufficient for any assessment of suitability for such person of the Notes. Any trading or investment decisions a prospective investor takes are in reliance on its own analysis and judgement and/or that of its advisers and not in reliance on the Issuer, Citigroup Global Markets Limited or any of their respective affiliates. In particular, each prospective investor in the Notes must determine, based on its own independent review and such professional advice as it deems appropriate under the circumstances, that its acquisition of the Notes (i) is fully consistent with its (or, if it is acquiring the Notes in a fiduciary capacity, the beneficiary’s) financial needs, objectives and condition, (ii) complies and is fully consistent with all investment policies, guidelines and restrictions applicable to it (whether acquiring the Notes as principal or in a fiduciary capacity) and (iii) is a fit, proper and 4 suitable investment for it (or, if it is acquiring the Notes in a fiduciary capacity, for the beneficiary), notwithstanding the clear and substantial risks inherent in investing in or holding the Notes. The Notes The Notes are complex instruments that involve substantial risks and are suitable only for sophisticated investors who have sufficient knowledge and experience and access to such professional advisers as they shall consider necessary in order to make their own evaluation of the risks and the merits of such an investment (including without limitation the tax, accounting, credit, legal, regulatory and financial implications for them of such an investment) and who have considered the suitability of such Notes in light of their own circumstances and financial condition. Prospective investors should ensure that they understand the nature of the risks posed by an investment in the Notes, and the extent of their exposure as a result of such investment in the Notes and, before making their investment decision, should consider carefully all of the information set forth in the Base Prospectus and, in particular, the considerations set forth below and in this Series Prospectus. Owing to the structured nature of the Notes, their price may be more volatile than that of unstructured securities. Investors Each prospective investor in the Notes should have sufficient financial resources and liquidity to bear all of the risks of an investment in the Notes, including where principal and interest may reduce as a result of the occurrence of different events whether related to the creditworthiness of any entity or otherwise or changes in particular rates, prices or indices, or where the currency for principal or interest payments is different from the prospective investor’s currency. Investment activities of certain investors are subject to investment laws and regulations, or review or regulation by certain authorities. Each prospective investor should therefore consult its professional advisers to determine whether and to what extent (i) the Notes are legal investments for it, and/or (ii) other restrictions apply to its purchase or, if relevant, pledge of any Notes. Financial institutions should consult their professional advisers or the appropriate regulators to determine the appropriate treatment of the Notes under any applicable risk-based capital or similar rules. No fiduciary role None of the Issuer, the Arranger, the Dealer, the Custodian, the Trustee, the Agents or the Swap Counterparty (excluding the Issuer, the “Transaction Parties”) or any of their respective affiliates is acting as an investment adviser, and none of them (other than the Trustee) assumes any fiduciary obligation to any purchaser of Notes or any other party, including the Issuer. None of the Issuer, the Transaction Parties, or any of their respective affiliates assumes any responsibility for conducting or failing to conduct any investigation into the business, financial condition, prospects, creditworthiness, status and/or affairs of any issuer of any Collateral or the terms thereof or (except in the case of the Swap Counterparty) the Swap Counterparty. Investors may not rely on the views or advice of the Issuer or the Transaction Parties for any information in relation to any person other than such Issuer or such Transaction Party. No reliance A prospective purchaser may not rely on the Issuer or the Transaction Parties or any of their respective affiliates in connection with its determination as to the legality of its acquisition of the Notes or as to the other matters referred to above. 5 No representations None of the Issuer, the Transaction Parties or any of their respective affiliates in respect of the Notes makes any representation or warranty, express or implied, in respect of any Collateral or any issuer of any Collateral or (except in the case of the Swap Counterparty) of the Swap Counterparty or in respect of the Swap Agreement or in respect of any information contained in any documents prepared, provided or filed by or on behalf of any such issuer or in respect of such Collateral or (except in the case of the Swap Counterparty) of the Swap Counterparty or in respect of the Swap Agreement with any exchange, governmental, supervisory or self regulatory authority or any other person. Risk Factors relating to the Issuer The Issuer is a special purpose vehicle The Issuer’s sole business is the raising of money by issuing notes or other obligations for the purposes of purchasing assets and entering into related derivatives and other contracts. The Issuer has covenanted not to, as long as any of the Notes (if any) remain outstanding, without the consent of the Trustee, have any subsidiaries or employees, purchase, own, lease or otherwise acquire any real property (including office premises or like facilities), consolidate or merge with any other person, declare any dividends or issue any shares (other than such shares as were in issue on the date of its incorporation). As such, the Issuer has, and will have, no assets other than its issued and paid-up share capital, such fees (as agreed) payable to it in connection with the issue of Notes or entry into other obligations from time to time and any Mortgaged Property and any other assets on which Notes or other obligations are secured. There is no day-to-day management of the business of the Issuer. Regulation of the Issuer by any regulatory authority The Issuer is not required to be licensed, registered or authorised under any current securities, commodities, insurance or banking laws or regulations of its jurisdiction of incorporation. There is no assurance, however, that in the future such regulatory authorities would not take a contrary view regarding the applicability of any such laws or regulations to the Issuer. There is also no assurance that the regulatory authorities in other jurisdictions would not require the Issuer to be licensed or authorised under any securities, commodities, insurance or banking laws or regulations of those jurisdictions. Any requirement to be licensed or authorised could have an adverse effect on the Issuer and on the holders of the Notes. Preferred creditors under Irish law Under Irish law, upon an insolvency of an Irish company such as the Issuer, when applying the proceeds of assets subject to fixed security that may have been realised in the course of a liquidation or receivership, the claims of a limited category of preferential creditors will take priority over the claims of creditors holding the relevant fixed security. These preferred claims include the remuneration, costs and expenses properly incurred by any examiner of the company (that may include any borrowings made by an examiner to fund the company’s requirements for the duration of his appointment) that have been approved by the Irish courts (see “Examinership” below). The holder of a fixed security over the book debts of an Irish tax resident company (that would include the Issuer) may be required by the Irish Revenue Commissioners, by notice in writing from the Irish Revenue Commissioners, to pay to them sums equivalent to those that the holder received in payment of debts due to it by the company. 6 Where notice has been given to the Irish Revenue Commissioners of the creation of the security within 21 calendar days of its creation by the holder of the security, the holder’s liability is limited to the amount of certain outstanding Irish tax liabilities of the company (including liabilities in respect of value added tax) arising after the issuance of the Irish Revenue Commissioners’ notice to the holder of fixed security. The Irish Revenue Commissioners may also attach any debt due to an Irish tax resident company by another person in order to discharge any liabilities of the company in respect of outstanding tax, whether the liabilities are due on its own account or as an agent or trustee. The scope of this right of the Irish Revenue Commissioners has not yet been considered by the Irish courts and it may override the rights of holders of security (whether fixed or floating) over the debt in question. In relation to the disposal of assets of any Irish tax resident company that are subject to security, a person entitled to the benefit of the security may be liable for tax in relation to any capital gains made by the company on a disposal of those assets on exercise of the security. The essence of a fixed charge is that the chargor does not have liberty to deal with the assets that are the subject matter of the security in the sense of disposing of such assets or expending or appropriating the moneys or claims constituting such assets and accordingly, if and to the extent that such liberty is given to the Issuer, any charge constituted by the Trust Deed may operate as a floating, rather than a fixed charge. In particular, the Irish courts have held that in order to create a fixed charge on receivables, it is necessary to oblige the chargor to pay the proceeds of collection of the receivables into a designated bank account and to prohibit the chargor from withdrawing or otherwise dealing with the moneys standing to the credit of such account without the consent of the chargee. Depending upon the level of control actually exercised by the chargor, there is therefore a possibility that the fixed security purported to be created by the Trust Deed would be regarded by the Irish courts as a floating charge. Floating charges have certain weaknesses, including the following: (a) they have weak priority against purchasers (who are not on notice of any negative pledge contained in the floating charge) and the chargees of the assets concerned and against lien holders, execution creditors and creditors with rights of set-off; (b) as discussed above, they rank after certain preferential creditors, such as claims of employees and certain taxes on winding-up; (c) they rank after certain insolvency remuneration expenses and liabilities; (d) the examiner of a company has certain rights to deal with the property covered by the floating charge; and (e) they rank after fixed charges. Examinership Examinership is a court procedure available under the Irish Companies Act, 2014 (as amended) to facilitate the survival of Irish companies in financial difficulties. The Issuer, the directors of the Issuer, a contingent, prospective or actual creditor of the Issuer, or shareholders of the Issuer holding, at the date of presentation of the petition, not less than onetenth of the voting share capital of the Issuer, are each entitled to petition either (i) the appropriate Irish Circuit Court or (ii) the High Court of Ireland (each an “Irish Court”) for the appointment of an 7 examiner. The examiner, once appointed, has the power to set aside contracts and arrangements entered into by the company after his appointment and, in certain circumstances, can avoid a negative pledge given by the company prior to his appointment. Furthermore, he may sell assets which are the subject of a fixed charge. However, if such power is exercised, he must account to the holders of the fixed charge for the amount realised and discharge the amount due to them out of the proceeds of sale. During the period of protection, the examiner will formulate proposals for a compromise or scheme of arrangement to assist the survival of the company or the whole or any part of its undertaking as a going concern. A scheme of arrangement may be approved by the relevant Irish Court when at least one class of creditors has voted in favour of the proposals and the relevant Irish Court is satisfied that such proposals are fair and equitable in relation to any class of members or creditors who have not accepted the proposals and whose interests would be impaired by the implementation of the scheme of arrangement. In considering proposals by the examiner, it is likely that secured and unsecured creditors would form separate classes of creditors. In the case of the Issuer, if the Trustee represented the majority in number and value of claims within the secured creditor class (which would be likely given the restrictions agreed to by the Issuer in the Conditions), the Trustee would be in a position to reject any proposal not in favour of the Noteholders. The Trustee would also be entitled to argue at the relevant Irish Court hearing at which the proposed scheme of arrangement is considered that the proposals are unfair and inequitable in relation to the Noteholders, especially if such proposals include a writing down of the value of amounts due by the Issuer to the Noteholders. The primary risks to the holders of Notes if an examiner were to be appointed in respect of the Issuer are as follows: (i) the potential for a scheme of arrangement to be approved involving the writing down of the debt owed by the Issuer to the Noteholders as secured by the Trust Deed; (ii) the potential for the examiner to seek to set aside any negative pledge in the Notes prohibiting the creation of security or the incurring of borrowings by the Issuer to enable the examiner to borrow to fund the Issuer during the protection period; and (iii) in the event that a scheme of arrangement is not approved and the Issuer subsequently goes into liquidation, the examiner’s remuneration and expenses (including certain borrowings incurred by the examiner on behalf of the Issuer and approved by the relevant Irish Court) will take priority over the moneys and liabilities which from time to time are or may become due, owing or payable by the Issuer to each of the secured creditors under the Notes or under any other secured obligations. Anti-money laundering The Issuer may be subject to anti-money laundering legislation in its jurisdiction of incorporation. If the Issuer were determined by the relevant authorities to be in violation of any such legislation, it could become subject to substantial criminal penalties. Any such violation could materially and adversely affect the timing and amount of payments made by the Issuer to Noteholders in respect of the Issuer’s Notes. Risk Factors relating to the Notes Limited recourse obligations The Notes are direct, secured, limited recourse obligations of the Issuer payable solely out of the Mortgaged Property by the Issuer in favour of the Trustee on behalf of the Noteholders and other 8 secured parties. The Issuer will have no other assets or sources of revenue available for payment of any of its obligations under the Notes. No assurance can be made that the proceeds available for and allocated to the repayment of the Notes at any particular time will be sufficient to cover all amounts that would otherwise be due and payable in respect of the Notes. If the proceeds of the realisation of the Security (as defined in the Conditions) received by the Trustee for the benefit of the Noteholders prove insufficient to make payments on the Notes, no other assets will be available for payment of the deficiency, and, following distribution of the proceeds of such realisation, the Issuer will have no further obligation to pay any amounts in respect of such deficiency. Further, none of the Noteholders nor any other secured party will be entitled at any time to proceed against the Issuer unless the Trustee having become bound to proceed fails or neglects to do so. No person other than the Issuer will be obliged to make payments on the Notes. Trustee indemnity In certain circumstances, the Noteholders may be dependent on the Trustee to take certain actions in respect of the Notes, in particular if the Security in respect of the Notes becomes enforceable under the Conditions. Prior to taking such action, the Trustee may require to be indemnified to its satisfaction. If the Trustee is not satisfied with its indemnity it may decide not to take such action, without being in breach of its obligations under the Trust Deed. Consequently, the Noteholders may have to either arrange for such indemnity or accept the consequences of such inaction by the Trustee. Noteholders should be prepared to bear the costs associated with any such indemnity and/or the consequences of any such inaction by the Trustee. Such inaction by the Trustee will not entitle Noteholders to proceed themselves directly against the Issuer. Priority of claims The priority of the claims of the Swap Counterparty and the Noteholders over the Mortgaged Property shall depend on the particular circumstances in which the Notes are to be redeemed or in which the security in respect of the Notes has become enforceable. Such priority of claims will only be determined at the relevant time. If the Notes are redeemed early as a result of the occurrence of a Swap Counterparty Default (as defined in this Series Prospectus), the claims of the Noteholders rank prior to claims of the Swap Counterparty. If the Notes are being redeemed in other circumstances or the security in respect of the Notes has become enforceable for any other reason, the claims of the Swap Counterparty will rank prior to claims of the Noteholders. In either scenario, the claims of the Trustee for its fees and expenses rank senior to the claims of the Noteholders and the Swap Counterparty. Noteholders should understand that the validity and enforceability of provisions such as paragraph 72(b) of the Terms and Conditions of the Notes below which determine the priority of payments upon the occurrence of one or more specified trigger events (sometimes called “flip clauses”) have been the subject of challenge in the English and U.S. courts on the basis that where the trigger event is a creditor insolvency (such as the insolvency of the Swap Counterparty), the flip clause breaches principles of English and U.S. insolvency law. The Supreme Court of the United Kingdom in Belmont Park Investments PTY Ltd v BNY Corporate Trustee Services Ltd [2011] UKSC 38 dismissed this argument and upheld the validity of a flip clause contained in an English-law governed contract. By contrast, the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York in Lehman Brothers Special Financing Inc. v. BNY Corporate Trustee Services Limited. (In re Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc.), Adv. Pro. No. 09-1242-JMP (Bankr. S.D.N.Y. May 20, 2009) and Lehman Bros. 9 Special Fin. Inc. v. Ballyrock ABS CDO 2007-1 Ltd. (In re Lehman Bros. Holdings Inc.), 452 B.R. 31 (Bankr. S.D.N.Y. 2011) (JMP). previously held that such a provision, which seeks to modify one creditor’s position in a priority of payments when that creditor files for bankruptcy, is unenforceable under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. However, in the recent case of Lehman Brothers Special Financing Inc. v. Bank of America National Association (2016 WL 3621180 (Bankr. S.D.N.Y. June 28, 2016), the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York has upheld the validity of a provision similar to that contained in paragraph 72(b) of the Terms and Conditions of the Notes. It is possible that further cases in respect of similar provisions may be heard in the future that may change this position. If the Swap Counterparty was ever the subject of U.S. bankruptcy proceedings at a time when these provisions were likely to be held to be unenforceable under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, it is possible, notwithstanding the validity of flip clauses as a matter of English law, that the Issuer would be required to pay the Swap Counterparty in priority to the Noteholders and as a result, the Issuer might not have sufficient funds to repay the Noteholders in full. No gross-up on payments under Notes or Swap Agreement In the event that any withholding tax or deduction for tax is imposed on payments on the Notes or payments by the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer under the Swap Agreement (except in the latter case where the tax is an “Indemnifiable Tax” pursuant to the Swap Agreement), the Noteholders will not be entitled to receive grossed-up amounts to compensate for such withholding tax nor be reimbursed for the amount of any shortfall and no Event of Default (as defined in the Conditions) shall occur as a result of any such withholding or deduction (but see “Early redemption for tax or other reasons” below). Early redemption for tax or other reasons The Issuer shall redeem the Notes earlier than the Maturity Date if either (a) specified tax or other reasons shall occur, as detailed in Condition 7.3 of the Terms and Conditions of the Notes (as modified below) or (b) any illegality, as detailed in Condition 7.12 (but see “Risk Factors relating to the Swap Counterparty and the Swap Agreement” below for a description of how such redemption is effected where it results from termination of the Swap Agreement). If the Issuer is required to redeem the Notes early, the Issuer will redeem the Notes at their Early Redemption Amount as specified in the Conditions. Such Early Redemption Amount is not principally protected and will be, equal to the sale proceeds from the disposal of the Collateral, plus (if due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) or minus (if due from the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty) the Swap Termination Value, minus the Unwind Costs, as detailed in the Conditions. Cash held by Custodian as banker not as trustee Any cash held in an account with the Custodian (including any cash held in the Cash Account, as defined in the Custody Agreement) will be held by the Custodian as banker and not as trustee. Any such cash will therefore not be held as client money in accordance with any client money rules. As a result, if the Custodian becomes insolvent, the Issuer will only have an unsecured claim against the Custodian’s estate in respect of any such cash. If the Issuer is unable to recover such cash in full from the Custodian’s estate, it may not have sufficient proceeds to redeem the Notes in full and the amount paid to Noteholders may be significantly less than the Noteholders’ original investment and may be zero. Modification, waivers and substitution The Conditions contain provisions for calling meetings of Noteholders to consider matters affecting their interests generally. These provisions permit defined majorities to bind all Noteholders of the 10 Notes, including Noteholders who did not attend and vote at the relevant meeting and Noteholders who voted in a manner contrary to the majority. The conditions of the Notes also provide that the Trustee may, without the consent of Noteholders, agree to (i) any modification of any of the Conditions or any of the provisions of the Trust Deed or the Swap Agreement that is, in its opinion, of a formal, minor or technical nature or is made to correct a manifest error, (ii) any other modification (except as mentioned in the Trust Deed) and any waiver or authorisation of any breach or proposed breach of any of the Conditions or any provisions of the Trust Deed or the Swap Agreement that are in the opinion of the Trustee not materially prejudicial to the interest of the Noteholders or (iii) the substitution of another company as principal debtor under any Notes in place of the Issuer. Market value of Notes The market value of the Notes will be affected by a number of factors, including, but not limited to (i) the value and volatility of the Initial Collateral and the creditworthiness of the issuer of the Initial Collateral, (ii) the value and volatility of obligations issued by the Reference Entity, and the creditworthiness of the Reference Entity, (iii) market perception, interest rates, yields and foreign exchange rates, (iv) the time remaining to the maturity date and (v) the nature and liquidity of the Swap Agreement. Any price at which Notes may be sold prior to the maturity date may be at a discount, which could be substantial, to the value at which the Notes were acquired on the issue date. Prospective purchasers should be aware that not all market participants would determine prices in respect of the Notes in the same manner, and the variation between such prices may be substantial. Accordingly, any prices provided by a dealer may not be representative of prices that may be provided by other market participants. For this reason, any price provided or quoted by a dealer should not be viewed or relied upon by prospective purchasers as establishing, or constituting advice by that dealer concerning, a mark-to-market value of the Notes. The price (if any) provided by a dealer is at the absolute discretion of that dealer and may be determined by reference to such factors as it sees fit. Any such price may take into account fees, commissions or arrangements entered into by that dealer with a third party in respect of the Notes and that dealer shall have no obligation to any Noteholder to disclose such arrangements. Any price given would be prepared as of a particular date and time and would not therefore reflect subsequent changes in market values or any other factors relevant to the determination of the price. Change of law The Conditions of the Notes, and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with them, are governed by and construed in accordance with English law in effect as at the Issue Date. No assurance can be given as to the impact of any possible judicial decision or change to English law or administrative practice after the Issue Date. Provision of information None of the Issuer, the Transaction Parties or any affiliate of such persons makes any representation as to the credit quality of the Collateral. Any of such persons may have acquired, or during the term of the Notes may acquire, non-public information with respect to the Collateral. None of such persons is under any obligation to make such information directly available to Noteholders. None of such persons is under any obligation to make available any information relating to, or keep under review on the Noteholders’ behalf, the business, financial conditions, prospects, creditworthiness or state of affairs of the Collateral or conduct any investigation or due diligence into the Collateral. 11 Non-registration under the Securities Act and restrictions on transfer The Notes have not been, and will not be, registered under the Securities Act or with any securities regulatory authority of any state or other jurisdiction of the United States. The Notes are being issued and sold in reliance upon exemptions from registration provided by such laws. Consequently, the transfer of the Notes will be subject to satisfaction of legal requirements applicable to transfers that do not require registration under the Securities Act or with any securities regulatory authority of any state or other jurisdiction of the United States. In addition, the Notes are subject to certain transfer restrictions as described under “Subscription and Sale and Transfer Restrictions” in the Base Prospectus, which may further limit the liquidity of the Notes. Foreign Account Tax Compliance Withholding Pursuant to certain provisions of U.S. law, commonly known as FATCA, a withholding tax is imposed on (i) certain U.S. source payments (including ”dividend equivalent” payments), (ii) beginning 1 January 2019, payments of gross proceeds from the disposition of assets that can produce U.S. source interest or dividends (including “dividend equivalent” payments) and (iii) beginning 1 January 2019 (at the earliest), certain payments made by “foreign financial institutions” (“foreign passthru payments”). This withholding tax is imposed on such payments made to persons that fail to meet certain certification, reporting or related requirements. The Issuer expects to be treated as a foreign financial institution for these purposes. A number of jurisdictions (including Ireland) have entered into, or have agreed in substance to, intergovernmental agreements with the United States to implement FATCA (“IGAs”), which modify the way in which FATCA applies in their jurisdictions. Certain aspects of the application of FATCA to instruments or agreements such as the Collateral, the Swap Agreement and the Notes, including whether withholding on foreign passthru payments would ever be required pursuant to FATCA or an IGA with respect to payments on instruments or agreements such as the Collateral, the Swap Agreement and/or the Notes, are uncertain and may be subject to change. Even if withholding would be required with respect to foreign passthru payments or payments of gross proceeds from the disposition of an asset that can produce U.S. source interest or dividends pursuant to FATCA or an IGA, such withholding would not apply prior to 1 January 2019. Additionally, an obligation that has a fixed term and is not treated as equity for U.S. federal income tax purposes generally will be “grandfathered” for purposes of FATCA withholding (i) in respect of foreign passthru payments, if entered into on or prior to the date that is six months after the date on which final regulations defining foreign passthru payments are filed with the U.S. Federal Register, and (ii) if the obligation is subject to FATCA withholding solely because the obligation is treated as giving rise to “dividend equivalent” payments, if outstanding at any point prior to six months after the date on which obligations of its type are first treated as giving rise to “dividend equivalent” payments, in each case, unless the obligation is materially modified after such grandfathering date. Possible impact on Payments on the Collateral or under the Swap Agreement If the Issuer fails to comply with its obligations under FATCA (including the IGA entered into between Ireland and the United States (the “Ireland IGA”) and any Irish local law implementing the Ireland IGA), it may be subject to FATCA withholding on all, or a portion of, payments it receives with respect to the Collateral or under the Swap Agreement. Any such withholding would, in turn, result in the Issuer having insufficient funds from which to make payments that would otherwise have become due in respect of the Notes and/or the Swap Agreement. No other funds will be available to the Issuer to make up any such shortfall and, as a result, the Issuer may not have sufficient funds to satisfy its payment obligations to Noteholders. Additionally, if payments to the 12 Issuer in respect of its assets are or will become subject to FATCA withholding, the Notes may be subject to early redemption. No assurance can be given that the Issuer can or will comply with its obligations under FATCA or that the Issuer will not be subject to FATCA withholding. Impact on Payments on the Notes Under the Ireland IGA (and Irish local law implementing the Ireland IGA) as currently in effect, an Irish foreign financial institution, would generally not be required to withhold under FATCA or the IGA from payments that it makes. However, the treatment of foreign passthru payments made by foreign financial institutions in IGA jurisdictions has not been agreed and it is possible that the Issuer could be required to withhold amounts from Noteholders that are foreign financial institutions that are not compliant with, or exempt from, FATCA or Noteholders that do not provide the information, documentation or certifications required for the Issuer to comply with its obligations under FATCA. Neither a Noteholder or beneficial owner of Notes will be entitled to any additional amounts in the event FATCA withholding tax is imposed on any payments on or with respect to the Notes. As a result, Noteholders may receive less interest or principal, as applicable, than expected. FATCA IS PARTICULARLY COMPLEX AND ITS APPLICATION TO THE ISSUER, THE NOTES, THE NOTEHOLDERS, AND THE SWAP AGREEMENT IS SUBJECT TO CHANGE. EACH NOTEHOLDER SHOULD CONSULT ITS OWN TAX ADVISER TO OBTAIN A MORE DETAILED EXPLANATION OF FATCA AND TO LEARN HOW IT MIGHT AFFECT EACH HOLDER IN ITS PARTICULAR CIRCUMSTANCE. Legality of purchase None of the Issuer, the Trustee, CGML or any affiliate of such persons has or assumes responsibility for the lawfulness of the acquisition of the Notes by a prospective purchaser of the Notes (whether for its own account or for the account of any third party), whether under the laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or the jurisdiction in which it operates (if different), or for compliance by that prospective purchaser (or any such third party) with any law, regulation or regulatory policy applicable to it. Suspension of payments upon a Sanctions Event Noteholders may be exposed to the risk that any Note, Noteholder, the Issuer, the Collateral, the Trustee, the Issuing and Paying Agent, the Dealer and/or any other entity involved in the Notes is subject to a Sanction that results in a Sanctions Event, causing payments under the Notes to that Noteholder to be suspended. Prospective investors should note that, during the existence of a Sanctions Event, Noteholders will have no right to take any action to compel the Trustee or the Issuer to take any action or enforce the Collateral and that the Calculation Agent has broad discretion to determine the amounts (if any) due to Noteholders following the occurrence of a Sanctions Event. Risk Factors relating to the Credit Linked Notes Capitalised terms used in this section of the Risk Factors (“Risk Factors relating to the Credit Linked Notes”) but not otherwise defined in this Series Prospectus or in the Base Prospectus shall have the meaning given to them in the Swap Agreement. Limited information about the Reference Entity and the Obligations thereof Investors in the Notes will be exposed to the credit risk of the Reference Entity and the Obligations thereof (each as defined herein) as that affects the amount that the Issuer will pay the Swap 13 Counterparty under the Credit Default Swap. None of the Issuer, CGML, the Trustee or any other person on their behalf makes any representation or warranty, express or implied, as to the credit quality of the Reference Entity or the Obligations thereof. CGML may have acquired, or during the term of the Notes may acquire, confidential information with respect to the Reference Entity or the Obligations thereof and is not required to disclose this information to the Issuer or any other party. Risk Factors relating to the Credit Default Swap The Reference Entity (as defined herein) is, as at the Issue Date, set out in Annex 4 (Form of the Credit Default Swap Confirmation). As at the Issue Date, the Reference Entity is The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. Determination of Credit Events Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees were originally established pursuant to the March 2009 Supplement to the 2003 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions published by ISDA to make determinations that are relevant to the majority of the credit derivatives market and to promote transparency and consistency. The Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees continue to perform this role under the 2014 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions published by ISDA (the “2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions”). Further information about the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees may be found at http://dc.isda.org (or any successor website). Noteholders should carefully monitor the matters under consideration by such committees and their determinations. In making any determination in its capacity as Calculation Agent under the Swap Agreement, CGML and its affiliates may, but are not obliged to, have regard to decisions made by announcements, determinations and resolutions made by ISDA and/or the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees. Such announcements, determinations and resolutions could affect the redemption and settlement of Notes (including the quantum and timing of payments and/or deliveries on redemption). CGML and its affiliates may act as a voting member on a Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee and consequently may take certain actions which may influence the process and outcome of decisions relating to the Reference Entity, which could be adverse to the interests of the Noteholders. For the avoidance of doubt, neither the Issuer nor the Calculation Agent nor the Swap Counterparty will be liable to any person for any determination, redemption, calculation and/or delay or suspension of payments and/or redemption of the Notes resulting from or relating to any announcements, publications, determinations and resolutions made by ISDA and/or any Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee. Noteholders should be aware that redemption and settlement of the Notes may be postponed following public announcement by ISDA that a DC Resolution (as defined in the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions) will be passed by the relevant Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee. The relevant Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee may resolve (i) that an event that constitutes a Credit Event in respect of the Reference Entity (as defined in the Credit Default Swap) for the purposes of the Credit Default Swap has occurred, (ii) that no event which could constitute a Credit Event in respect of the Reference Entity for the purposes of the Credit Default Swap has occurred, or (iii) not to determine whether an event constitutes a Credit Event. Such announcements, determinations and resolutions could affect the redemption and settlement of Notes (including the quantum and timing of payments and/or deliveries on redemption) and may postpone the maturity date of the Notes. By subscribing for or purchasing the Notes, each Noteholder shall be deemed to agree that (i) no DC Party (as defined in the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions) and no legal counsel or other third-party professional hired by a DC Party in connection with such DC Party's performance of its respective duties under the DC Rules (as defined in the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions) and/or 14 any relevant Credit Derivatives Auction Settlement Terms, as applicable, shall be liable to Noteholders, and (ii) no DC Party and no legal counsel or other third-party professional hired by a DC Party in connection with such DC Party's performance of its respective duties under the DC Rules and/or any relevant Credit Derivatives Auction Settlement Terms is acting as fiduciary for, or as an adviser to, Noteholders. Prospective investors should note that the occurrence of a Credit Event on the Notes is determined by the Swap Counterparty under the Credit Default Swap. The determination of whether a Credit Event (or a potential Credit Event, if applicable) has occurred shall be made by the Swap Counterparty without regard to the interest of the Noteholders. The likelihood of a Credit Event occurring will generally fluctuate with, among other things, the financial condition and other characteristics of the Reference Entity, general economic conditions, the condition of certain financial markets, political events, developments or trends in any particular industry and changes in prevailing interest rates. If a Credit Event occurs in relation to the Reference Entity, an amount will be payable by the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty. If there are one or more Auction(s) with respect to the Reference Entity, this amount will be based on the relevant Auction Final Price, failing which it will be determined on the Final Price (each as defined in the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions). The Issuer will need to sell the Collateral in order to fund such payment and will also terminate the Asset Swap, with corresponding termination payments being payable thereunder. The Notes will be redeemed at an amount equal to the remaining sale proceeds of the Collateral (if any) after the payments due to or from the Swap Counterparty under the Swap Agreement have been made. Questions to the ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees The ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees Rules provides that eligible market participants may raise questions to the ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee which have the power to make binding decisions on critical issues such as, without limitation, whether a Credit Event has occurred, whether there is a Successor to a Reference Entity or which obligations of a Reference Entity are deliverable. The Calculation Agent has no duty to the Noteholders to refer specific questions to the ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees. Noteholders should understand the role of the ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees and how their determinations could affect the Issuer’s obligations under the Swap Agreement and consequently have effect on the Notes. Auctions Prospective investors should note that the Notes are linked to the Auction Final Price of the Reference Entity. Accordingly, where a Credit Event occurs, the Auction Final Price will be determined according to an auction procedure set out in the Credit Derivative Auction Settlement Terms, which will be published on the ISDA’s website at www.isda.org following the occurrence of the Credit Event. The Calculation Agent and its affiliates may participate as a participating bidder in an Auction and consequently may take certain actions which may influence the Auction Final Price, which could be adverse to the interests of the Noteholders. For the avoidance of doubt, neither the Issuer nor the Calculation Agent accept any liability to any person for any determinations, redemption, calculations and/or delay or suspension of payments and/or redemption of the Notes resulting from or relating to the Auction Final Price or the Final Price. Noteholders should be aware that redemption and settlement of the Notes may be postponed following public announcement by ISDA that one or more Auction(s) will be held. The relevant 15 Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee may resolve to postpone the scheduled date for an Auction or resolve that no Auction will be held, in which case the Calculation Agent will determine the Final Price in accordance with the dealer poll procedure set out in the Credit Default Swap. Successors Investors should note that, from time to time, the Reference Entity may be subject to change following an event such as an annexation, unification, secession, partition, dissolution, consolidation, reconstitution or other similar event that results in any successor(s) (the “Successor”) to the Reference Entity. The Calculation Agent will be responsible for determining, as soon as reasonably practicable after it becomes aware of the relevant succession date the sovereign and/or entity, if any, that qualifies as the Successor in accordance with the Credit Default Swap. The Credit Default Swap provides that if a Reference Entity has more than one successor entity, then the notional amount will be split evenly among the successor entities, and in the case of joint potential Successors, each joint potential successor shall succeed in equal parts. The Calculation Agent will be responsible for determining, as soon as reasonably practicable after it becomes aware of the relevant succession date the sovereign and/or entity, if any, that qualifies as the Successor. Investors should note that a Successor may be riskier than the Reference Entity it replaces, and consequently the occurrence of a succession date may be detrimental to the Noteholders. Noteholders should also be aware that the relevant event will not necessarily result in the assumption of an obligation intended to be hedged by the Credit Default Swap (if any) by the successor Reference Entities either at all or in the same proportion as the allocation of the notional amount of the original Credit Default Swap. Payments in the Notes may be deferred or suspended In certain circumstances, for example where (i) a Credit Event has occurred and the related credit loss has not been determined as at the relevant date for payment, (ii) where a potential Credit Event exists as at the scheduled maturity of the Notes, or (iii) pending a resolution of an ISDA Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee, payment of the redemption amount of the Notes and/or interest on the Notes may be deferred for a material period in whole or part without compensation to Noteholders. Potential postponement of the Maturity Date As the terms and conditions of the Notes relating to the Credit Default Swap include provisions dealing with the postponement of the Maturity Date if either (i) a Potential Failure to Pay exists on the Scheduled Maturity Date or (ii) a Potential Repudiation/Moratorium exists on the Scheduled Maturity Date or (iii) the Issuer has received a relevant Potential Credit Event Notice from the Swap Counterparty or (iv) the Auction Settlement Date (or Cash Settlement Date, if applicable) has not occurred by the Scheduled Maturity Date, investors should be aware that such postponement or any alternative provisions for valuation provided in the terms and conditions of the Notes may have an adverse effect on the value of the Notes. No legal or beneficial interest in Obligation of the Reference Entity Under the Credit Default Swap, the Issuer will have a contractual relationship only with the Swap Counterparty and not with any obligor in respect of the Reference Entity. Consequently, the Credit Default Swap will not constitute a purchase or other acquisition or assignment of any interest against the Reference Entity. The Issuer and the Trustee will have rights solely against the Swap Counterparty and will have no recourse against the Reference Entity. None of the Issuer, the Trustee, the Noteholders or any other entity will have any rights to acquire from the Swap Counterparty (or to require the Swap Counterparty to transfer, assign or otherwise dispose of) any 16 interest in any obligation of the Reference Entity. Moreover, the Swap Counterparty will not grant the Issuer or the Trustee any security interest in any such obligation. None of the Issuer, CGML, the Trustee, the Swap Counterparty or any other person on their behalf has undertaken any legal due diligence in respect of the Reference Entity. Outstanding Principal Balance The calculation of the outstanding principal balance of a Deliverable Obligation (as defined in the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions) under the Credit Default Swap is determined by (i) firstly ascertaining all principal payment obligations of a Reference Entity, (ii) then determining all or any portion of such principal payment obligations that are subject to a contingency (other than a permitted contingency) or prohibited action which need to be disregarded, leaving an amount equal to the non-contingent amount and (iii) finally, determining the claim that could be validly asserted against a Reference Entity in respect of such non-contingent amount if the obligation was redeemed or accelerated which would be the outstanding principal balance. If payments of principal are subject to a contingency, the outstanding principal balance could be less than the principal balance (and depending upon the type of contingency, could be zero). Sale of Collateral following a Credit Event Following the occurrence of a Credit Event: (a) the Collateral will be sold; (b) under the Credit Default Swap between the Issuer and the Swap Counterparty, unless otherwise specified, the Issuer will pay the Swap Counterparty an amount equal to the product of (x) the notional amount thereof and (y) 100 per cent. minus the final price applicable to the Reference Entity; and (c) the Asset Swap between the Issuer and the Swap Counterparty will be terminated and a termination payment based on its mark-to-market value may be payable by the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty or by the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer. See “Risk Factors relating to the Collateral - Sale of Collateral” below. Risk Factors relating to the Swap Counterparty and the Swap Agreement The ability of the Issuer to meet its obligations under the Notes will depend on the receipt by it of payments under the Swap Agreement. Consequently, the Issuer is exposed not only to the performance of the Initial Collateral and to the occurrence of Credit Events in relation to the Reference Entity, but also to the ability of the Swap Counterparty to perform its obligations under the Swap Agreement. Default by the Swap Counterparty may result in the termination of the Swap Agreement and, in such circumstance, any amount due to the Issuer upon such termination may not be paid in full. The Swap Counterparty has prepared audited financial statements in respect of its financial years ending 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014. Such audited financial statements are attached at the end of the section entitled “Description of the Swap Counterparty” of this Series Prospectus. The receipt by the Issuer of payments under the Swap Agreement is also dependent on the timely payment by the Issuer of its obligations under the Swap Agreement. The ability of the Issuer to make timely payment of its obligations under the Asset Swap depends on receipt by it of the scheduled payments under the Initial Collateral. Consequently, the Issuer is also exposed to the ability of the Collateral Issuer to perform its obligations under the Initial Collateral. Potential investors should note that in certain circumstances the Issuer may not hold any Collateral. In such circumstance, the security for the Notes will consist solely of the Issuer’s contractual rights under the Swap Agreement and other agreements relating to the Notes. 17 U.S. Regulatory considerations U.S. Dodd-Frank Act Title VII of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, enacted 21 July 2010 (“Dodd-Frank”), establishes a comprehensive U.S. regulatory regime for a broad range of derivatives contracts (collectively referred to in this risk factor as “covered swaps”). Among other things, Title VII provides the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”) and the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) with jurisdiction and regulatory authority over many different types of derivatives that were previously traded over the counter, requires the establishment of a comprehensive registration and regulatory framework applicable to covered swap dealers and other major market participants, requires many types of covered swaps to be exchange-traded or executed on swap execution facilities and centrally cleared, and contemplates the imposition of capital and margin requirements for uncleared transactions in covered swaps. While Title VII provided that it was to go into effect on 16 July 2011, the SEC and CFTC have repeatedly delayed compliance with many of Title VII’s requirements through exemptive orders, no-action letters or other forms of relief. While the CFTC had adopted a number of regulations under Title VII and many of the obligations under those regulations have become effective, the SEC is significantly behind the CFTC and its rules are not yet in effect. As Title VII’s requirements go into effect, it is clear that covered swap counterparties, dealers and other major market participants, as well as commercial users of covered swaps, will experience new and/or additional regulatory requirements, compliance burdens and associated costs. Notwithstanding the contractual restrictions that have been imposed by the Issuer in order to fall outside the scope of Dodd-Frank, there is no assurance that the transactions entered into under the Swap Agreement would not be treated as covered swaps under Title VII, nor is there assurance that the Issuer would not be required to comply with additional regulation under the CEA, as described immediately below. If the transactions entered into under the Swap Agreement are treated as covered swaps under Title VII, the Issuer may be required to comply with additional regulation under the CEA. Moreover, the Issuer could be required to register as a commodity pool operator and to register the Notes as a commodity pool with the CFTC (see “Risks relating to the U.S. Commodity Pool Regulation” below). Such additional regulations and/or registration requirements may result in, among other things, increased reporting obligations and also in extraordinary, non-recurring expenses of the Issuer thereby materially and adversely impacting a transaction's value. Any such additional registration requirements could result in one or more service providers or counterparties to the Issuer resigning, seeking to withdraw or renegotiating their relationship with the Issuer. To the extent any service providers resign, it may be difficult to replace such service providers. Under Dodd-Frank, swap agreements entered into between the Issuer and a swap counterparty may be subject to mandatory execution, clearing and documentation requirements. Even those swap agreements not required to be cleared may be subject to initial and variation margining and documentation requirements that may require modifications to existing agreements. Any of the foregoing requirements and/or other requirements or obligations under Dodd-Frank could materially increase costs associated with the Programme and could materially and adversely affect the value of the Notes. Investors are urged to consult their own advisors regarding the suitability of an investment in any Notes. 18 Risks relating to U.S. Commodity Pool Regulation The CFTC has rescinded a rule which formerly provided an exemption from registration as a “commodity pool operator” (a “CPO”) or a “commodity trading advisor” (“CTA”) under the CEA, in respect of certain transactions and investment vehicles involving sophisticated investors. DoddFrank also expanded the definition of “commodity pool” to include any form of enterprise operated for the purpose of trading in commodity interests, including swaps. It should also be noted that the definition of “swap” under Dodd-Frank is itself broad and expressly includes certain interest rate swaps, currency swaps and total return swaps. The term “commodity pool operator” has been expanded to include any person engaged in a business that is of the nature of a commodity pool or similar enterprise and in connection therewith, solicits, accepts, or receives from others, funds, securities or property for the purpose of trading in commodity interests, including any swaps. The CFTC has taken an expansive interpretation of these definitions, and has expressed the view that entering into a single swap could make an entity a “commodity pool” subject to regulation under the CEA. The CFTC has also provided extensive exemptive relief in respect of these matters although there is no guarantee that all or any aspects of the Programme will be able to take advantage of such relief. As at the date of this Base Prospectus, no person has registered nor will register as a CPO of the Issuer under the CEA and the CFTC Rules thereunder. No assurance can be made that either the U.S. federal government or a U.S. regulatory body (or other authority or regulatory body) will not take further legislative or regulatory action, and the effect of such action, if any, cannot be known or predicted. Notwithstanding the contractual restrictions that have been imposed by the Issuer in order to fall outside the scope of the CEA, if the Issuer was deemed to be one or more “commodity pools”, then whoever is deemed to be acting as a CPO in respect thereof would be required to register as such with the CFTC. While there remain certain limited exemptions from registration, because the wording of these regulations applies to traditional commodity pools and was not drafted with transactions such as those contemplated in relation to the Programme in mind, these exemptions may not be available to avoid registration with respect to the Issuer or other parties. In addition, if the Issuer were deemed to be a “commodity pool”, it would have to comply with a number of reporting requirements that are geared to traded commodity pools. Complying with these requirements on an ongoing basis could impose significant costs on the Issuer that may materially and adversely affect the value of the Notes. It is presently unclear how an investment vehicle such as the Issuer could comply with certain of these reporting requirements on an ongoing basis. Such registration and other requirements would also involve material ongoing costs to the Issuer. The scope of such requirements and related compliance costs is uncertain but could materially and adversely affect the value of the Notes. Risks relating to U.S. Volcker Rule On December 10, 2013, the SEC, the CFTC and three U.S. banking regulators approved a final rule to implement the Volcker Rule. Subject to certain exceptions, the Volcker Rule prohibits sponsorship of and investment in certain “covered funds” by “banking entities”, a term that includes Citibank, N.A. and most internationally active banking organizations that may be swap counterparties. Even if an exception allows a banking entity to sponsor or invest in a covered fund, the banking entity may be prohibited from entering into certain “covered transactions” with that covered fund. Covered transactions include (among other things) entering into a swap transaction if the swap would result in a credit exposure to the covered fund. If the Issuer is considered a covered fund and if any affiliate of the Swap Counterparty were to be deemed to be a “sponsor” of the Issuer, the Swap Counterparty could be prohibited from entering 19 into the Swap Agreement with the Issuer, which could have material adverse effects on the Notes. Alternatively, the Issuer may incur additional costs in seeking new swap counterparties in order to maintain the payment characteristics of the Notes, although there is no guarantee that it will be able to find such counterparties. Such costs could materially and adversely affect the value of and any return on the Notes. If the Issuer is considered a covered fund, the liquidity of the market for the Notes may be materially and adversely affected, since banking entities could be prohibited from, or face restrictions in, investing in the Notes. This could make it difficult or impossible for Noteholders to sell the Notes or it could materially and adversely affect their market value. Risk Factors relating to the Custodian Collateral in the form of transferable securities will be held in an account of, and in the name of, the Custodian. Where the Collateral consists of assets other than transferable securities, it may be held in the name of or under the control of the Custodian or in such other manner as is approved by the Trustee. The ability of the Issuer to meet its obligations with respect to the Notes will be dependent upon receipt by the Issuer of payments from the Custodian under the Custody Agreement for the Notes (if the Collateral is so held). Consequently, the Noteholders are relying not only on the creditworthiness of the Collateral, but also on the creditworthiness of the Custodian in respect of the performance of its obligations under the Custody Agreement for such Notes. If there is an overpayment in respect of the Collateral held in the Custodian’s account with a clearing system that leads to a subsequent clawback of such overpayment via the relevant clearing system, the Custodian may seek to recover the corresponding payments made in respect of the Notes or may retain amounts payable in respect of the Notes in order to recover the amount of such clawback. Any cash deposited with the Custodian by the Issuer and any cash received by the Custodian for the account of the Issuer in relation to a Series will be held by the Custodian as banker and not as trustee and will be a bank deposit. Accordingly, such cash will not be held as client money and will represent only an unsecured claim against the Custodian’s assets. Sub-Custodians. Depositaries and Clearing Systems Credit risk Under the Custody Agreement, the Issuer authorises the Custodian to hold the Collateral in their account or accounts with any other sub-custodian, any securities depositary or at such other account keeper or clearing system as the Custodian deems to be appropriate for the type of instruments which comprise the Collateral. Therefore, where the Collateral is held with a sub-custodian, securities depositary or clearing system, the ability of the Issuer to meet its obligations with respect to the Notes will be dependent upon receipt by the Issuer of payments from the Custodian under the Custody Agreement for the Notes (if the Collateral is so held) and, in turn, the Custodian will be dependant (in whole or in part) upon receipt of payments from such sub-custodian, securities depositary or clearing system. Consequently, the Noteholders are relying not only on the creditworthiness of the Collateral and the Custodian in respect of the performance of its obligations under the Custody Agreement for such Notes, but also on the creditworthiness of any duly appointed sub-custodian, securities depositary or other account keeper or clearing system holding the Collateral. Lien/Right of set-off 20 Pursuant to their terms of engagement, such sub-custodians, security depositaries or clearing systems may have liens or rights of set-off with respect to the Collateral held with them in relation to any of their fees and/or expenses. If, for whatever reason, the Custodian fails to pay such fees and/or expenses, the relevant sub-custodian, security depositary or clearing system may exercise such lien or right of set-off, which may result in the Issuer failing to receive any payments due to it in respect of the Collateral, adversely affecting the ability of the Issuer to meet its obligations with respect to the Notes. Therefore, the ability of the Issuer to meet its obligations with respect to the Notes will not only be dependent upon receipt by the Issuer of payments from the Custodian under the Custody Agreement for the Notes (if the Collateral is so held) but also dependant on any sub-custodian, security depositary or clearing system not exercising any lien or right of set-off in respect of any Collateral that it holds. Consequently, the Noteholders are relying not only on the creditworthiness of the Collateral but also on the creditworthiness of the Custodian in paying when due any fees or expenses of such sub-custodian, security depositary or clearing system. Risks Relating to the Paying Agent Any payments made to Noteholders in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Notes will be made by the Paying Agent on behalf of the Issuer. Pursuant to the Agency Agreement, the Issuer is to transfer to the Paying Agent such amount as may be due under the Notes, on or before each date on which such payment in respect of the Notes becomes due. If the Paying Agent, while holding funds for payment to Noteholders in respect of the Notes, is declared insolvent, the Noteholders may not receive all (or any part) of any amounts due to them in respect of the Notes from the Paying Agent. The Issuer will still be liable to Noteholders in respect of such unpaid amounts but the Issuer will have insufficient assets to make such payments (or any part thereof) and Noteholders may not receive all, or any part, of any amounts due to them. Consequently, the Noteholders are relying not only on the creditworthiness of the Securities, but also on the creditworthiness of the Paying Agent in respect of the performance of its obligations under the Agency Agreement to make payments to Noteholders. Conflicts of Interest The Trustee In connection with the exercise of its functions, the Trustee shall have regard to the interests of the Noteholders as a class and shall not have regard to the consequences of such exercise for individual Noteholders and the Trustee shall not be entitled to require, nor shall any Noteholder be entitled to claim, from the Issuer any indemnification or payment in respect of any tax consequence of any such exercise upon individual Noteholders. In acting as Trustee under the Trust Deed, the Trustee shall not, in respect of Notes of any Series, assume any duty or responsibility to any Swap Counterparty (other than to pay to any Swap Counterparty any moneys received and payable to it and to act in accordance with the Conditions) and shall have regard solely to the interests of the Noteholders and shall not be obliged to act on any directions of the relevant Swap Counterparty if this would in the Trustee’s opinion be contrary to the interests of the Noteholders. The Swap Counterparty Prospective investors should be aware that, where any Swap Counterparty is entitled to exercise its discretion or to undertake a decision in such capacity in respect of the Swap Agreement (including any right to terminate the Swap Agreement), in respect of the terms and conditions or 21 otherwise in respect of the Notes, unless specified to the contrary therein, the relevant Swap Counterparty will be entitled to act in its absolute discretion and will be under no obligation to, and will not assume any fiduciary duty or responsibility for, the Noteholders or any other person. In exercising its discretion or deciding upon a course of action, the relevant Swap Counterparty shall attempt to maximise the beneficial outcome for itself (that is, maximise any payments due to it and minimise any payments due from it) and will not be liable to account to the Noteholders or any other person for any profit or other benefit to it or any of its affiliates that may result directly or indirectly from any such selection. The Calculation Agent The Calculation Agent is a leading dealer in the credit derivatives market. If an auction is held in respect of a Reference Entity for which a Credit Event has occurred, there is a high probability that the Calculation Agent or one of its affiliates would act as a participating bidder in any such auction. In such capacity, it may take certain actions which may influence the final price determined pursuant to the auction, including, without limitation, (i) providing rates of conversion to determine the applicable currency conversion rates to be used to convert any obligations that are not denominated in the auction currency into such currency for the purposes of the auction and (ii) submitting bids and offers with respect to the relevant deliverable obligations. In deciding whether to take any such action, or whether to act as a participating bidder in any auction, the Calculation Agent and its affiliates shall be under no obligation to consider the interests of any Noteholder. The Calculation Agent (or, as the case may be, one of its affiliates) may also be a voting member on one or more of the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees and is a party to transactions that incorporate, or are deemed to incorporate, either (a) the July 2009 Supplement to the 2003 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions published by ISDA or (b) the 2014 Credit Derivatives Definitions and may take certain actions that may influence the process and outcome of decisions of the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees. Such actions may be adverse to the interests of the Noteholders and may result in an economic benefit accruing to the Calculation Agent or its affiliates. In taking any action relating to the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees or performing any duty under the rules that govern the Credit Derivatives Determinations Committees, the Calculation Agent (or, as the case may be, one of its affiliates) shall have no obligation to consider the interests of the Noteholders and may ignore any conflict of interest arising in respect of the Notes. Risk Factors relating to the Initial Collateral No investigations No investigations, searches or other enquiries have been made by or on behalf of the Issuer or the Transaction Parties in respect of the Initial Collateral. No representations or warranties, express or implied, have been given by the Issuer, the Transaction Parties or any other person on their behalf in respect of the Initial Collateral. Collateral Noteholders may be exposed to the market value of the Initial Collateral. The Issuer may have to fund its payments by the sale of some or all of the Initial Collateral at its market value. The market value of the Initial Collateral will generally fluctuate with, among other things, the liquidity and volatility of the financial markets, general economic conditions, domestic and international political events, developments or trends in a particular industry and the financial condition of the relevant issuer of the Initial Collateral. 22 For example, the occurrence of certain events, including, inter alia, the Initial Collateral becoming repayable prior to its stated maturity as a result of a payment default, imposition of withholding tax on the Issuer, imposition of withholding tax on payments due in respect of the Collateral, may result in the Notes redeeming early. Furthermore, the Notes will be subject to an early redemption if the value of the Initial Collateral held by the Issuer (as determined by the Calculation Agent acting in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner) is less than 65 per cent. of the outstanding nominal amount of the Notes (such event, an “Asset Value Termination Event”). In such circumstances, the Issuer will sell any Initial Collateral and Noteholders will then receive (i) a pro rata share of the net realised sale proceeds of such Initial Collateral, plus (if due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) or minus (if due from the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty) (ii) the Swap Termination Value. Depending on the market price of the Initial Collateral, any of these events may cause significant losses to the Noteholders and may result in the Notes redeeming at zero. In particular, investors should note that whilst the Calculation Agent will use its reasonable endeavours to notify the Issuer of the occurrence of an Asset Value Termination Event, notification may not occur immediately following a fall in value to below the trigger percentage. There is no guarantee of timely receipt of any such notice by the Issuer (which is subject to operational and other risks). In the case of increasing market volatility, at the time of the Issuer’s receipt of a notice of the Asset Value Termination Event (and the Noteholders’ receipt of a Mandatory Redemption Notice), the value of the Initial Collateral may have fallen further below 65 per cent. of the outstanding nominal amount of the Notes, even to zero. The Arranger and the Dealer may have acquired, or during the terms of the Notes may acquire, confidential information or enter into transactions with respect to any Initial Collateral and they shall not be under any duty to disclose such confidential information or the nature of any transaction to any Noteholder or the Issuer. Sale of the Initial Collateral Investors should note that any sale proceeds of the Initial Collateral may be less than the principal amount thereof. Early redemption due to early redemption of the Initial Collateral If the Initial Collateral (i) becomes due and payable or becomes capable of being declared due and payable prior to its stated date of maturity in accordance with its terms or (ii) there is a payment default in respect of the Initial Collateral, the Issuer is required to redeem the Notes in whole (and not in part) at the Early Redemption Amount. Notes linked to the Emerging Markets The performance of the Notes is linked to the performance of (a) the Initial Collateral issued by a company incorporated in the United Arab Emirates and (b) The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia (as the Reference Entity for the purposes of the Credit Default Swap), both of which are emerging markets jurisdictions (each, an “Emerging Market Jurisdiction”). Prospective investors should note that special risks may be associated with investment in or linked to securities that are issued by, or are related or linked to, issuers and obligors which are Emerging Market Jurisdictions. Such risks may arise because, among other reasons, there is a high degree of uncertainty and volatility associated with investments in or linked to Emerging Market Jurisdictions, and the performance of the Notes will be directly impacted by certain political, economic and legal conditions in one or more Emerging Market Jurisdictions. There are political and economic uncertainties that are greater in Emerging Market Jurisdictions than in other countries, many Emerging Market Jurisdictions do not 23 have fully developed or clear legal, judicial, regulatory or settlement infrastructures, accounting standards may differ markedly and the markets may be far less liquid or transparent than in more developed markets. Initial Collateral Correlation Risk As at the Issue Date, the issuer of the Initial Collateral is Abu Dhabi National Energy Company PJSC (a company incorporated in the United Arab Emirates) and the Reference Entity for the purposes of the Credit Default Swap is The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. Noteholders should therefore note that both the Initial Collateral and the Reference Entity may be affected by the financial, political and general economic conditions prevailing from time to time in the Middle East. There is likely to be a high degree of correlation between a default by the issuer of the Initial Collateral and the occurrence of an Event Determination Date (as defined in the Credit Default Swap) in respect of the Reference Entity. Accordingly, Noteholders may suffer greater loss (and may be more likely to suffer losses) as a result of such correlation than they may otherwise have done had the issuer of the Initial Collateral and the Reference Entity not been organised or located in the same geographical area. Risk Factors relating to business relationships and capacity of Citigroup Global Markets Limited and its affiliates The Issuer, CGML and any of its affiliates may have existing or future business relationships with the issuer of the Collateral (including, but not limited to, lending, depository, risk management, advisory, sponsorship and banking relationships), and will pursue actions and take steps that they deem or it deems necessary or appropriate to protect their or its interests arising therefrom without regard to the consequences for a Noteholder. In addition, the Issuer, CGML and any of its affiliates may make a market or hold positions in respect of the Collateral relating to any particular transaction. From time to time, CGML and its affiliates may own significant amounts of Notes. CGML and its affiliates may act in a number of capacities in respect of the Notes including, without limitation, Dealer, Calculation Agent and Swap Counterparty. CGML and its affiliates acting in such capacities in connection with the Notes shall have only the duties and responsibilities expressly agreed to by such entities in the relevant capacity and shall not, by virtue of acting in any other capacity, be deemed to have other duties or responsibilities or be deemed to hold a standard of care other than as expressly provided with respect to each such capacity. CGML and its affiliates in their various capacities in connection with the Notes may enter into business dealings, from which they may derive revenues and profits in addition to any fees, without any duty to account therefor. Risk Factors relating to the Market Current market conditions The current liquidity shortage and volatility in the credit markets has introduced a variety of increased risks relating to several aspects of the Issuer’s operations. Such additional risks include the inability of the Issuer to sell its assets which, among other things, may render it unable to dispose of the Collateral and satisfy its obligations in respect of the redemption of the Notes. Such market conditions may also lead to the inability of the Issuer to determine a reliable valuation of its assets. All of such factors could materially adversely affect the interests of Noteholders. Limited liquidity of the Notes Although application has been made to admit the Notes to the Official List of the Irish Stock Exchange and admit them to trading on the regulated market of the Irish Stock Exchange, there is 24 currently no secondary market for the Notes. There can be no assurance that a secondary market for any of the Notes will develop, or, if a secondary market does develop, that it will provide the holders of the Notes with liquidity or that it will continue for the life of the Notes. Consequently, any investor of the Notes must be prepared to hold such Notes for an indefinite period of time or until redemption of the Notes. If the Arranger or any Dealer begins making a market for the Notes, it is under no obligation to continue to do so and may stop making a market at any time. Exchange rate risks and exchange controls The Issuer will pay principal and interest on the Notes in the currency of the Notes. This presents certain risks relating to currency conversions if an investor's financial activities are denominated principally in a currency or currency unit (the “Investor’s Currency”) other than the specified currency. These include the risk that exchange rates may significantly change (including changes due to devaluation of the specified currency or revaluation of the Investor’s Currency) and the risk that authorities with jurisdiction over the Investor’s Currency may impose or modify exchange controls. An appreciation in the value of the Investor’s Currency relative to the specified currency would decrease (i) the Investor’s Currency-equivalent yield on the Notes, (ii) the Investor’s Currency-equivalent value of the principal payable on the Notes and (iii) the Investor’s Currencyequivalent market value of the Notes. Government and monetary authorities may impose (as some have done in the past) exchange controls that could adversely affect an applicable exchange rate. As a result, investors may receive less interest or principal than expected, or no interest or principal. Interest rate risks Investment in Notes may involve the risk that subsequent changes in market interest rates may adversely affect the value of the Notes. Risks relating to global events General Since mid-2007, the global economy and financial markets have experienced extreme levels of instability. The initial trigger for the instability was a downturn in the U.S. housing market. By mid-2007, concerns about the value of mortgage assets held by global commercial banks, investment banks, government sponsored entities, hedge funds, structured investment vehicles and institutional investors led to a general tightening of available credit and liquidity in the global financial markets. During 2008, the initial instability intensified into a severe global financial crisis. In response to the crisis, various governments and central banks took substantial measures to ease liquidity problems and enacted fiscal stimulus packages and measures to support certain entities affected by the crisis. Such measures included establishing special liquidity schemes and credit facilities, bank recapitalisation programmes and credit guarantee schemes. In an attempt to counteract recessionary pressures, the central banks of the U.S., the UK and certain other countries and the European Central Bank also lowered interest rates, in some cases to record low levels. No assurance can be given that any recovery will be sustained or that certain economies will not encounter a “double dip” recession. In particular, a number of countries have accumulated significant levels of public debt both absolutely and relative to GDP. This has led to international “bail-outs” of certain countries and resulted in general concerns about sovereign credit defaults 25 which could undermine any recovery and could have the effect of taking the credit crisis into a new recessionary phase. The above factors have also led to substantial volatility in markets across asset classes, including (without limitation) stock markets, foreign exchange markets, fixed income markets and credit markets. There can be no assurance that the steps taken by governments or international or supra-national bodies to ameliorate the global financial crisis will be successful or that any recovery will continue. The structure, nature and regulation of financial markets in the future may be fundamentally altered as a consequence of the global financial crisis, possibly in unforeseen ways. There can be no assurance that similar or greater disruption may not occur in the future for similar or other reasons. In addition, the attempts being taken to reduce the high level of sovereign debt may themselves contribute to a further global recession. There can be no assurance as to how severe the global recession will be or as to how long it will last. There can be no assurance that government actions or the actions of international or supranational bodies to limit the impact of the crisis will be successful and that they will not instead lead or contribute to a deeper and/or longer-lasting recession. Economic prospects are subject to considerable uncertainty. Prospective investors should ensure that they have sufficient knowledge and awareness of the global financial crisis and the response thereto and of the economic situation and outlook as they consider necessary to enable them to make their own evaluation of the risks and merits of an investment in the Notes. In particular, prospective investors should take into account the considerable uncertainty as to how the global financial crisis and the wider economic situation will develop over time. Any person who had held securities during the periods considered above, particularly structured securities, would be highly likely to have suffered significant adverse effects as a result of such holding, including, but not limited to, major reductions in the value of those securities and a lack of liquidity. Prospective investors should consider carefully whether they are prepared to take on similar risks by virtue of an investment in the Notes. Impact on liquidity The events outlined above have had an extremely negative effect on the liquidity of financial markets generally and in the markets in respect of certain financial assets or in the obligations of certain obligors. This has particularly been the case with respect to the market for structured assets and the obligations of financial institutions and certain sovereigns. Such assets may either not be saleable at all or may only be saleable at significant discounts to their estimated fair value or to the amount originally invested. No assurance can be given that liquidity in the market generally, or in the market for any particular asset class or in the obligations of any particular financial institution or sovereign, will improve or that it will not worsen in the future. Such limited liquidity may have a negative impact on the value of the Notes or the value of the Collateral, in terms of the assets or indices referenced. In particular, should the Notes be redeemed early, Noteholders will be exposed to the realisation value of the Collateral, which value might be affected (in some cases significantly) by such lack of liquidity. Concerns about the creditworthiness of the Issuing and Paying Agent may also impact the value of the Notes. 26 Impact on credit The events outlined above have negatively affected the creditworthiness of a number of entities or governments, in some cases to the extent of collapse or requiring rescue from governments or international or supra-national bodies. Such credit deterioration has and may continue to be widespread. The value of the Notes or of the amount of payments under them may be negatively affected by such widespread credit deterioration. Prospective investors should note that recoveries on assets of affected entities have, in some cases, been de minimis and that similarly low recovery levels may be experienced with respect to other entities or governments in the future which may include the obligors of the Collateral (or any guarantor or credit support provider in respect thereof). Prospective investors should also consider the impact of a default by an Issuing and Paying Agent and possible delays and costs in being able to access property held with a failed agent. Impact on valuations and calculations Since 2007, actively traded markets for a number of asset classes and obligors either have ceased to exist or have reduced significantly. To the extent that valuations or calculations in respect of instruments related to those asset classes were based on quoted market prices or market inputs, the lack or limited availability of such market prices or inputs has significantly impaired the ability to make accurate valuations or calculations in respect of such instruments. No assurance can be given that similar impairment may not occur in the future. Furthermore, in a number of asset classes, a significant reliance has historically been placed on valuations derived from models that use inputs that are not observable in the markets and/or that are based on historical data and trends. Such models often rely on certain assumptions about the values or behaviour of such unobservable inputs or about the behaviour of the markets generally or interpolate future outcomes from historical data. In a number of cases, the extent of the market volatility and disruption has resulted in the assumptions being incorrect to a significant degree or in extreme departures from historical trends. Where reliance is placed on historical data, in certain instances such data may only be available for relatively short time periods (for example, data with respect to prices in relatively new markets) and such data may not be as statistically representative as data for longer periods. Prospective investors should be aware of the risks inherent in any valuation or calculation that is determined by reference to a model and that certain assumptions will be made in operating the model which may prove to be incorrect and give rise to significantly different outcomes to those predicted by the model. Impact of increased regulation and nationalisation The events since 2007 have seen increased involvement of governmental and regulatory authorities in the financial sector and in the operation of financial institutions. In particular, governmental and regulatory authorities in a number of jurisdictions have imposed stricter regulatory controls around certain financial activities and/or have indicated that they intend to impose such controls in the future. The United States of America, the European Union and other jurisdictions are actively considering or are in the process of implementing various reform measures. Such regulatory changes and the method of their implementation may have a significant impact on the operation of the financial markets. It is uncertain how a changed regulatory environment will affect the Issuer, the treatment of instruments such as the Notes, the Arranger and the other Transaction Parties. In addition, governments have shown an increased willingness, wholly or partially, to nationalise financial institutions, corporates and other entities in order to support the economy. Such nationalisation may impact adversely on the value of the stock 27 or other obligations of any such entity. In addition, in order to effect such nationalisation, existing obligations or stock might have their terms mandatorily amended or be forcibly redeemed. To the extent that the obligors of the Collateral (or any guarantor or credit support provider in respect thereof) or any other person or entity connected with the Notes is subject to nationalisation or other government intervention, it may have an adverse effect on a holder of a Note. Systemic risk Financial institutions and other significant participants in the financial markets that deal with each other are interrelated as a result of trading, investment, clearing, counterparty and other relationships. This risk is sometimes referred to as “systemic risk”. Financial institutions such as the Arranger, the Dealer(s), the Trustee and the Agents (or any affiliate of any of them) and any obligors of the Collateral (or any guarantor or credit support provider in respect thereof) that are financial institutions or are significant participants in the financial markets are likely routinely to execute a high volume of transactions with various types of counterparties, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, insurers, mutual and hedge funds, and institutional clients. To the extent they do so, they are and will continue to be exposed to the risk of loss if counterparties fail or are otherwise unable to meet their obligations. In addition, a default by a financial institution or other significant participant in the financial markets, or concerns about the ability of a financial institution or other significant participant in the financial markets to meet its obligations, could lead to further significant systemic liquidity problems and other problems that could exacerbate the global financial crisis and, as such, have a material adverse impact on other entities. 28 INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE The provisions contained in pages 1 to 162 and 207 to 278 of the Base Prospectus, which constitutes a Base Prospectus for the purposes of the Prospectus Directive, shall be deemed to be incorporated into and form part of this Series Prospectus, save that any statement contained in the Base Prospectus shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for the purpose of this Series Prospectus to the extent that a statement contained herein modifies or supersedes such earlier statement (whether expressly, by implication or otherwise). Any statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this Series Prospectus. This Series Prospectus must be read in conjunction with the Base Prospectus and full information on the Issuer and the offer of the Notes is only available on the basis of the combination of the provisions set out within this document and the provisions of the Base Prospectus incorporated herein. The audited financial statements in respect of its financial years ended 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014 filed by the Issuer with the Central Bank are also deemed to be incorporated into and form part of this Series Prospectus, and are available for viewing on the website of the Irish Stock Exchange using the following link: http://ise.ie/app/announcementDetails.aspx?ID=13044842 As at the Issue Date, the Base Prospectus and the Issuer’s audited financial statements in respect of its financial years ended 31 December 2014 and 31 December 2013 (contained within Schedules 1 and 2, respectively, of Issuer Disclosure Annex 2 to the Base Prospectus) have been filed with the Central Bank and are also available for viewing on the website of the Irish Stock Exchange using the following link: http://www.ise.ie/debt_documents/Base%20Prospectus_d6a85a84-1a6e-481f-b9c3ce6c758fd8ad.PDF Pages 179 to 180 of the Citigroup, Inc. Form 10-Q (filed with the SEC in respect of the quarterly period ended 31 March 2017), containing the disclosures with respect to “Contingencies” in respect of such Form 10-Q, are also deemed to be incorporated into and form part of this Series Prospectus, and are available for viewing on the website of Citigroup, Inc. using the following link: http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/data/q1701c.pdf?ieNocache=323 The non-incorporated parts of the documents incorporated by reference are either not relevant for the prospective investors in the Notes or covered elsewhere in this Series Prospectus. 29 TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE NOTES The terms and conditions of the Notes shall consist of the terms and conditions set out in the Base Prospectus as amended or supplemented below. Provisions appearing on the face of the Notes 1 Issuer: Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company (formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited) 2 Relevant Dealer/Lead Manager (including, if Syndicated Issue, Managers): Citigroup Global Markets Limited (“CGML”) 3 Series No: 2017-02 4 Tranche No: 1 5 ISIN: XS1608156474 6 Common Code: 160815647 7 Currency (or Currencies in the case of Dual Currency Notes): United States Dollar (“USD”) 8 Principal Amount: USD 35,000,000. Following any purchase and cancellation of the Notes pursuant to Condition 7.4 (Purchases) or Condition 7.10 (Cancellation), the Principal Amount shall be reduced accordingly. As soon as practicable following receipt by the Issuer of a Credit Event Notice and (if applicable) a Notice of Publicly Available Information from the Swap Counterparty under the Credit Default Swap, notice of the same shall be given by or on behalf of the Issuer to the Noteholders in accordance with Condition 16 (Notices). 9 10 (i) Issue Date: 10 May 2017 (ii) Date Board approval for issuance of Notes obtained: 8 May 2017 Issue Price: 100 per cent. Provisions appearing on the back of the Notes 11 Form of the Notes: Registered 12 Denomination(s): USD 250,000 13 Status: Secured and limited recourse obligations of the Issuer, secured as provided in item 72 below (under the heading 30 “The Security Arrangements”). 14 Interest Commencement Date (if different from Issue Date): Issue Date 15 Interest Basis: Fixed Rate, as described in paragraphs 16 to 37. 16 Interest Rate: 4.88 per cent. per annum. 17 Interest Payment Date(s): Two Business Days following each Interest Period Date. 18 Relevant Time (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 19 Determination Date(s) (if applicable): Not applicable 20 Interest Determination Date (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 21 Primary Source for Floating Rate (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 22 Reference Banks (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 23 Relevant Financial Centre (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 24 Benchmark (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 25 Broken Amount (Fixed Rate Notes): Not applicable 26 Representative Amount (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 27 Relevant Currency (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 28 Effective Date (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 29 Specified Duration (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 30 Margin (Floating Rate Notes): Not applicable 31 Rate Multiplier (if applicable): Not applicable 32 Maximum/Minimum Interest Rate (if applicable): Not applicable 33 Maximum/Minimum Instalment Amount (if applicable): Not applicable 34 Maximum/Minimum Not applicable 31 Redemption Amount (if applicable): 35 Interest Amount: The Interest Amount payable in respect of each Note and an Interest Accrual Period shall be an amount in USD calculated by the Calculation Agent as being equal to the product of (a) the Denomination; (b) the Interest Rate; and (c) the Day Count Fraction. Interest will be payable in arrear on the Interest Payment Dates. The Interest Amount will cease to accrue from and including the Interest Period Date immediately preceding an Event Determination Date (as defined in the Credit Default Swap) (or if none, the Interest Commencement Date), provided that if the Event Determination Date is subsequently reversed pursuant to the terms of the Credit Default Swap, any Interest Amount which previously ceased to accrue shall be deemed to have accrued and shall be payable by the Issuer two Business Days after the date of such reversal. No additional interest shall be payable in respect of any reversal of an Event Determination Date. If the Swap Counterparty notifies the Issuer that a Credit Event (as defined in the Credit Default Swap) may have occurred prior to an Interest Period Date but no Event Determination Date has yet been determined (including without limitation where a request has been made to ISDA (in its capacity as secretary of the relevant Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee, the “DC Secretary”) to convene a Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee to consider whether a Credit Event has occurred and (a) such request has not been rejected by the DC Secretary; and (b) the deliberations with respect to any DC Credit Event Meeting Announcement in relation to such Credit Event have not commenced yet or are still ongoing), payment of the Interest Amount on the Interest Payment Date relating to such Interest Period Date shall be postponed until the Swap Counterparty confirms whether or not a Credit Event has occurred. If the Swap Counterparty notifies the Issuer that no Credit Event has occurred, the Issuer will pay Noteholders the postponed Interest Amount two Business Days after the Swap Counterparty makes such confirmation without any additional interest in respect of such postponement. If the Swap Counterparty determines that an Event Determination Date has occurred, the Interest Amount will cease to accrue from and including the Interest Period Date immediately preceding such Event Determination Date and no Interest Amount shall be payable on any Interest Payment Date following such event. 32 36 Day Count Fraction: 30/360 37 Interest Period Date(s) (if applicable): 22 June and 22 December in each year from and including 22 June 2017 (a short first coupon) to and including 22 June 2026, in each case not subject to adjustment in accordance with any Business Day Convention. 38 Redemption Amount: Redemption Amount payable on final maturity pursuant to Condition 7.1: Final Redemption Amount Redemption Amount payable on mandatory redemption pursuant to Condition 7.2: Early Redemption Amount No additional amounts shall be payable by the Issuer or the Swap Counterparty as a result of the redemption of the Notes falling on a date after the Scheduled Maturity Date. Condition 7.2.1 (Mandatory Redemption) shall be amended by: deleting “either” immediately before “(i) any of the Initial Collateral”; inserting the following immediately after the words “a payment default in respect of any of the Initial Collateral”: “or (iv) the Asset Value Termination Event has occurred”; and inserting the following sentence at the end of Condition 7.2.1: “For the purposes of (iv) above, (a) an “Asset Value Termination Event” shall occur if, on any day, the value of the Initial Collateral then held by the Issuer (as determined by the Calculation Agent acting in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner) is less than 65 per cent. of the outstanding nominal amount of the Notes (the “Asset Value Trigger Level”) on such day and (b) the occurrence of an Asset Value Termination Event on any day shall give rise to an early redemption of the Notes in accordance with this Condition 7.2.1 notwithstanding the value of the Initial Collateral at any time thereafter. The Calculation Agent will use reasonable endeavours to notify the Issuer of the occurrence of an Asset Value Termination Event.” Noteholders should note that such notification may not occur immediately following a fall in value to below the trigger percentage. There is no guarantee of timely receipt of any such notice by the Issuer (which is subject to operational and other risks) and, particularly in the case of increasing market volatility, the value of the Initial Collateral may have fallen further below the 33 Asset Value Trigger Level, even to zero, at the time of the Issuer’s receipt of a notice of the Asset Value Termination Event (and the Noteholders’ receipt of a Mandatory Redemption Notice) and at the time of subsequent realisation of the Initial Collateral. Noteholders may notify the Calculation Agent if they believe that the value of the Initial Collateral has fallen below the Asset Value Trigger Level and, in order to ensure that it can monitor the such values, any Noteholder should have its own access to real-time sophisticated financial data. Noteholders shall have no claim against the Calculation Agent for any failure to provide (or delay in providing) notice of an Asset Value Termination Event. Redemption Amount payable on mandatory redemption pursuant to Condition 7.3: Early Redemption Amount Redemption Amount payable on exercise of Issuer’s option pursuant to Condition 7.6: Not applicable Redemption Amount payable on exercise of Noteholder’s option pursuant to Condition 7.7: Not applicable Redemption Amount payable on final maturity pursuant to Condition 7.12: Early Redemption Amount Redemption Amount payable where an Event Determination Date has occurred in accordance with the Credit Default Swap: If a Credit Event occurs at any time from and including the Credit Linkage Start Date (as defined in Annex 1) to and including the later of (a) the Credit Linkage End Date (as defined in Annex 1), (b) if a Potential Failure to Pay exists on the Credit Linkage End Date, the Grace Period Extension Date and (c) if a Potential Repudiation/Moratorium exists on the Credit Linkage End Date, the Repudiation/Moratorium Evaluation Date, and an Event Determination Date has occurred and has not been subsequently reversed prior to the occurrence of the Auction Final Price Determination Date, Valuation Date or Termination Date (as applicable) in accordance with the terms of the Credit Default Swap (and where terms not defined herein have the meanings given to them in the Credit Default Swap), subject to the paragraph 34 below with regard to Multiple Successors, each Note will, subject as provided below, be redeemed at the Cash Settlement Entitlement on the date falling two Business Days after the relevant Settlement Date. Notes held by a Noteholder shall be aggregated for the purpose of determining the aggregate Cash Settlement Entitlement of that Noteholder. Where with respect to the Credit Default Swap, more than one Successor (each a “Multiple Successor”) has been identified and the relevant Event Determination Date relates to a Multiple Successor, each Note shall be redeemed in part, not in whole (except where the Credit Event relates to the final remaining Multiple Successor that has not already suffered a Credit Event) and: (i) Principal Amount to be redeemed: the principal amount of each Note to be redeemed (the “Allocated Principal Amount”) shall be a portion of the corresponding principal amount of such Note equal to the outstanding principal amount of such Note allocated to the relevant Reference Entity immediately prior to such Succession Date divided by the number of Multiple Successors and the aggregate principal amount of the Notes redeemed in respect of such Event Determination Date shall be the sum of all such Allocated Principal Amounts (the “Aggregate Allocated Principal Amount”); (ii) Cessation of Interest: interest shall cease to accrue on the principal amount of the Notes equal to the Aggregate Allocated Principal Amount from and including the Interest Period Date immediately preceding the relevant Event Determination Date; (iii) Sale of Initial Collateral: the Disposal Agent on behalf of the Issuer shall dispose of a portion of the Initial Collateral bearing the same proportion to the Initial Collateral as the Aggregate Allocated Principal Amount bears to the Principal Amount outstanding; and (iv) Partial Cash Settlement Entitlement payable: in such circumstances each Note will be redeemed by payment of the Cash Settlement Entitlement (determined with respect to such Allocated Principal Amount) on the day falling two Business Days after the relevant Settlement Date. More than one Cash Settlement Entitlement may be payable on the same day in respect of different Multiple Successors but, subject to the provisions of paragraphs 38(g)(i) and (ii) above, not more than one Event Determination Date resulting in a Credit Event may occur (or 35 deemed to occur) in relation to a single Multiple Successor. Following a partial redemption pursuant to this paragraph 38(g), the Calculation Agent may make such modifications to the Conditions as it considers necessary acting in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner to preserve the economic effects of the continuing notes. Noteholders should note that in the event that the Notes are redeemed pursuant to this paragraph 38(g), the market value of any Cash Settlement Entitlement may be less than the outstanding principal amount of the Notes and may be zero. Redemption Amount payable upon the acceleration of the Notes following the occurrence of an Event of Default pursuant to Condition 11: Early Redemption Amount Where the Notes redeem early, the Issuer shall apply the proceeds of the sale of the Collateral and the Swap Termination Value (if the same is due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) in accordance with the applicable order of priorities that would then be determined to apply in accordance with paragraph 72(b). Noteholders may receive different payments as a result of roundings effected by the Calculation Agent. In the event that the Notes are redeemed prior to the Maturity Date, the amount payable by the Issuer may be more or less than the principal amount of the Notes and may be zero. 39 Maturity Date: Two Business Days following 22 June 2026 (the “Scheduled Maturity Date”) or, if later, the latest of each of the dates as determined below (each event causing an extension to the Maturity Date of the Notes, a “Maturity Date Extension Event”): (a) if an Event Determination Date or DC Credit Event Question Dismissal has occurred or if, for any reason, the Extension Date does not fall on the Scheduled Termination Date (each as defined in the Credit Default Swap), two Business Days following the Termination Date of the Credit Default Swap (or, if any event under the Credit Default Swap results in the Calculation Agent only being able to determine the Termination Date of the Credit Default Swap on a date after such date has occurred, two Business Days following the date that the Calculation Agent is able to make such determination); (b) if a Potential Failure to Pay exists on the Credit Linkage End Date, the Maturity Date shall be 36 postponed (but for the avoidance of doubt shall not be accelerated) until the date falling two Business Days following the later of the final day of (i) the Notice Delivery Period; and (ii) the Post Dismissal Additional Period (if any) (each as defined in the Credit Default Swap); (c) if a Potential Repudiation/Moratorium (each as defined in the Credit Default Swap) exists on the Credit Linkage End Date, the Maturity Date shall be postponed until the date falling two Business Days following the later of the final day of (i) the Notice Delivery Period; and (ii) the Post Dismissal Additional Period (if any); (d) if the Swap Counterparty notifies the Issuer pursuant to the Credit Default Swap (such notice, a “Potential Credit Event Notice”) at any time on or prior to the Scheduled Maturity Date of its determination (which shall be exercisable in its sole and absolute discretion) that a Credit Event may have occurred in the period from and including the Credit Linkage Start Date to and including the Credit Linkage End Date in respect of which an Event Determination Date has not occurred, or the determination as to whether such Credit Event has occurred cannot be resolved in accordance with the terms of the Credit Default Swap on or before the Scheduled Maturity Date, the Maturity Date shall be postponed until the date falling two Business Days following the later of the final day of (i) the Notice Delivery Period; and (ii) the Post Dismissal Additional Period (if any) or such later date on which, in the reasonable opinion of the Calculation Agent, an Event Determination Date can no longer occur with respect to such Credit Event; and (e) if, with respect to a Reference Entity, an Event Determination Date occurs and the Auction Settlement Amount (or Cash Settlement Amount, if applicable) in respect of the relevant Credit Event has not been determined as of the Scheduled Maturity Date, then the Maturity Date shall be postponed until the date falling two Business Days following the relevant Settlement Date. For the avoidance of doubt, the Settlement Date of the Credit Default Swap may be postponed following a public announcement by the DC Secretary that a DC Resolution (as defined in the 2014 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions) will be passed by the relevant Credit Derivatives 37 Determinations Committee. See “Determination of Credit Events” risk factor in “Risk Factors” above. See also “Payments in the Notes may be deferred or suspended” risk factor in “Risk Factors” above. Notice of any Potential Credit Event Notice will be given to the Noteholders in accordance with Condition 16 (Notices) by the Issuer promptly after receipt by the Issuer thereof from the Swap Counterparty. In addition, notice of the postponed Maturity Date will be given to the Noteholders in accordance with Condition 16 (Notices) by the Issuer promptly after the postponed Maturity Date is determined. The Swap Counterparty may send more than one Potential Credit Event Notice during the term of the Notes and in the event of the occurrence of more than one Maturity Date Extension Event the Maturity Date shall be postponed until the latest of the dates determined pursuant to each Maturity Date Extension Event described above. No additional amounts of interest or otherwise will be payable by the Issuer or the Swap Counterparty as a result of any postponement of the Maturity Date. 40 Redemption for taxation reasons permitted on days other than Interest Payment Dates: Yes 41 Index/Formula (Indexed Notes): Not applicable 42 Calculation Agent: For the purposes of the calculations described in paragraphs 38(b) to (h), CGML, and otherwise, Citibank, N.A., London Branch. The Calculation Agent shall make all calculations and determinations in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner. The Calculation Agent may in good faith make such amendment to, or supplement, the Conditions following the announcement or publication by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. of any provision, standard protocol or material relating to credit derivatives transactions which affects the Notes, the Credit Default Swap or any hedge transaction related to the Notes or the Swap Agreement entered into by the Issuer, the Swap Counterparty or any of its affiliates as the Calculation Agent determines appropriate to take into account the effect of such provision, standard protocol or material. 43 Dual Currency Notes: Not applicable 44 Partly-Paid Notes: Not applicable 38 45 Amortisation Yield (Zero Coupon Notes): Not applicable 46 Redemption at the option of the Issuer or other Issuer’s option (if applicable): Not applicable 47 Redemption at the option of the Noteholders or other Noteholders’ Option (if applicable): Not applicable 48 Issuer’s Option Period: Not applicable 49 Noteholders’ Option Period: Not applicable 50 Instalment Date(s) (if applicable): Not applicable 51 Instalment Amount(s) (if applicable): Not applicable 52 Unmatured Coupons to become void upon early redemption in full: Not applicable 53 Noteholders’ option to exchange Notes for the Net Asset Amount No 54 Talons to be attached to Notes and, if applicable, the number of Interest Payment Dates between the maturity of each Talon (Bearer Notes): Not applicable 55 Business Day Jurisdictions for Condition 8.8 (jurisdictions required to be open for payment): London, New York and Riyadh 56 Additional steps that may only be taken following approval by an Extraordinary Resolution in accordance with Condition 13.1 (if applicable): None 57 Details of any other additions or variations to the Conditions: A. Condition 7.9 (Redemption because of Ineligible Investors) shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “7.9 Redemption because of Ineligible Investors The Issuer may: (i) at any time, compel any beneficial owner of an interest in the Notes to certify that such beneficial 39 owner is not an Ineligible Investor; (ii) refuse to honour the transfer of an interest in a Note to the extent such transfer is to or for the benefit of an Ineligible Investor; and (iii) compel any beneficial owner of an interest in the Notes that is an Ineligible Investor to transfer such interest in the Notes to a Permitted Purchaser, or transfer such interest in the Notes to the Issuer or an affiliate of the Issuer at a price equal to the lesser of (x) the purchase price therefor paid by the beneficial owner, (y) 100 per cent. of the principal amount thereof and (z) the fair market value thereof. For the purposes of these Conditions, an “Ineligible Investor” means a person who is not (x) not a U.S. person (as such term is defined under Rule 902(k)(1) of Regulation S under the Securities Act), (y) a Non-United States person (as such term is defined under CFTC Rule 4.7) or (z) not a U.S. person (as defined in the credit risk retention regulations issued under Section 15G of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934) (any person who satisfies the conditions set forth in the immediately preceding clauses (x), (y) and (z), a “Permitted Purchaser”).” B. By purchasing the Notes, each Noteholder or beneficial owner of the Notes in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia shall be deemed to have represented to the Issuer and the Dealer that, pursuant to Article 13(c) of the Saudi Arabian Securities Business Regulations, they have been advised by an authorized person in relation to their purchase of the Notes. C. Condition 7.3.1 shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “7.3.1 If the Issuer (i) on the occasion of the next payment due in respect of the Notes, (a) would be required by the law of any authority of any jurisdiction to withhold, deduct or account for tax (except in the case of any such withholding, deduction of accounting arising on account of an Information Reporting Regime) or (b) would suffer tax in accordance with the law of any authority of any jurisdiction in respect of its income so that it would be unable to make payment of the full amount due or (ii) determines that any Noteholder, Couponholder or beneficial owner of Notes has failed to provide sufficient forms, documentation or other information requested in accordance with Condition 9.2 such that any payment received by the Issuer may be subject to a deduction or withholding or the Issuer may 40 suffer a fine or penalty, in each case, pursuant to an Information Reporting Regime, then the Issuer shall so inform the Trustee, and if an event described in paragraphs (i)(a) or (b) has occurred shall use its best endeavours (I) to arrange the substitution of a company incorporated in another jurisdiction approved beforehand in writing by the Trustee and any Swap Counterparty, Option Counterparty and Loan Counterparty in respect of any outstanding Notes as the principal obligor such that no deduction, withholding, or accounting described in (a) above shall be due with respect to payments on the Notes or tax on income described in (b) above would be suffered or (II) to change (to the satisfaction of the Trustee and any Swap Counterparty, Option Counterparty and Loan Counterparty in respect of any outstanding Notes) its residence for taxation purposes to another jurisdiction approved beforehand in writing by the Trustee and any such Swap Counterparty, Option Counterparty and Loan Counterparty (and provided that Rating Agency Affirmation has been received at the time of the proposed substitution or change from each Rating Agency (if any) then rating the outstanding Notes) such that no deduction, withholding or accounting described in (a) above shall be due with respect to payments on the Notes or tax on income described in (b) above would be suffered, and if it is unable to arrange such substitution or change before the next payment is due in respect of the Notes, or if an event described in paragraphs (ii) has occurred, the Issuer shall redeem all but not some only of the Notes; and/or” D. Condition 7.3.2 shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “7.3.2 if the Issuer (i) is or will be unable to receive any payment due in respect of the Initial Collateral forming part of the Mortgaged Property in full on the due date therefor without deduction for or on account of any withholding tax, back-up withholding or other tax, duties or charges of whatsoever nature imposed by any authority of any jurisdiction, (ii) is required to pay any tax, duty or charge of whatsoever nature in respect of any payment received in respect of the Initial Collateral forming part of the Mortgaged Property, (iii) is or will be unable to receive any payment due under the Swap Agreement in full on the due date therefor without deduction for or on account of any withholding tax, backup withholding or other tax, duties or charges of whatsoever nature, or (iv) is required to comply with any reporting requirement of any such authority (except in 41 any case where the Issuer is able to obtain such payment in full on the due date therefor or gain exemption from such payment or reporting requirement or comply with such reporting requirements by filing a declaration that it is not a resident of such jurisdiction and/or by executing any certificate, form or other document in order to make a claim under a double taxation treaty or other exemption available to it and such filing or execution does not involve any material expense and is not unduly onerous, or such reporting requirement does not involve any material expense and is not unduly onerous), in each case including where such tax, duty, charge or reporting requirement is imposed on account of an Information Reporting Regime, then the Issuer shall so inform the Trustee and the Issuer shall redeem all but not some only of the Notes save where Condition 7.3.4 (Disapplication of Conditions 7.3.1 and 7.3.2 and Information Reporting Regime Withholding) below applies; and/or” E. Condition 7.3.4 shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “7.3.4 Disapplication of Conditions 7.3.1 and 7.3.2 and Information Reporting Regime Withholding Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the requirement to withhold, deduct or account for any present or future taxes, duties or charges of whatsoever nature or any fine or penalty referred to in Conditions 7.3.1 or 7.3.2 above arises solely (i) due to the imposition of withholding in respect of payments due in respect of the Notes on account of an Information Reporting Regime, (ii) by reason of any Noteholder’s, Couponholder’s or beneficial owner of Notes’ connection with a relevant taxing jurisdiction otherwise than by reason only of the holding of any Note or receiving or being entitled to any payment in respect thereof or (iii) by reason of the failure of the relevant Noteholder, Couponholder or beneficial owner of Notes to comply with any applicable procedures required to establish non-residence or other similar claim for exemption from such tax including, without limitation, any failure to provide information or documentation requested in accordance with Condition 9.2 or to provide any waiver required by an Information Reporting Regime, then, to the extent the Issuer is able to deduct such taxes, duties, charges, fines or penalties, as applicable, from the amounts payable to such Noteholder or Couponholder without impairing payments to other Noteholders and Couponholders, Condition 7.3.1 or 7.3.2, as applicable, shall not apply and the Issuer shall deduct such taxes, duties, charges, fines or 42 penalties, as applicable, from the amounts payable to such Noteholder or Couponholder and all other Noteholders and Couponholders shall receive the due amounts payable to them and the Issuer shall not redeem the Notes pursuant to Condition 7.3.1 or 7.3.2, as applicable. Any such deduction shall not be an Event of Default under Condition 11.” F. Condition 9.1 (Withholding and Deductions) shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “9.1 Withholding and Deductions All payments of principal and interest by the Issuer in respect of the Notes and Coupons will be made subject to any withholding or deduction for, or on account of, any withholding tax. Any such deduction shall not be an Event of Default under Condition 11. In the event of the imposition of any withholding taxes other than on account of an Information Reporting Regime on payments in respect of the Notes, the Issuer will use its best endeavours to (i) arrange for the substitution of its obligations by a company incorporated in another jurisdiction or (ii) to change its residence for taxation purposes to another jurisdiction approved by the Trustee, in each case such that no deduction or withholding shall be due with respect to payments on the Notes, as contemplated in Condition 7.3.1.” 58 The Agents appointed in respect of the Notes are: Citibank, N.A., London Branch Citigroup Centre Canada Square Canary Wharf London E14 5LB as Issuing and Calculation Agent Paying Agent, Transfer Agent Citigroup Global Markets Limited Citigroup Centre Canada Square Canary Wharf London E14 5LB as Calculation Agent and Disposal Agent Citigroup Global Markets Deutschland AG Agency and Trust Department Reuterweg 16 60323 Frankfurt Germany as Registrar Arthur Cox Listing Services Limited Earlsfort Centre Earlsfort Terrace 43 and Dublin 2 Ireland as Irish Listing Agent 59 Purchase by the Issuer of Notes: The Issuer may purchase Notes 60 Settlement method: Delivery free of payment Provisions applicable to Global Notes and Certificates 61 How Notes will be represented on issue: Global Certificate 62 Applicable TEFRA exemption: Not applicable 63 Whether Temporary/ Permanent Global Note/ Global Certificate is exchangeable for Definitive Notes/Individual Certificates at the request of the holder: Yes, in limited circumstances, for Individual Certificates. 64 New Global Note: No 65 Intended to be held in a manner which would allow Eurosystem eligibility: No. Whilst the designation is specified as “no” at the date of this Series Prospectus, should the Eurosystem eligibility criteria be amended in the future such that the Notes are capable of meeting them the Notes may then be deposited with one of the ICSDs as common safekeeper (and registered in the name of a nominee of one of the ICSDs acting as common safekeeper). Note that this does not necessarily mean that the Notes will then be recognised as eligible collateral for Eurosystem monetary policy and intra day credit operations by the Eurosystem at any time during their life. Such recognition will depend upon the ECB being satisfied that Eurosystem eligibility criteria have been met. Provisions relating only to the sale and listing of the Notes 66 Details of any additions or variations to the Dealer Agreement: Not applicable 67 (i) Listing and admission to trading: This Series Prospectus has been approved by the Central Bank of Ireland (the “Central Bank”), as competent authority under Directive 2003/71/EC (as amended). The Central Bank only approves this Series Prospectus as meeting the requirements imposed under Irish and EU law pursuant to the Prospectus Directive. Application has been made to the Irish Stock Exchange for the Notes to be admitted to the Official List and admitted to trading on its regulated market. (ii) Estimate of total All such expenses are being paid by the Dealer. 44 expenses related to admission to trading: 68 Dealers’ commission (if applicable): None. 69 Method of Issue: Individual Dealer 70 The following Dealer is subscribing to the Notes: CGML 71 Rating (if applicable): Not applicable The Security Arrangements 72 Mortgaged Property: Initial Collateral: See Annex 2. Security (order of priorities): See Annex 2. The Trustee shall apply the Available Proceeds in accordance with one of the following orders of priority: (i) if the Notes are being redeemed early directly as a result of a Swap Counterparty Default, Noteholder Priority; or (ii) if the Notes are being redeemed in circumstances other than those outlined in paragraph 72(b)(i) above or the security in respect of the Notes has become enforceable for any other reason, Counterparty Priority A. Noteholders should understand that the validity and enforceability of provisions such as paragraph 72(b) have been the subject of caselaw in the English and U.S. courts – see “Priority of claims” risk factor in “Risk Factors” above. Swap Agreement (if applicable): See Annexes 3, 4 and 5 Swap Counterparty(ies): Citigroup Global Markets Limited, whose registered office is Citigroup Centre, Canada Square, Canary Wharf, London E14 5LB. Credit Support Annex: Not applicable Option Agreement (if applicable): Not applicable Option Counterparty(ies) Not applicable Details of Credit Support Document (if applicable): Not applicable Credit Support Provider: Not applicable 45 73 Details of Securities Lending Agreement (if applicable): Not applicable Loan Counterparty(ies): Not applicable Noteholder Substitution of Initial Collateral: Not Applicable 46 Annex 1 Defined Terms “Business Day” means a day on which commercial banks and foreign exchange markets settle payments and are open for general business (including dealings in foreign exchange and foreign currency deposits) in London and New York. “Cash Settlement Entitlement” means, in respect of each Note outstanding, a pro rata share of (a) the net realised proceeds of the sale of the Collateral (where applicable) together with any other cash then held by or on behalf of the Issuer (or the relevant proportion thereof, in each case converted, where necessary, into USD at the then prevailing exchange rate), plus (where the same is due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) or, as the case may be, minus (where the same is due from the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty) (b) the Swap Termination Value (if applicable), minus (c) the Auction Settlement Amount or the Cash Settlement Amount (as applicable), plus (d) the Final Fixed Amount (as defined in the Credit Default Swap), minus (e) the Unwind Costs, subject to a minimum of zero (rounded to the nearest USD 0.01, half of USD 0.01 being rounded downwards). Notes held by a Noteholder shall be aggregated for the purposes of determining the aggregate Cash Settlement Entitlement of that Noteholder. “Credit Linkage End Date” means the Scheduled Termination Date (as defined in the Credit Default Swap). “Credit Linkage Start Date” means the Trade Date (as defined in the Credit Default Swap). “Early Redemption Amount” means, in respect of each Note outstanding on the relevant Early Redemption Date, an amount in USD determined by the Calculation Agent acting in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner as being equal to a pro rata share of: (i) if the Notes are being redeemed pursuant to Conditions 7.3 or 11 directly as a result of a Swap Counterparty Default, the lower of: (A) (I) the net realised proceeds of the sale of the Collateral (where applicable) together with any other cash then held by or on behalf of the Issuer (in each case converted, were necessary, into USD at the then prevailing exchange rate); plus (II) (only where the same is due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) the Swap Termination Value; and (B) (I) the outstanding principal amount of the Notes; plus (II) any accrued but unpaid interest on the Notes; or (ii) if the Notes are being redeemed in circumstances other than those outlined in subparagraph (i) above, (A) the net realised proceeds of the sale of the Collateral (where applicable) together with any other cash then held by or on behalf of the Issuer (in each case converted, where necessary, into USD at the then prevailing exchange rate) plus (where the same is due from the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer) or, as the case may be, minus (where the same is due from the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty) (B) the Swap Termination Value (if applicable), minus (C) the Unwind Costs, in each case subject to a minimum of zero (rounded to the nearest USD 0.01, half of USD 0.01 being rounded downwards). Notes held by a Noteholder shall be aggregated for the purposes of determining the aggregate Early Redemption Amount in respect of the Notes of that Noteholder. “Swap Counterparty Default” means an Event of Default (as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) in respect of which the Defaulting Party (as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) is the Swap Counterparty. 47 “Swap Termination Value” means the aggregate of the early termination payments due from or payable to the Swap Counterparty under the Swap Agreement, the calculation of which is described under “Consequences of Early Termination” in Annex 3. For the avoidance of doubt, if an Event Determination Date under the Credit Default Swap has occurred and has not been subsequently reversed prior to the occurrence of the Auction Final Price Determination Date, Valuation Date or Termination Date (as applicable) in accordance with the Credit Default Swap, the Swap Termination Value shall ignore the Credit Default Swap (which shall terminate following payment of the Auction Settlement Amount (or Cash Settlement Amount, if applicable) and the Final Fixed Amount) and shall comprise the early termination payment for the Asset Swap calculated in accordance with Section 6(e) of the Swap Agreement. For the avoidance of doubt, the Swap Termination Value will be calculated in the currency in which the Notes are denominated and may be zero. “Unwind Costs” means the fees, costs, charges, expenses and liabilities incurred by the Swap Counterparty and the Issuer in connection with the early redemption of the Notes. 48 Annex 2 Security and Collateral Description of the Collateral On the Issue Date, the Issuer purchased the Initial Collateral. The “Initial Collateral” in respect of the Notes comprises USD 35,000,000 in principal amount of the USD 1,000,000,000 4.375% Notes due 2026 issued by Abu Dhabi National Energy Company PJSC and having the ISIN number XS1435072464. The Initial Collateral constitutes the “Collateral” as at the Issue Date and, at any time thereafter, the “Collateral” shall include any other securities, cash or other assets or property derived therefrom or delivered to the Issuer and held by the Custodian for the account of the Issuer at such time. Initial Collateral The following summary of the Initial Collateral is qualified by reference to the detailed terms and conditions of the Initial Collateral. Title: 4.375% Notes due 2026 Collateral Issuer: Abu Dhabi National Energy Company PJSC Country of Incorporation: United Arab Emirates Principal Address of Collateral Issuer: Levels 23-25, Al Maqam Tower, Abu Dhabi Global Market Square, Al Maryah Island, P.O. Box 5524, Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates Principal Business of Collateral Issuer: Abu Dhabi National Energy Company PJSC is the holding company for a diversified international energy group headquartered in the Emirate of Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates. Principal Amount: USD 1,000,000,000 Denomination: USD 200,000 plus integral multiples of USD 1,000 in excess thereof Issue Date: 22 June 2016 Final Maturity Date: 22 June 2026 Interest Rate: 4.375 per cent. per annum Interest Payment Date: 22 June and 22 December in each year, commencing on 22 December 2016 Listing: The Initial Collateral was listed on the regulated market of the London Stock Exchange with effect from 22 June 2016. Governing law: English law ISIN: XS1435072464 Common Code: 143507246 49 Ratings: As at the Issue Date of the Notes, the Initial Collateral was rated “A3” by Moody’s and “BBB+” by S&P. The Collateral Issuer has been assigned long-term unsecured senior debt ratings of “A3 (stable outlook)” by Moody’s and “A- (negative outlook)” by S&P. Each of Moody’s and S&P is a credit rating agency established in the European Community or registered in the European Community under the CRA Regulations. Ranking: The Initial Collateral and any related coupons constitute senior unsecured obligations of the Collateral Issuer. Security Arrangements Subject as set out below, the obligations of the Issuer under the Notes are secured pursuant to the Trust Deed by: (i) a first fixed charge over the Collateral in favour of the Trustee; (ii) an assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee of all the Issuer’s rights, title and interest attaching to or relating to the Collateral and all sums derived therefrom including, without limitation, any right to delivery thereof or to an equivalent number or nominal value thereof which arises in connection with any such assets being held in a clearing system or through a financial intermediary; (iii) an assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee of the Issuer’s rights, title and interest against the Custodian and the Disposal Agent, to the extent that they relate to the Collateral; (iv) an assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee of the Issuer’s rights, title and interest under and in respect of the Agency Agreement, to the extent that they relate to the Notes and all sums derived therefrom in respect of the Notes; (v) an assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee of the Issuer’s rights, title and interest under and in respect of the Custody Agreement, to the extent that they relate to the Notes; (vi) an assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee of the Issuer’s rights, title and interest under the Swap Agreement and in respect of any sums received thereunder; and (vii) a first fixed charge in favour of the Trustee of (a) all sums held by the Issuing and Paying Agent and the Custodian to meet payments due in respect of the obligations and duties of the Issuer under the Trust Deed, the Swap Agreement, the Agency Agreement, the Custody Agreement and the Notes, (b) all sums held by the Disposal Agent under the Agency Agreement and (c) any sums received by the Issuing and Paying Agent under the Swap Agreement, (the rights and assets of the Issuer referred to in this paragraph being the “Mortgaged Property”). In circumstances where Collateral is held by or through the Custodian in a clearing system, the security will take the form of an assignment of the Issuer’s contractual rights against the Custodian rather than a charge over such Collateral. A charge, although expressed in words which would suffice to create a fixed charge, may be treated as a floating charge, particularly if it appears that it was intended that the chargor should 50 have licence to dispose of the assets charged in the course of its business without the consent of the chargee. The Disposal Agent, acting on behalf of the Issuer, may procure the realisation of the equivalent proportion of the Collateral in connection with any purchase and cancellation of the Notes by the Issuer in accordance with Condition 7.4 (Purchases) and Condition 7.10 (Cancellation). In the event that the Mortgaged Property described above is realised by the Trustee on behalf of the Noteholders, there can be no assurance that the proceeds of realisation thereof will be sufficient to repay the principal amount and any other amount that is due under the Notes. The Custodian A description of the Custodian is set out in the section entitled “Description of Citibank, N.A.” in the Base Prospectus. 51 Annex 3 The Swap Agreement The description of the Swap Agreement set out below is a summary of certain features of the Swap Agreement and is qualified by reference to the detailed provisions of the Swap Agreement. Payments under the Swap Agreement Under a 2002 ISDA Master Agreement deemed entered into between the Issuer and the Swap Counterparty and dated as of the Issue Date (including the Schedule (as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) in the form of Part A of the Swap Terms (August 2016 Version) relating to the Programme (as such Schedule may have been amended by the Swap Confirmations)) as may be amended and/or supplemented from time to time (the “ISDA Master Agreement”), the Issuer and the Swap Counterparty have entered into a swap confirmation (the “Credit Default Swap Confirmation”) which constitutes a credit default swap transaction with an effective date of the Issue Date of the Notes (the “Credit Default Swap”) (into which the 2014 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions are incorporated by reference) a swap confirmation (the “Asset Swap Confirmation” and together with the Credit Default Swap Confirmation, the “Swap Confirmations”) which constitutes an asset swap transaction with an effective date of the Issue Date of the Notes (the “Asset Swap”) (into which the 2006 ISDA Definitions are incorporated by reference) (the ISDA Master Agreement together with the Swap Confirmations, the “Swap Agreement”). Under the Credit Default Swap, the Issuer shall be paid the Fixed Rate on the Fixed Rate Payer Payment Dates by the Swap Counterparty. Pursuant to the Credit Default Swap, the Swap Counterparty has the right to exercise the credit event provisions under the Credit Default Swap immediately upon (and, subject as set out below, at any time subsequent to) the occurrence of a Credit Event during the period from and including the Credit Linkage Start Date to and including the Credit Linkage End Date (or, in certain circumstances, after the Credit Linkage End Date if a Potential Failure to Pay exists on the Credit Linkage End Date, or a Potential Repudiation/Moratorium exists on the Credit Linkage End Date). When serving notice of the occurrence of a Credit Event, the Swap Counterparty may provide the Issuer with the Notice of Publicly Available Information (it will not need to do so if a Credit Derivatives Determinations Committee resolves that a Credit Event has occurred). On the fifth Business Day (or such other number of Business Days specified in respect of the relevant Auction in the “Transaction Auction Settlement Terms” published by ISDA in respect of the Auction) following the determination of the Auction Final Price, the Issuer will pay the Swap Counterparty an amount that is the greater of (a) an amount equal in USD to the product of (i) the outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes and (ii) the Reference Price minus the Auction Final Price; and (b) zero. Under the Asset Swap, the Swap Counterparty will pay to the Issuer periodic amounts equal to the interest and principal payable under the Notes and the Issuer will pay to the Swap Counterparty periodic amounts equal to the scheduled interest and principal receivable on the Collateral and the amounts payable by the Swap Counterparty to the Issuer under the Credit Default Swap. In addition, other than following the occurrence of an Event Determination Date under the Credit Default Swap (in which case see “Termination of the Swap Agreement following a Credit Event“ below) the Issuer will pay to the Swap Counterparty (or the Swap Counterparty will pay to the Issuer, as the case may be) the termination amounts in connection with the termination of the Swap Agreement whether in whole or in part (as further described in “Consequences of Early Termination” below). 52 Termination of the Swap Agreement Except as stated in the following paragraphs or following the occurrence of an Event Determination Date under the Credit Default Swap, the Credit Default Swap is scheduled to terminate on 22 June 2026 and the Asset Swap is scheduled to terminate on the Maturity Date of the Notes. The Swap Agreement may be terminated (either in whole or in part only), among other circumstances: (i) if at any time any of the Notes becomes payable in accordance with the Conditions prior to the Maturity Date, other than as a result of the Swap Agreement itself having already terminated; (ii) if the Issuer or the Calculation Agent determines that the performance of the Issuer’s obligations under the Notes has or will become unlawful, illegal or otherwise prohibited in whole or in part, including without limitation, as a result of an enactment of or supplement or amendment to, or a change in law, policy or official interpretation, implementation or determination made by any relevant regulatory authority or for any other reason; (iii) if at any time the Swap Counterparty determines that the performance of the Swap Counterparty’s and/or its Affiliates’ obligations under the Swap Agreement, the Trust Deed or under any other Transaction Document or any arrangement made to hedge such obligations has or will become unlawful, illegal or otherwise prohibited due to a Regulatory Consequence (as defined in the Conditions) and that, if applicable, a transfer of the Swap Agreement to an Affiliate of the Swap Counterparty will not be timely, practical or desirable for any reason, all determined in its sole and absolute discretion; (iv) at the option of one party, if there is a failure by the other party to pay any amounts due, or to comply with or perform any obligation, under the Swap Agreement; (v) if withholding taxes are imposed on any of the payments made either by the Issuer or by the Swap Counterparty under the Swap Agreement or it becomes illegal for either party to perform its obligations under any Transaction under the Swap Agreement (see “Transfer to avoid Termination Event” below); (vi) upon the occurrence of certain other events with respect to either party to the Swap Agreement, including insolvency or, in respect of the Swap Counterparty, a merger without an assumption of the obligations in respect of the Swap Agreement; or if either of the Credit Default Swap or the Asset Swap is terminated early for whatever reason, the other swap transaction shall automatically terminate. Consequences of Early Termination Upon any early termination of the Swap Agreement in the circumstances set out in sub-paragraphs (i) to (vii) above and the designation of an Early Termination Date, the Issuer or the Swap Counterparty may be liable to make a termination payment to the other (regardless, if applicable, of which of the parties may have caused such termination). Such termination payments will be based on the replacement cost or gain for a swap agreement that would have the effect of preserving for the party making the determination the economic equivalent of the Swap Agreement. Such termination amounts shall also include amounts that are either unpaid as at the Early Termination Date (as defined in the Swap Agreement) or represent the fair market value of any obligation that was required to have been performed under the Swap Agreement had it not been terminated on the relevant Early Termination Date (as defined in the Swap Agreement). In 53 addition, any fees, costs, charges, expenses and liabilities incurred by the Swap Counterparty and the Issuer in connection with the early redemption of the Notes shall be deducted. In all cases of early termination, the termination payment will be determined by the Swap Counterparty. General Except as stated under “Transfer to avoid Termination Event” and “Transfer by the Swap Counterparty to its Affiliates” below, neither the Issuer nor the Swap Counterparty are, save for the assignment by way of security in favour of the Trustee under the Trust Deed and certain limited circumstances set out in Section 7 (Transfer) of the ISDA Master Agreement, permitted to assign, novate or transfer as a whole or in part any of their rights, obligations or interests under the Swap Agreement. Sanctions Upon the occurrence of a Sanctions Event as defined in Condition 8.9 (Suspension of Obligations following a Sanctions Event) of the Notes, all obligations will be suspended under the Swap Agreement. Taxation The Issuer is not obliged under the Swap Agreement to gross up if withholding taxes or other deductions for taxes are imposed on payments made by it under the Swap Agreement. The Swap Counterparty is not obliged under the Swap Agreement to gross up if withholding taxes or other deductions for taxes are imposed on payments made by it under the Swap Agreement, unless the relevant tax is an “Indemnifiable Tax”. Transfer to avoid Termination Event If withholding taxes are imposed on payments made by the Issuer or the Swap Counterparty under the Swap Agreement, then the Swap Counterparty shall, at its sole option, have the right to require the Issuer: (a) to transfer all of its interest and obligations under the Swap Agreement together with its interests and obligations under the Notes, the Trust Deed, the Dealer Agreement and the Agency Agreement to another entity, whether or not in the same tax jurisdiction as the Issuer, which would not have any obligation to withhold or deduct (if the Issuer is or would be required to make such withholding or deduction) or to which the Swap Counterparty would be entitled to make payments free from the relevant withholding or deduction and/or not to be subject to any gross-up obligations (if the Swap Counterparty is or would otherwise be required to make such withholding or deduction), subject to obtaining the prior written consent of the Trustee; or (b) to transfer its residence for tax purposes to another jurisdiction such that no withholding taxes would be due with respect to payments on the Swap Agreement, subject to obtaining the prior written consent of the Trustee. If the Issuer is unable to transfer its interests to another party or to transfer its tax residence in accordance with the preceding provisions prior to the 30th calendar day following the date of imposition of such withholding taxes or, if earlier, the 10th calendar day prior to the first date on which it or the Swap Counterparty would otherwise be required to make a payment net of withholding taxes or subject to gross-up, the Swap Counterparty may terminate the swap transaction under the Swap Agreement. 54 Transfer by the Swap Counterparty to its Affiliates The Swap Counterparty may, at any time, at its own expense and without the need for the consent of the Issuer, transfer (by way of an assignment or novation) all or part of its interests and obligations in and under the Swap Agreement together with its interests and obligations under the Notes, the Trust Deed, the Dealer Agreement, the Custody Agreement, the Agency Agreement and any other Transaction Document to any of its Affiliates (the “Transferee”) upon providing at least five Business Days prior written notice to the Issuer and the Trustee provided that: (a) as of the date of such transfer, the Issuer will not, as a result of such transfer, be entitled to receive from the Transferee on any payment date specified under the Swap Agreement an amount less than an amount that would be received from the Swap Counterparty in the absence of such transfer (in each case, taking into account any Taxes (as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) required to be withheld or deducted as well as amounts payable under Section 2(d)(i)(4) of the ISDA Master Agreement); (b) no Event of Default, Potential Event of Default or Termination Event (each as defined in the ISDA Master Agreement) is then continuing as of the date of such transfer or would result from such transfer; (c) no additional amount will be payable by the Issuer to the Swap Counterparty or the Transferee on the next succeeding scheduled payment date under the Swap Agreement as a result of such transfer (d) there is an ISDA commissioned legal netting opinion and, if applicable, collateral opinion for the jurisdiction of organisation of the Transferee which confirms the application of closeout netting in respect of the organisational form taken by the Transferee; (e) the Swap Counterparty or other acceptable Affiliate will provide a written guarantee of the obligations of the Transferee if at the time of such transfer, the Transferee’s long term, unsecured debt rating assigned by Moody’s Investors Service Inc. and by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., is less than the ratings assigned to Swap Counterparty at the time of such transfer (and for purposes hereof, in the event of a split rating, the lower rating shall be determinative); and (f) the Swap Counterparty will be responsible for all reasonable costs and expenses, including reasonable counsel fees, incurred by Issuer in connection with such transfer. Provided that the criteria set out in (a) to (f) above are satisfied, no consent shall be required from the Issuer or the Trustee to such transfer and the Issuer and Trustee shall promptly take such action and execute all documentation as the Swap Counterparty may reasonably require to effect such transfer. Description of the Reference Entity The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia is located in the Middle East, and shares borders with Jordan, Iraq, Kuwait, Bahrain, Qatar, the United Arab Emirates, Oman and Yemen. Natural resources include petroleum, natural gas, iron ore, gold and copper. The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia’s capital is Riyadh. The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia has securities admitted to trading on the regulated market of the Irish Stock Exchange. 55 EMIR Portfolio Reconciliation and Dispute Resolution Deed The Issuer and the Swap Counterparty have entered into an EMIR Portfolio Reconciliation and Dispute Resolution Deed dated 3 April 2014 as amended and restated on 28 May 2014 to comply with the portfolio reconciliation and dispute resolution requirements of Regulation (EU) No 648/2012 of the European Parliament and of the Council on OTC derivatives, central counterparties and trade repositories dated 4 July 2012. 56 Annex 4 Form of the Credit Default Swap Confirmation Set out below is the form of the Credit Default Swap Confirmation Date: 10 May 2017 To: Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company From: Citigroup Global Markets Limited Re: Credit Derivative Transaction relating to Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company Series No: 2017-02 USD 35,000,000 Fixed Rate The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Credit Linked Notes due 2026 (the “Notes”) (Ref: LEMA3C10735783). Dear Sirs, The purpose of this letter agreement (the “Confirmation”) is to confirm the terms and conditions of the Transaction entered into between us on the first day on which this Confirmation has been signed by both Party A and Party B (the “Transaction”, and such date the “Signing Date”). This Confirmation constitutes a “Confirmation” as referred to in the 2002 ISDA Master Agreement specified below. The definitions and provisions contained in the 2014 ISDA Credit Derivatives Definitions, as supplemented by the 2014 Sovereign No Asset Package Delivery Supplement (the “Credit Derivatives Definitions”), as published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., as amended herein, are incorporated into this Confirmation. In the event of any inconsistency between the Credit Derivatives Definitions and this Confirmation, this Confirmation will govern. This Confirmation supplements, forms a part of, and is subject to the 2002 ISDA Master Agreement dated the Issue Date (the “Agreement”) deemed entered into between Citigroup Global Markets Limited (“Party A”) and Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company (formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited) (“Party B”) in respect of which the Schedule to such 2002 ISDA Master Agreement is in the form of the ISDA Schedule Terms (August 2016 Version). All provisions contained in the Agreement govern this Confirmation except as expressly modified below. Party A and Party B have entered into a related asset swap transaction by means of a confirmation under the Agreement on the Effective Date (the “Asset Swap”). Party A represents and warrants that it has the capacity and power to enter into this Agreement and that the entry into this Agreement has been validly authorised, executed and delivered by it. Capitalised terms used but not defined herein will have the meanings given to them in (or incorporated by reference into) the Information Memorandum dated 9 May 2017, as amended and supplemented from time to time, relating to the issue of the Notes (the “Information Memorandum”). In this Confirmation, the “Conditions” refers to the terms and conditions of the Notes as set out in or incorporated by reference into the Information Memorandum. In the event of any inconsistency between terms defined in this Confirmation and the corresponding terms in the Conditions, the terms as defined in the Conditions shall govern. In the event of any inconsistency between terms defined in this Confirmation and the corresponding terms in the Asset Swap, the terms as defined in this Confirmation shall govern. 57 The terms of the Transaction to which this Confirmation relates are as follows: 1 General Terms Trade Date: 27 April 2017. Notwithstanding Section 1.5 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions, the Parties agree that they have entered into the Transaction to which this Confirmation relates on the Signing Date. Effective Date: 10 May 2017 Scheduled Termination Date: 22 June 2026 Floating Rate Payer: Party B Fixed Rate Payer Party A Calculation Agent: Party A Calculation Agent City: London Business Days: London and New York Business Day Convention: Modified Following (which subject to Sections 1.14, 1.39, 2.2(k), 3.33(a) and 12.10 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions, shall apply to any date referred to in the Confirmation that falls on a day that is not a Business Day). Reference Entity: The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and any Successor Standard Reference Obligation: Applicable Seniority Level: Senior Level Transaction Type: Emerging European & Middle Eastern Sovereign All Guarantees: As set out in the Credit Derivatives Physical Settlement Matrix (the “ISDA Matrix”) corresponding to the relevant Transaction Type. 2 Fixed Payments Fixed Rate Payer Calculation Amount: Initially USD 35,000,000 and thereafter the Principal Amount of the Notes from time to time. Fixed Rate Payer Period End Date(s): Each Interest Period Date in respect of the Notes up to and including the Interest Period Date immediately preceding the Event Determination Date (if any), and such Event Determination Date (if any), which are not subject to adjustment in accordance with any Business Day Convention. Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date(s): Notwithstanding Section 12.11 of the Credit Derivative Definitions, each Fixed Rate Payer Period End Date, subject to adjustment in accordance with the Following Business Day Convention, provided that if an Event Determination Date occurs, the final Fixed Rate Payer 58 Payment Date shall be the Auction Settlement Date or Cash Settlement Date (as applicable). The Fixed Amount payable on the final Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date shall be referred to as the “Final Fixed Amount”. For the avoidance of doubt, if there is any delay in the payment of the Final Fixed Amount after the Scheduled Termination Date, no additional amount shall be payable by Party A. Fixed Rate: 0.50 per cent. per annum. If, on or prior to a Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date, Party A determines that a Credit Event may have occurred prior to such Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date, Party A may notify Party B thereof and payment of the Fixed Amount by Party A to Party B on such Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date shall be suspended until Party A confirms whether or not a Credit Event has occurred. If Party A confirms that no Credit Event has occurred, Party A will pay to Party B the Fixed Amount that was originally due to have been paid on the Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date two Business Days after it makes such confirmation, and no interest shall be payable in respect of such postponement. Fixed Rate Day Count Fraction: 3 Actual/360 Floating Amounts Floating Rate Payer Calculation Amount: Initially USD 35,000,000 and thereafter the Principal Amount of the Notes from time to time. Notifying Party: Party A Notice of Publicly Available Information: Applicable provided that if a DC Credit Event Announcement has occurred, the Notice of Publicly Available Information is deemed to have been satisfied. Specified Number of Public Sources: Two The parties agree that, subject to Sections 1.19 and 10.2 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions, an Event Determination Date may occur on one occasion only with respect to each Reference Entity except in certain circumstances following a Succession Date. “Credit Event Notice” means a notice (which Party A has the right but not the obligation to deliver) from Party A (which may be oral including by telephone to be confirmed in writing) to Party B (with a copy to the Issuing and Paying Agent) during the Notice Delivery Period (or any other period permissible pursuant to the terms of the Credit Default Swap) that describes a Credit Event that occurred on or after the Credit Linkage 59 Start Date to and including the Extension Date or (if applicable and earlier) the Early Redemption Date, each as determined by reference to Greenwich Mean Time. Any Credit Event Notice that describes a Credit Event that occurred after the Scheduled Termination Date must relate to the relevant Potential Failure to Pay, in the case of a Grace Period Extension Date, or the relevant Potential Repudiation/Moratorium, in the case of a Repudiation/Moratorium Evaluation Date. A Credit Event Notice must contain a description in reasonable detail of the facts relevant to the determination that a Credit Event has occurred. The Credit Event that is the subject of the Credit Event Notice need not be continuing on the date the Credit Event Notice is effective. If a Credit Event Notice contains the information required in the Notice of Publicly Available Information, such Credit Event Notice shall be deemed to be both a Credit Event Notice and a Notice of Publicly Available Information. Credit Events: As set out in the ISDA Matrix corresponding to the relevant Transaction Type. Obligation Category: As set out in the ISDA Matrix corresponding to the relevant Transaction Type. Obligation Characteristics: As set out in the ISDA Matrix corresponding to the relevant Transaction Type. Excluded Obligations: For the purposes of Section 3.6(a) of the Credit Derivatives Definitions: None 4 Settlement Terms Settlement Method: Auction Settlement Fallback Settlement Method: Cash Settlement Reference Price: 100 per cent. Terms relating to Auction Settlement: Auction Settlement Date: Five Business Days following the determination of the Auction Final Price. Auction Settlement Amount: The greater of: an amount in USD equal to the product of (i) the Floating Rate Payer Calculation Amount and (ii) the Reference Price minus the Auction Final Price; and 60 zero. Terms relating to Cash Settlement (if applicable) Valuation Obligation: Any obligation of the Reference Entity chosen by the Calculation Agent in its sole discretion pursuant to Section 3.2 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions, for which purpose the Deliverable Obligation Category and Deliverable Obligation Characteristics are set out in the ISDA Matrix corresponding to the relevant Transaction Type and there are no Excluded Deliverable Obligations specified for the purposes of Section 3.7(a) of the Credit Derivatives Definitions. References in Article VII of the Credit Derivatives Definitions to “Reference Obligation” shall be construed as references to “Valuation Obligation”. Valuation Date: Single Valuation Date: the Business Day selected by the Calculation Agent in its sole discretion (the “Scheduled Valuation Date”), provided that such Business Day shall be no earlier than forty-five (45) Business Days and no later than sixty (60) Business Days after the relevant Event Determination Date, provided that if the Calculation Agent in its sole discretion considers that all of the Valuation Obligation(s) with respect to the Reference Entity outstanding on the relevant Event Determination Date are reasonably likely to cease to exist prior to the date that is forty-five (45) Business Days after the relevant Event Determination Date, the Calculation Agent may designate, as the Valuation Date, an earlier date. Valuation Time: Any time (as selected by the Calculation Agent in its sole discretion) on the applicable Valuation Date during the hours that the Dealers customarily quote prices for the relevant Valuation Obligation. Quotation Method: Bid Quotation Amount: An amount selected by the Calculation Agent greater than or equal to USD 1,000,000 subject to a maximum of 100 per cent. of the Floating Rate Payer Calculation Amount, or the equivalent in the applicable currency selected by the Calculation Agent in its sole discretion. Valuation Method: If there is only one Valuation Obligation, Highest, or if there is more than one Valuation Obligation, Blended Highest. Where “Blended Highest” means the weighted arithmetic mean of the highest Quotations obtained by the Calculation Agent for each Valuation Obligation on the Valuation Date. 61 Settlement Currency: USD Quotations: Each Full Quotation or other quotation, excluding accrued interest, expressed as a percentage of the Valuation Obligation’s Outstanding Principal Balance or Due and Payable Amount, as applicable, with respect to a Valuation Date. The Calculation Agent shall attempt to obtain Full Quotations from at least five Dealers (which may include Party A) on the Scheduled Valuation Date. If fewer than five Full Quotations are available, but at least two Full Quotations are available, the Calculation Agent shall determine the Final Price on the basis of the available Full Quotations. If at least two Full Quotations are not available on the Scheduled Valuation Date, but a Weighted Average Quotation is available then such Weighted Average Quotation will be used, on the Valuation Date, to determine the Final Price. If neither two Full Quotations nor a Weighted Average Quotation are available on the Valuation Date, but a single Full Quotation is available, such single Full Quotation will be used with respect to the Valuation Date, to determine the Final Price. If a single Full Quotation is also not available, but one or more firm quotations for an amount equal to or less than the Minimum Quotation Amount is available, then the weighted average of such firm quotations with respect to the aggregate portion of the Quotation Amount for which such quotations were obtained and a quotation deemed to be zero for the balance of the Quotation Amount for which firm quotations were not obtained will be used on the Scheduled Valuation Date to determine the Final Price. If one or more firm quotations for an amount equal to or less than the Minimum Quotation Amount are not available, the Quotation will be zero. Where a Quotation is sought in respect of a Valuation Obligation which is a Consent Required Loan, the Calculation Agent shall, to the extent practicable in connection with any requests for quotations in respect of such Valuation Obligation, inform the Dealers of the identity of the debtor, the governing law and jurisdiction of the relevant loan documentation, details of any guarantee and/or security, the main covenants contained within the relevant loan documentation, the maturity date of the loan and any amortisation, the interest rate of the loan, whether the loan is a revolving loan or a term loan, the amounts if any drawn down under the loan, any conditions to transfer and the date of the relevant loan agreement subject to not thereby breaching any duty of confidentiality the Calculation 62 Agent or any Affiliate thereof may owe in respect of such Consent Required Loan. Any firm bid quotations received from Dealers in respect of such Valuation Obligation shall be treated as firm bid quotations notwithstanding that the Dealers express such firm bid quotations as being subject to the loan documentation. For the purposes of this Transaction, the last sentence of Section 7.4 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions shall not apply. Dealer: A dealer in obligations of the type of the Valuation Obligation for which Quotations are to be obtained as selected by the Calculation Agent in its sole and absolute discretion, which may include the Calculation Agent or any one Affiliate of the Calculation Agent (including Party A). Cash Settlement Date: Five Business Days following the Valuation Date. Cash Settlement Amount: The greater of: an amount in USD payable equal to the product of (i) the Floating Rate Payer Calculation Amount and (ii) the Reference Price minus the Final Price; and zero. 5 Amendments to the Credit Derivatives Definitions and Additional Definitions Section 1.19 (No Event Determination Date) of the Credit Derivatives Definitions: Section 1.19 shall be amended by the insertion of the words “the Notifying Party has the option, in its sole discretion, to retract a Credit Event Notice and” after the words “Subject to Section 10.2(a)(i)(III),” in the first line thereto. Fixed Payments: Section 12.9(b) of the Credit Derivatives Definitions shall be deleted and substituted with the following: “(b) the final Fixed Rate Payer Calculation Period will end on, but include, the earlier to occur of the Scheduled Termination Date and the Fixed Rate Payer Period End Date immediately preceding the Event Determination Date.” Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Credit Derivatives Definitions, no further Fixed Amounts shall be payable by the Fixed Rate Payer pursuant to this Transaction following the occurrence of an Event Determination Date, to the extent that such Event Determination Date is not subsequently reversed prior to the Auction Final Price Determination Date, Valuation Date or Termination Date. If this Transaction terminates other than as a result of the occurrence of an Event 63 Determination Date, any accrued and unpaid Fixed Amount as at such early termination date shall be taken into account when determining the future cash flows of the Transaction in respect of what would have been due on the next following Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date had the early termination not occurred. Section 11.4 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions: Section 11.4 of the Credit Derivatives Definitions shall not apply to this Transaction. Potential Credit Event Notice: If the Buyer determines in its sole and absolute discretion that a Credit Event may have occurred in the period from and including the Credit Linkage Start Date (as defined in the Conditions) to and including the Scheduled Termination Date in respect of which the Event Determination Date has not occurred or may not be determined on or before the Scheduled Maturity Date of the Notes, the Buyer undertakes to forthwith notify the Issuer, the Trustee and the Issuing and Paying Agent of the same. Credit Event Backstop Date: Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Credit Derivatives Definitions, no event occurring prior to the Trade Date shall be capable of comprising a Credit Event giving rise to an Event Determination Date in respect of this Transaction. Valuation Notice: If the Calculation Agent determines that a Cash Settlement Amount greater than zero is payable under this Transaction, then as soon as reasonably practicable following the determination of the Final Price, the Calculation Agent shall send a notice to the Swap Counterparty and the Issuer that contains the Quotations received, the Final Price and the calculation of the Cash Settlement Amount. Failure to send such a Valuation Notice shall not affect the Issuer’s obligation to pay a Cash Settlement Amount under this Transaction. General: All references in the Credit Derivatives Definitions to consultation between the parties shall be deemed to be deleted and any determinations to be made under the Credit Derivatives Definitions by either party in connection with the other shall be made in the sole and absolute discretion of the Calculation Agent. 6 Other Provisions (a) For the purpose of determining any amounts payable pursuant to Section 6 (Early Termination; Close-Out Netting) of the Agreement in connection with an early termination of this Transaction, notwithstanding any other provision of the 64 Agreement, all calculations and determinations that, under the Agreement, would otherwise be made by Party B shall be made by Party A. (b) The occurrence or designation of an Early Termination Date pursuant to the Asset Swap (such date, the “Asset Swap Termination Date”) shall be an Additional Termination Event in respect of this Credit Default Swap (for which purpose the Affected Party shall be Party B, except if Party A is the Defaulting Party or the sole Affected Party in relation to the termination of the Asset Swap, in which case the Affected Party hereunder shall be Party A) unless such occurrence or designation is due to the occurrence of the Auction Final Price Determination Date, Valuation Date or Termination Date (as applicable) following the occurrence of an Event Determination Date, in each case in relation to the Credit Default Swap. In such circumstances, the Asset Swap Termination Date shall be deemed to have been designated as an Early Termination Date hereunder. For the avoidance of doubt if an event or circumstance which would otherwise constitute or give rise to this Additional Termination Event, would also constitute or give rise to any other Termination Event or Event of Default, it will be treated as only giving rise to such other Termination Event or Event of Default. (c) An Additional Termination Event (for which the Affected Party shall be Party B and all Transactions shall be Affected Transactions) shall occur if at any time Party A notifies Party B that it has determined that the performance of the Swap Counterparty’s and/or its Affiliates’ obligations under the Swap Agreement, the Trust Deed or under any other Transaction Document or any arrangement made to hedge such obligations has or will become unlawful, illegal or otherwise prohibited due to a Regulatory Consequence and that, if applicable, a transfer of the Swap Agreement to an Affiliate of the Swap Counterparty will not be timely, practical or desirable for any reason, all determined in its sole and absolute discretion. (d) The “Breach of Agreement” provisions of Section 5(a)(ii) of the Agreement shall not apply to Party A or Party B. (e) The “Misrepresentation” provisions of Section 5(a)(iv) of the Agreement shall not apply to Party A or Party B. (f) Party B agrees that Party A may report the details of this Transaction (including any modification or termination of this Transaction) to a trade repository that collects and maintains records of derivatives. (g) Notwithstanding Part 1, paragraph 11 (Termination Currency) of the Schedule to the Agreement, the Termination Currency for this Transaction shall be the currency in which the Notes are denominated. (h) The Calculation Agent may in good faith make such amendment to, or supplement, the terms of this Transaction following the announcement or publication by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. of any provision, standard protocol or material relating to credit derivatives transactions which affects the Notes, this Transaction or any hedge transaction related to the Notes or the Swap Agreement entered into by Party B, Party A or any of its affiliates as the Calculation Agent determines appropriate to take into account the effect of such provision, standard protocol or material. 65 7 8 Other Terms (a) Non-insurance business. Party A and Party B acknowledge and agree that this Transaction is not intended to constitute insurance business and is not a contract of insurance, assurance, suretyship or guarantee and payments may be made under this Transaction by each party independently and without proof of the economic loss (if any) of the other party. (b) Third party rights. No person shall have any right to enforce any provision of this Transaction under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999. (c) Rounding. For the purposes of any calculations, determinations and valuations referred to in this Confirmation, (a) all percentages resulting from such calculations, determinations or valuations will be rounded, if necessary, to the nearest one hundred-thousandth of a percentage point (with 0.000005 per cent. being rounded up to 0.00001 per cent.) and (b) all amounts used in or resulting from such calculations, determinations or valuations will be rounded to the nearest USD (with USD 0.5 being rounded upwards). Account Details Account details of Party A: Citibank, N.A., New York Swift: CITIUS33 A/C of: Citigroup Global Markets Limited Account Number: 30761652 Account details of Party B: Citibank, N.A. BIC: CITIUS33 A/C of: Citibank, N.A. London Branch Swift: CITIGB2L Account Number: 10990765 Ref: GATS Emerald Capital DAC 2017-02 XS1608156474 This Confirmation and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it shall be governed by English law. This Transaction has been arranged by Citigroup Global Markets Limited which is authorised by the Prudential Regulation Authority (the “PRA”) and regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority (the “FCA”) and the PRA. Unless specified herein, information about the time of dealing and the amount or basis of any charges shared with any third party in connection with this Transaction will be made available on request. Your counterparty to the Transaction is Citigroup Global Markets Limited, which is authorised by the PRA and regulated by the FCA and the PRA. In the event that you have dealt with employees of an affiliate of Citigroup Global Markets Limited in placing the order for or otherwise arranging the Transaction (which is likely if you are not a UK person), then the Transaction has been introduced to you, and arranged, by such affiliate. Such affiliate does not act as agent for Citigroup Global Markets Limited, which is the principal to the Transaction with you. In the European Union, 66 such affiliate may be Citibank, N.A., London Branch (authorised by the PRA, subject to regulation by the FCA and limited regulation by the PRA) or Citibank Europe plc (authorised and regulated by the Central Bank). Please confirm your agreement to be bound by the terms of the foregoing by executing a copy of this Confirmation and returning it to us by facsimile. Yours faithfully, CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED By: Name: Title: Confirmed on the date first above written: EMERALD CAPITAL DESIGNATED ACTIVITY COMPANY By: Name: 67 Annex 5 Form of the Asset Swap Confirmation Set out below is the form of the Asset Swap Confirmation: Date: 10 May 2017 To: Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company From: Citigroup Global Markets Limited Re: Asset Swap Transaction relating to Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company Series No: 2017-02 USD 35,000,000 Fixed Rate The Kingdom of Saudi Arabia Credit Linked Notes due 2026 (the “Notes”) (Ref: LEMA3C10737243) Dear Sirs, The purpose of this letter agreement (the “Confirmation”) is to confirm the terms and conditions of the Transaction entered into between us on the first day on which this Confirmation has been signed by both Party A and Party B (the “Transaction”, and such date the “Signing Date”). This Confirmation constitutes a “Confirmation” as referred to in the 2002 ISDA Master Agreement specified below. The definitions and provisions contained in the 2006 ISDA Definitions (the “2006 Definitions”), as published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., are incorporated into this Confirmation. In the event of any inconsistency between the 2006 Definitions and this Confirmation, this Confirmation will govern. This Confirmation supplements, forms a part of, and is subject to the 2002 ISDA Master Agreement dated the Issue Date (the “Agreement”) deemed entered into between Citigroup Global Markets Limited (“Party A”) and Emerald Capital Designated Activity Company (formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited) (“Party B”) in respect of which the Schedule to such 2002 ISDA Master Agreement is in the form of the ISDA Schedule Terms (August 2016 Version). All provisions contained in the Agreement govern this Confirmation except as expressly modified below. Party A and Party B have entered into a related credit default swap transaction by means of a confirmation under the Agreement on the Effective Date (the “Credit Default Swap”). Party A represents and warrants that it has the capacity and power to enter into this Agreement and that the entry into this Agreement has been validly authorised, executed and delivered by it. Capitalised terms used but not defined herein will have the meanings given to such terms in (or incorporated by reference into) the Credit Default Swap relating to the Notes or in the Information Memorandum dated 9 May 2017, as amended and supplemented from time to time, relating to the issue of the Notes (the “Information Memorandum”). In this Confirmation, the “Conditions” refers to the terms and conditions of the Notes, as set out in or incorporated by reference into the Information Memorandum. In the event of any inconsistency between terms defined in this Confirmation and the corresponding terms in the Credit Default Swap or the Conditions, the terms as defined in the Credit Default Swap or the Conditions, as the case may be, shall govern. The terms of the Transaction to which this Confirmation relates are as follows: 68 1 General Terms Trade Date: 27 April 2017. Notwithstanding Section 3.7 of the 2006 Definitions, the Parties agree that they have entered into the Transaction to which this Confirmation relates on the Signing Date. Effective Date: 10 May 2017 Termination Date: The Maturity Date of the Notes Calculation Agent: Citigroup Global Markets Limited Business Days: London and New York Business Day Convention: Modified Following 2 Party B Fixed Amount 1 Party B Fixed Amount 1 Payer: Party B Party B Fixed Amount 1: On each Party B Fixed Amount 1 Payment Date Party B will pay to Party A an amount equal to the aggregate interest and principal amount receivable (in accordance with the terms of the Initial Collateral as at the Trade Date) in respect of the Initial Collateral held by or on behalf of Party B on such date. Party B Fixed Amount 1 Payment Date(s): In respect of the Initial Collateral, each Collateral Payment Date from and including the Collateral Payment Date falling on or immediately following the Effective Date to and including the Collateral Maturity Date. “Collateral Payment Date” means each date on which interest and/or principal is due and payable in respect of the Initial Collateral. “Collateral Maturity Date” means the Collateral Payment Date falling on the maturity date of the Initial Collateral. 3 Party B Fixed Amount 2 Party B Fixed Amount 2 Payer: Party B Party B Fixed Amount 2: On each Party B Fixed Amount 2 Payment Date Party B will pay to Party A an amount equal to the fixed amount receivable by Party B from Party A under the Credit Default Swap on such date. Party B Fixed Amount 2 Payment Date(s): In respect of the Credit Default Swap, each Credit Default Swap Payment Date. “Credit Default Swap Payment Date” means each “Fixed Rate Payer Payment Date”, as defined in the Credit Default Swap. 69 4 Party A Fixed Amounts Party A Fixed Amount Payer: Party A Party A Fixed Amount: An amount equal to the aggregate coupon amount that is payable by Party B in respect of the Notes then outstanding. Party A Fixed Amount Payer Payment Date(s): Each Interest Period Date in respect of the Notes, subject to adjustment in accordance with the Following Business Day Convention. 5 Final Exchange Party A Final Exchange Date: The Maturity Date of the Notes. Party A Final Exchange Amount: An amount in the Notes Currency equal to the outstanding Principal Amount of the Notes as at the Maturity Date. 6 Other Provisions (a) For the purpose of determining any amounts payable pursuant to Section 6 (Early Termination; Close-Out Netting) of the Agreement in connection with an early termination of this Transaction, notwithstanding any other provision of the Agreement, all calculations and determinations that, under the Agreement, would otherwise be made by Party B shall be made by Party A. (b) Where a termination amount is to be calculated in respect of this Transaction in accordance with Section 6 (Early Termination; Close-Out Netting) of the Agreement, notwithstanding any other provision of the Agreement, such calculation shall: (c) (i) not take into account the related early redemption of the Notes or the occurrence of an Event Determination Date (as applicable) in calculating the Party A Fixed Amounts, the Party B Fixed Amounts 1 or the Party B Fixed Amounts 2; (ii) assume that interest will be payable in respect of the Notes until (and including) the Scheduled Maturity Date of the Notes; (iii) not take into account any sale by or on behalf of Party B of any Initial Collateral in connection with such related early redemption of the Notes or occurrence of an Event Determination Date in calculating the Party B Fixed Amounts 2; (iv) assume that interest will be payable on the Initial Collateral until the Collateral Maturity Date; and (v) assume that “Fixed Amounts” under the Credit Default Swap will continue to be payable to and including the Scheduled Termination Date of the Credit Default Swap. The termination of the Credit Default Swap (including following a Credit Event) shall be an Additional Termination Event in respect of this Asset Swap, for which 70 purpose the Affected Party shall be Party B, except if Party A is the Defaulting Party or the sole Affected Party in relation to the termination of the Credit Default Swap, in which case the Affected Party hereunder shall be Party A. For the avoidance of doubt if an event or circumstance which would otherwise constitute or give rise to this Additional Termination Event, would also constitute or give rise to any other Termination Event or Event of Default, it will be treated as only giving rise to such other Termination Event or Event of Default. If the Credit Default Swap has been deemed to have been divided into multiple credit default swap transactions following a Successor Date (as defined in the Credit Default Swap) for which multiple Successors have been identified, the Additional Termination Event described in the above paragraph shall be deemed to apply in respect of a portion of this Transaction only (the “Terminated Portion”), bearing the same proportion to the whole Transaction as the Aggregate Allocated Principal Amount (as defined in the Conditions) bears to the Principal Amount outstanding, and the termination amount determined in accordance with Section 6(e) of the Agreement shall be determined only in respect of the Terminated Portion. The portion of this Transaction other than the Terminated Portion shall be deemed to continue as reduced by the Terminated Portion. The Calculation Agent may make such modifications to the terms of this Transaction as it considers necessary acting in good faith and in a commercially reasonable manner to preserve the economic effects of this Transaction after any multiple Successor event under the Credit Default Swap. Terms used in this paragraph 6(c) and not defined herein shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Credit Default Swap. (d) An Additional Termination Event (for which the Affected Party shall be Party B and all Transactions shall be Affected Transactions) shall occur if at any time Party A notifies Party B that it has determined that the performance of the Swap Counterparty’s and/or its Affiliates’ obligations under the Swap Agreement, the Trust Deed or under any other Transaction Document or any arrangement made to hedge such obligations has or will become unlawful, illegal or otherwise prohibited due to a Regulatory Consequence and that, if applicable, a transfer of the Swap Agreement to an Affiliate of the Swap Counterparty will not be timely, practical or desirable for any reason, all determined in its sole and absolute discretion. (e) The “Breach of Agreement” provisions of Section 5(a)(ii) of the Agreement shall not apply to Party A or Party B. (f) The “Misrepresentation” provisions of Section 5(a)(iv) of the Agreement shall not apply to Party A or Party B. (g) Party B agrees that Party A may report the details of this Transaction (including any modification or termination of this Transaction) to a trade repository that collects and maintains records of derivatives. (h) Notwithstanding Part 1, paragraph 11 (Termination Currency) of the Schedule to the Agreement, the Termination Currency for this Transaction shall be the currency in which the Notes are denominated. (i) The Calculation Agent may in good faith make such amendment to, or supplement, the terms of this Transaction following the announcement or publication by the 71 International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. of any provision, standard protocol or material relating to credit derivatives transactions which, by agreement or otherwise, affects the Notes, the Credit Default Swap or any hedge transaction related to the Notes or the Swap Agreement entered into by Party B, Party A or any of its affiliates as the Calculation Agent determines appropriate to take into account the effect of such provision, standard protocol or material. 7 Third party rights No person shall have any right to enforce any provision of this Transaction under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999. 8 Account Details Account details of Party A: Citibank, N.A., New York Swift: CITIUS33 A/C of: Citigroup Global Markets Limited Account Number: 30761652 Account details of Party B: Citibank, N.A. BIC: CITIUS33 A/C of: Citibank, N.A. London Branch Swift: CITIGB2L Account Number: 10990765 Ref: GATS Emerald Capital DAC 2017-02 XS1608156474 This Confirmation and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it shall be governed by and construed in accordance with English law. This Transaction has been arranged by Citigroup Global Markets Limited which is authorised by the Prudential Regulation Authority (the “PRA”) and regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority (the “FCA”) and the PRA. Unless specified herein, information about the time of dealing and the amount or basis of any charges shared with any third party in connection with this Transaction will be made available on request. Your counterparty to the Transaction is Citigroup Global Markets Limited, which is authorised by the PRA and regulated by the FCA and the PRA. In the event that you have dealt with employees of an affiliate of Citigroup Global Markets Limited branch in placing the order for or otherwise arranging the Transaction (which is likely if you are not a UK person), then the Transaction has been introduced to you, and arranged, by such affiliate. Such affiliate does not act as agent for Citigroup Global Markets Limited, which is the principal to the Transaction with you. In the European Union, such affiliate may be Citibank, N.A., London Branch (authorised by the PRA, subject to regulation by the FCA and limited regulation by the PRA) or Citibank Europe plc (authorised and regulated by the Central Bank). Please confirm your agreement to be bound by the terms of the foregoing by executing a copy of this Confirmation and returning it to us by facsimile. 72 Yours faithfully, CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED By: Name: Title: Confirmed on the date first above written: EMERALD CAPITAL DESIGNATED ACTIVITY COMPANY By: Name: 73 Annex 6 Description of the Issuer The Issuer was incorporated and formerly registered as a private limited company under the Irish Companies Acts, 1963 to 2013 (which were repealed with effect from 1 June 2015). The Issuer applied to re-register under the Companies Act, 2014 (as amended) of Ireland (the “2014 Act”) and on 20 September 2016 the Issuer was converted to a “designated activity company” under the 2014 Act. The following section provides an updated description of the Issuer following such conversion and should be read in place of the section of the Base Prospectus entitled Issuer Disclosure Annex 2. EMERALD CAPITAL DESIGNATED ACTIVITY COMPANY (formerly known as Emerald Capital Limited, the “Issuer”) The Issuer is a private limited company and was incorporated on 31 January 2007 and is registered under the 2014 Act under registration number 433859. The Issuer has been incorporated for an indefinite period. The registered office of the Issuer is at 3rd Floor, Kilmore House, Park Lane, Spencer Dock, Dublin 1 (Tel: +353 1 614 6240). The authorised share capital of the Issuer is Euro 1,000 divided into 1,000 ordinary shares of Euro 1 each, all of which have been issued and fully paid up. All of the issued ordinary shares are held by TMF Management (Ireland) Limited as share trustee (the “Share Trustee”). Under the terms of a declaration of trust (the “Declaration of Trust”) dated on or about 13 February 2007, the Share Trustee holds all the issued shares held directly or indirectly by it on trust for the holders of Notes and counterparties to other transactions until all payments in respect of such Notes and other transactions have been duly made and thereafter on trust for one or more Qualified Charities as defined in the Declaration of Trust. The Share Trustee has no beneficial interest in and derives no benefit (other than its fees for acting as Share Trustee) from its holding of the shares of the Issuer. Business The Issuer has not engaged, since its incorporation, in any activities other than those incidental to its incorporation, the accession to the Programme, the authorisation and issue of the Notes, the matters referred to or contemplated in the Base Prospectus and the authorisation, execution, delivery and performance of the other documents to which it is or will be a party and matters which are incidental or ancillary to the foregoing. The principal objects of the Issuer are set forth in Clause 3.1 of its Memorandum of Association and include, inter alia, the management of financial assets, the purchase, transfer of, investment in and acquisition of, by any means of loans, bonds or other obligations, including the extension of credit and any security therefore and the raising and borrowing of money and the granting of security over its assets for such purposes. So long as any of the obligations of the Issuer remain outstanding, the Issuer will not, inter alia, (a) enter into any business whatsoever, other than acquiring Mortgaged Property, issuing Notes or creating other obligations or entering into a similar limited recourse transaction, entering into related agreements and transactions and performing any act incidental to or in connection with the foregoing, (b) have any subsidiaries, (c) have any employees or (d) dispose of any Mortgaged Property or any interest therein or create any mortgage, charge or security interest or right of recourse in respect thereof in favour of any person (other than contemplated by the Base Prospectus) provided that nothing shall limit the ability of either the Issuer or the Trustee on behalf of the Issuer from entering into any agreement described in Section 1471(b) of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or perform any act incidental or necessary thereto to comply with such agreement. 74 Authorised and Issued Share Capital The following table sets forth the authorised and issued share capital of the Issuer as at the date of the Base Prospectus: Shareholders’ Funds EUR Share Capital Authorised: .......................................................................................................... 1,000 Issued: ................................................................................................................. 1,000 Directors The Directors of the Issuer are as follows: Name Function Business Address Principal Occupation Deirdre Brennan Director 3rd Floor, Kilmore House, Park Lane, Spencer Dock, Dublin 1 Accountant Keat Cheng Chin Director 3rd Floor, Kilmore House, Park Lane, Spencer Dock, Dublin 1 Accountant TMF Administration Services Limited of 3rd Floor, Kilmore House, Park Lane, Spencer Dock, Dublin 1 is the administrator for the Issuer. Its duties include the provision of certain administrative and related services. The appointment of the administrator may be terminated and the administrator may retire upon two months’ written notice subject to the appointment of an alternative administrator. TMF Administration Services Limited is Secretary to the Issuer. Financial Statements The Issuer has prepared audited financial statements in respect of its financial years ending 31 December 2014 and 31 December 2013 which form part of the Base Prospectus approved by the Central Bank, as well as in respect of its financial year ending 31 December 2015. The Issuer will prepare annually and publish audited financial statements, with explanatory notes. These financial statements will be available from the registered office of the Issuer and the office of the Issuing and Paying Agent. The auditors of the Issuer, Deloitte & Touche, Chartered Accountants and Registered Auditors of Deloitte & Touche House, Earlsfort Terrace, Dublin 2, are Chartered Accountants authorised and regulated by the Institute of Chartered Accountants in Ireland for designated investment business. 75 DESCRIPTION OF THE SWAP COUNTERPARTY The information referred to below in respect of Citigroup Global Markets Limited has been sourced from publicly available information. Such information has been accurately reproduced and, as far as the Issuer is aware and able to ascertain from information published by Citigroup Global Markets Limited, no facts have been omitted that would render the reproduced information inaccurate or misleading. A description of the Swap Counterparty is set out in the section of the Base Prospectus entitled “Description of Citigroup Global Markets Limited”. Financial Statements Citigroup Global Markets Limited has prepared audited financial statements in respect of its financial years ending 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014. Such audited financial statements are attached at the end of this section of the Series Prospectus. Significant or Material Change There has been no significant change in the financial or trading position of Citigroup Global Markets Limited or Citigroup Global Markets Limited and its subsidiaries as a whole since 31 December 2015 (the date of its most recently prepared audited financial statements) and there has been no material adverse change in the financial position or prospects of Citigroup Global Markets Limited or Citigroup Global Markets Limited and its subsidiaries as a whole since 31 December 2015 (the date of its most recently prepared audited financial statements). Litigation Save as disclosed in the Exhibit (entitled “Citigroup Contingencies”) to the section of the Base Prospectus entitled “Description of Citigroup Global Markets Limited” and in the equivalent “Contingencies” section within the Citigroup, Inc. Form 10-Q (filed with the SEC in respect of the quarterly period ended 31 March 2017), Citigroup Global Markets Limited is not subject to any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which Citigroup Global Markets Limited is aware) in the twelve months preceding the date of this Series Prospectus which may have or have had in the recent past a significant effect on the financial position or profitability of Citigroup Global Markets Limited or Citigroup Global Markets Limited and its subsidiaries as a whole. The disclosures with respect to “Contingencies” within the Citigroup, Inc. Form 10-Q (filed with the SEC in respect of the quarterly period ended 31 March 2017) are contained on pages 179 to 180 of such Form 10-Q that is available for viewing on the website of Citigroup, Inc. using the following link: http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/data/q1701c.pdf?ieNocache=323 76 INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT TO THE MEMBER OF CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED We have audited the financial statements of Citigroup Global Markets Limited for the year ended 31 December 2015 set out on pages 18 to 83, with the exception of the unaudited information on pages 78 to 81. The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their preparation is applicable law and United Kingdom Accounting Standards (United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice), including FRS 101 Reduced Disclosure Framework. This report is made solely to the Company's members, as a body, in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company's members those matters we are required to state to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company's members, as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. Respective responsibilities of Directors and Auditor As explained more fully in the Directors' Responsibilities Statement set out on pages 14 and 15, the Directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. Our responsibility is to audit, and express our opinion on, the financial statements in accordance with applicable law and International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland). Those standards require us to comply with the Auditing Practices Board's (APB's) Ethical Standards for Auditors. Scope of the audit of the financial statements A description of the scope of an audit of financial statements is provided on the Financial Reporting Council's website at www.frc.org.uk/auditscopeukprivate. Opinion on financial statements In our opinion the financial statements: • give a true and fair view of the state of the Company's affairs as at 31 December 2015 and of its profit for the year then ended; • have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice; and • have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. Opinion on other matter prescribed by the Companies Act 2006 In our opinion the information given in the Strategic Report and the Directors' Report for the financial year for which the financial statements are prepared is consistent with the financial statements. Matters on which we are required to report by exception We have nothing to report in respect of the following matters where the Companies Act 2006 requires us to report to you if, in our opinion: • adequate accounting records have not been kept, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or • the financial statements are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns; or • certain disclosures of the Directors' remuneration specified by law are not made; or • we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit. Richard Faulkner (Senior Statutory Auditor) for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor Chartered Accountants 15 Canada Square London E14 5GL 31st March 2016 17 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED INCOME STATEMENT for the year ended 31 December 2015 Notes 2015 2014 * $ Million $ Million Commission income and fees Net dealing income 4 6 2,063 1,237 2,195 725 Interest receivable Interest payable 5 5 591 (632) 773 (638) 3,259 3,055 (2,910) 18 6 (2,955) 10 3 373 113 (5) 73 368 186 Gross profit Operating expenses Other finance income Other income 7 8 Operating profit on ordinary activities before taxation Tax on profits on ordinary activities 11(a) Profit for the financial year * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The accompanying notes on pages 21 to 83 form an integral part of these financial statements. 18 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME for the year ended 31 December 2015 Notes Profit/(loss) for the financial year 2015 2014 * $ Million $ Million 368 186 (70) 166 298 352 Other Comprehensive Income (Expense) Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss: Gains/(losses) on remeasurement of net defined benefit pension asset 8 Total comprehensive gain for the financial year * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY for the year ended 31 December 2015 Share Capital $ Million Capital reserve $ Million Profit and loss account $ Million Total $ Million At 31 December 2013 Transitional adjustments in respect of FRS 101 Balance at 1 January 2014 Profit for the year Net movement in Statement of Comprehensive Income in respect of the pension scheme Share based payment transactions At 31 December 2014 Profit for the year Net movement in Statement of Comprehensive Income in respect of the pension scheme Share based payment transactions 1500 1,500 - 9,989 9,989 - 1,265 38 1,303 186 166 12,754 38 12,792 186 166 1,500 - 9,989 - (9) 1,646 368 (70) (9) 13,135 368 (70) - - 14 14 At 31 December 2015 1,500 9,989 1,958 13,447 The accompanying notes on pages 21 to 83 form an integral part of these financial statements. 19 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED BALANCE SHEET as at 31 December 2015 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 2013 * $ Million 12 1,939 46,335 1,571 48,764 2,805 50,659 13 14 162,450 41,583 47,126 31 446 23,429 213,383 45,133 44,290 40 502 29,667 83,549 41,926 48,215 50 218 18,038 323,339 383,350 245,460 11,995 34,729 10,104 39,025 5,881 38,244 161,858 28,996 41,067 25,810 5,437 309,892 211,759 32,754 40,193 32,300 4,080 370,215 85,086 29,429 49,230 20,598 4,200 232,668 1,500 9,989 1,958 1,500 9,989 1,646 1,500 9,989 1,303 13,447 13,135 12,792 323,339 383,350 245,460 Notes Assets Financial assets at amortised cost - cash at bank and in hand - collateralised financing transactions Financial assets classed as held for trading - derivatives - inventory - financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Financial assets classed as available for sale Pension asset Other assets 16 8 18 Total Assets Liabilities and Equity Financial liabilities at amortised cost - bank loans and overdrafts - collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities classed as held for trading - derivatives - securities sold but not yet purchased - financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or Other liabilities Subordinated loans Total Liabilities Capital and reserves Called up share capital Capital reserve Profit and loss account 13 22 26 27 Shareholders' funds Total Liabilities and Shareholders' Funds * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The accompanying notes on pages 21 to 83 form an integral part of these financial statements. The financial statements on pages 18 to 83 were approved by the Directors on 31 March 2016 and were signed on their behalf by: J D K Bardrick Director Registered Number: 01763297 20 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (a) Basis of presentation The financial statements of the Company have been prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101, ‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’ (FRS 101) from the beginning of the accounting period. In preparing these financial statements, the Company applies the recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements of International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the EU (Adopted IFRSs), but makes amendments where necessary in order to comply with Companies Act 2006 and has set out below where advantage of the FRS 101 disclosure exemptions has been taken. The Company has taken exemption available under FRS 101 not to disclose all transactions with other group companies and investees of the group qualifying as related parties. It has also taken the exemption available under FRS 101 not to prepare a cash flow statement. In the transition to FRS 101, the Company has applied IFRS 1 whilst ensuring that its assets and liabilities are measured in compliance with FRS 101. The major measurement impact on the net assets and liabilities of the company upon transition to FRS 101 has been the recognition of the full surplus attributable to its defined benefit pension scheme. For full details of the transition impact on the Company’s P&L and balance sheet, see Note 29 ‘FRS 101 Transition Adjustments. The financial statements have been prepared in US Dollars, which is the functional currency of the Company, and any reference to $ in these financial statements refers to US Dollars. As permitted under section 401 of the Companies Act 2006, consolidated financial statements have not been prepared because the Company is a wholly owned subsidiary of the ultimate parent Citigroup Inc. which prepares consolidated financial statements under US GAAP. Citigroup Inc. makes its financial statements available to the public on a quarterly basis. (b) Changes in accounting policy and disclosures Standards issued but not yet effective There are a number of accounting standards that have been amended by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), but which are not yet effective for the Company’s financial statements. The Company does not plan on early adoption of these standards. They include those set out below. • In December 2014 the IASB published the final Standard Disclosure Initiative (Amendments to IAS 1). These amendments to IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements address some of the concerns expressed about existing presentation and disclosure requirements and ensure that entities are able to use judgement when applying IAS 1. The final Standard Disclosure Initiative (Amendments to IAS 1) is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016 with earlier application permitted. • Annual Improvements to IFRS 2010-2012 and 2011-2013 Cycles. The IASB’s annual improvement projects for the 2010-2012 and 2011-2013 cycles resulted in minor amendments to multiple standards. The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 February 2015, with early adoption permitted. The amendments are not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements. • Annual Improvements to IFRS 2012-2014 Cycle. The IASB’s annual improvement projects for the 20122014 cycle resulted in minor amendments to multiple standards. The amendments are effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016, with early adoption permitted. The amendments are not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial statements. 21 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (b) Changes in accounting policy and disclosures (continued) Standards issued but not yet endorsed by the EU There are a number of accounting standards and interpretations that have been issued by the IASB, but which are not yet effective for the Company’s financial statements. The Company does not plan on early adoption of these standards. They include: • IFRS 9 – Financial Instruments. The new standard includes a model for classification and measurement of financial instruments, a forward-looking ‘expected loss’ impairment model and a substantially reformed approach to hedge accounting. The standard replaces the existing guidance in IAS 39 – Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement. IFRS 9 is effective from 1 January 2018 and can be adopted early once it is endorsed by the EU. The Company is assessing the impact IFRS 9 will have on its financial statements and has initiated a project strategy to assess the impact of the new standard on Citi’s internal processes and systems. • IFRS 15 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers. IFRS 15 establishes a comprehensive framework for determining whether, how much and when revenue is recognised. It replaces existing revenue recognition guidance, including IAS 18 Revenue, IAS 11 Construction Contracts and IFRIC 13 Customer Loyalty Programmes. IFRS 15 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018, with early adoption permitted. The Company is assessing the potential impact on its financial statements resulting from the application of IFRS 15. (c) Financial instruments Trading assets and trading liabilities Financial instruments that have been acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the near term, or form part of a portfolio of financial instruments that are managed at fair value together and for which there is evidence of short term profit taking are classified as “held for trading”. Financial assets classified as “held for trading” include collateralised financing transactions, government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities, certificates of deposit, commercial paper and derivatives. Financial liabilities classified as “held for trading” include securities sold but not yet purchased, collateralised financing transactions and derivatives. Trading assets and liabilities are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. Any changes in fair value between trade date and settlement date are reported in the profit and loss account. Gains and losses realised on disposal or redemption and unrealised gains and losses from changes in fair value are reported in the profit and loss account. Any initial gain or loss on financial instruments where valuation is depended on valuation techniques using unobservable parameters are deferred over the life of the contract or until the instrument is redeemed, transferred or sold or the fair value becomes observable. Derivative contracts Derivative contracts used in trading activities are recognised at fair value on the date the derivative is entered into and are subsequently re-measured at fair value. All derivatives are carried as assets when fair value is positive and as liabilities when fair value is negative. Gains and losses realised on disposal or redemption and unrealised gains and losses from changes in fair value are reported in the profit and loss account. Repurchase and resale agreements Repurchase and resale agreements are treated as collateralised financing transactions. Securities which have been sold with an agreement to repurchase continue to be shown on the balance sheet and the sale proceeds are recorded as a collateralised financing transaction within other liabilities. Securities acquired in purchase and resale transactions are not recognised in the balance sheet and the purchase is recorded as a collateralised financing transaction within other assets. The difference between the sale price and the repurchase price is recognised over the life of the transaction and is charged or credited to the profit and loss account as interest payable or receivable. 22 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (c) Financial instruments (continued) The Company has chosen to designate a portion of its repurchase and resale agreements at fair value. Financial instruments are classified as fair value through profit and loss when they meet one or more of the criteria set out below, and are so designated by management: • The assets or liabilities are managed, evaluated and reported internally on a fair value basis. • The designation eliminates or significantly reduces an accounting mismatch that would otherwise arise. Loans and receivables Loans and receivables incorporate trade debtors, including settlement receivables, and are initially recognised at fair value including direct and incremental transaction costs and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. At each reporting date the Company assesses whether there is objective evidence that financial assets carried at amortised cost are impaired. A financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired when objective evidence demonstrates that a loss event has occurred after the initial recognition of the asset(s), and that the loss event has an impact on the future cash flows of the asset(s) that can be estimated reliably. Objective evidence that financial assets are impaired can include significant financial difficulty of the debtor or other observable data such as adverse changes in the payment status of debtors, or economic conditions that correlate with defaults of the debtor. Impairment losses on assets carried at amortised cost are measured as the difference between the carrying amount of the financial asset and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the asset’s original effective interest rate. Impairment losses are recognised in profit or loss and reflected in an allowance account against loans and receivables. Interest on impaired assets continues to be recognised through the unwinding of the discount. When a subsequent event causes the amount of impairment loss to decrease, the decrease in impairment loss is reversed through profit or loss. The Company writes off loans and receivables when they are determined to be uncollectible. Available for Sale Assets Financial assets that are not classified as at fair value through profit or loss or as loans and receivables are classified as Available for Sale (AFS). A financial asset classified as AFS is initially recognized at its fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition of the financial asset. Financial assets classified as AFS are carried at fair value with the changes in fair value reported in other comprehensive income. For AFS debt instruments, changes in carrying amounts relating to changes in foreign exchange rate are recognized in the Statement of Income and other changes in carrying amount are recognized in other comprehensive income as indicated above. For financial assets classified as AFS that are nonmonetary items (equity instruments), the gain or loss that is recognized in other comprehensive income includes any related foreign exchange component. However, interest calculated using the effective interest rate method is recognised in the income statement. Other financial liabilities and subordinated loans Financial liabilities and subordinated loans are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate, except those which are “held for trading”, which are held at fair value through the profit and loss account. Determination of fair value Where the classification of a financial instrument requires it to be stated at fair value, this is determined by reference to the quoted market value in an active market wherever possible. Where no such active market exists for the particular instrument, the Company uses a valuation technique to arrive at the fair value, including the use of prices obtained in recent arms’ length transactions, discounted cash flow analysis, option pricing models and other valuation techniques commonly used by market participants. See Note 15 ‘Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values’ for further details. 23 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. (c) Principal accounting policies (continued) Financial instruments (continued) Collateral The Company receives collateral from customers as part of its business activities. Collateral can take the form of cash, securities or other assets. Where cash collateral (client money) is received this is recorded on the balance sheet and, where required by collateral agreements, is held in segregated client cash accounts. The Company does not recognise non-cash collateral on its balance sheet. Offsetting financial instruments Financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the balance sheet only when there is a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. The legal right to set off the recognized amounts must be enforceable in both the normal course of business, in the event of default, insolvency or bankruptcy of both the Company and its counterparty. In all other situations they are presented gross. The majority of the offsetting applied by the Company relates to derivatives and repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements. A significant portion of offsetting is applied to interest rate derivatives and related cash margin balances, which are cleared through central clearing parties such as the London Clearing House. The Company also offsets repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements for which the Company has the right to set off and has the intent to settle on a net basis or to realize an asset and settle a liability simultaneously. Derecognition of financial assets and financial liabilities Financial assets are derecognised when the right to receive cash flows from the assets has expired or when the Company has transferred its contractual right to receive the cash flows of the financial assets and either substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership have been transferred or substantially all the risks and rewards have neither been retained nor transferred but control is not retained. If the Company enters into a transaction that results in it retaining significantly all of the risks and rewards of a financial asset it will continue to recognise that financial asset and will recognise a financial liability equal to the consideration received under the transaction. In transactions in which the Company neither retains nor transfers substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a financial asset and it retains control over the asset, the Company continues to recognise the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement, determined by the extent to which it is exposed to changes in the value of the transferred asset. Financial liabilities are derecognised when they are extinguished, that is when the obligation is modified, exchanged, discharged, cancelled or expired. (d) Physical commodities Physical commodities are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. Realised gains and losses on sales of commodities inventory are included in Net dealing income. (e) Commission income and fees Commission revenues and expenses are recognised when the right to consideration has been obtained in exchange for performance. (f) Interest receivable and payable Interest income and expense is recognised in the profit and loss account for all financial assets classified as loans and receivables and non-trading financial liabilities, using the effective interest rate method. Interest arising on financial assets or financial liabilities that are “held for trading” or “designated at fair value” is reported within interest income and expense respectively. 24 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (g) Net dealing income Net dealing income comprises gains and losses related to trading assets, trading liabilities and financial assets and liabilities designated at fair value and physical commodities, and includes all realised and unrealised fair value changes, dividends and foreign exchange differences. (h) Tangible and Intangible assets Tangible fixed assets are measured at cost, less accumulated depreciation. The cost of developed software includes directly attributable internal costs and the cost of external consultants. Depreciation is provided at rates calculated to write-off the cost, less the estimated residual value of each asset, on a straight-line basis over its expected economic useful life, as follows: Premises improvements Equipment Capitalised software - lesser of the life of the lease or 10 years 3 to 5 years 5 to 10 years At each reporting date the Company assesses whether there is any indication that tangible or intangible fixed assets are impaired. (i) Fixed asset investments Investments in subsidiary undertakings are stated at cost, less any write down for diminution in value regarded as permanent. (j) Taxation Income tax payable on profits is recognised as an expense based on the applicable tax laws in each jurisdiction in the period in which profits arise. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised for taxable and deductible temporary differences between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the financial statements. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that there will be sufficient profits available against which these differences can be utilised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period in which the asset will be realised or the liability will be settled based on tax rates that are enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. (k) Pension and other post retirement benefit costs CGML operates both a defined benefit and a defined contribution pension scheme. The cost of CGML’s defined contribution pension scheme is the amount of contributions payable in respect of the year. The defined benefit obligation is calculated annually by independent actuaries using the projected unit credit method. The present value of the defined benefit obligation is determined by discounting the estimated future cash outflows using interest rates of high quality corporate bonds that are denominated in the currency in which the benefits will be paid and that have terms to maturity approximating to the term of the related pension liability. Remeasurement gains and losses are recognised immediately in the statement of comprehensive income. The current service cost and any past service costs are included in the income statement within operating expenses. The interest income on pension scheme assets, net of the impact of the interest cost on the pension scheme liabilities, is included with other finance income. A surplus is recognised on the balance sheet where an economic benefit is available as a reduction in future contributions or as a refund of monies to Citi. 25 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (l) Foreign currencies Transactions in foreign currencies are recorded using the rate of exchange at the date of transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollars are translated into US Dollars using the year end spot exchange rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollar that are classified as “held for trading” or “designated at fair value” are translated into US Dollars using the year end spot rate. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollars that are not measured at fair value have been translated at the relevant historical exchange rates. Any gains or losses on exchange are taken to the profit and loss account as incurred. (m) Share-based incentive plans The Company participates in a number of Citigroup Inc. (Citi) share-based incentive plans under which Citi grants shares to the Company’s employees. Pursuant to a separate Stock Plans Affiliate Participation Agreement (SPAPA) the Company makes a cash settlement to Citi for the fair value of the share-based incentive awards delivered to the Company’s employees under these plans. The Company applies equity-settled accounting for its share based incentive plans, with separate accounting for its associated obligations to make payments to Citigroup Inc. The Company recognises the fair value of the awards at grant date as compensation expense over the vesting period with a credit to the intercompany payable to Citigroup Inc. All amounts paid to Citigroup Inc. and the associated obligations are recognised over the vesting period. Subsequent changes in the fair value of all unexercised awards are reviewed annually and any changes in value are recognised in the equity reserve, again over the vesting period. The SPAPA is also updated annually. For Citi’s share based incentive plans that have a graded vested period each “tranche” of the award is treated as a separate award. Where a plan has a cliff vest, the award only has a single “tranche”. The expense is recognised as follows: Vesting Period of Award 2 Years (vesting in 2 Tranches) 2 Years (vesting in 1 Tranche) 3 Years (vesting in 3 Tranches) 3 years (vesting in 1 Tranche) 4 Years (vesting in 4 Tranches) 4 Years (vesting in 1 Tranche) % of expense recognised in Income Statement Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 Year 4 75% 25% 50% 50% 61% 28% 11% 33% 33% 33% 52% 27% 15% 6% 25% 25% 25% 25% Employees who meet certain age plus years of service requirements (retirement eligible employees) may terminate active employment and continue vesting of their awards provided they comply with specified non-compete provisions. The cost of share based incentive plans are recognised over the requisite service period. For awards granted to retirement eligible employees, the services are provided prior to grant date, and subsequently the costs are accrued in the year prior to the grant date. EU Short Term awards are a form of Capital Accumulation Program (CAP) awarded to qualifying staff. The award is accounted for similarly to CAP awards but is delivered in the form of immediately vested restricted shares subject to a six month sale restriction. 26 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 2. Use of assumptions, estimates and judgements The results of the Company are sensitive to the accounting policies, assumptions and estimates that underlie the preparation of its financial statements. The accounting policies used in the preparation of the financial statements are described in detail above. The preparation of financial statements requires management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from these estimates. Estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised and in any future periods affected. Further information about those areas where estimation, uncertainty and the application of critical judgements to accounting policies have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the financial statements are set out below. Valuation of financial instruments The Company’s accounting policy for valuation of financial instruments is described in Note 1(c). The fair values of financial instruments that are not quoted in active markets are determined by using valuation techniques. To the extent practicable, models use only observable data. Where this is not possible, management may be required to make estimates. Note 15 ‘Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values’ discusses further the valuation of financial instruments. Credit valuation adjustment The Company has a number of financial liabilities that are valued at fair value. Under IAS 39, the Company is required to consider its own credit risk in determining the fair value of such financial liabilities. Management judgement is required in determining the appropriate measure of own credit risk to be included in the valuation model of the financial liability. Credit valuation adjustments (CVA) and, effective in the third quarter of 2014, funding valuation adjustments (FVA), are applied to OTC derivative instruments in which the base valuation generally discounts expected cash flows using the relevant base interest rate curve for the currency of the derivative (e.g., LIBOR for uncollateralized U.S. dollar derivatives). As not all counterparties have the same credit risk as that implied by the relevant base curve, a CVA is necessary to incorporate the market view of both counterparty credit risk and Citi’s own credit risk in the valuation. FVA reflects a market funding risk premium inherent in the uncollateralized portion of derivative portfolios and in collateralized derivatives where the terms of the agreement do not permit the reuse of the collateral received. Citi’s CVA methodology is composed of two steps. First, the credit exposure profile for each counterparty is determined using the terms of all individual derivative positions and a Monte Carlo simulation or other quantitative analysis to generate a series of expected cash flows at future points in time. The calculation of this exposure profile considers the effect of credit risk mitigants, including pledged cash or other collateral and any legal right of offset that exists with counterparty through arrangements such as netting agreements. Individual derivative contracts that are subject to an enforceable master netting agreement with a counterparty are aggregated for this purpose, since it is those aggregate net cash flows that are subject to non-performance risk. This process identifies specific, point-in-time future cash flows that are subject to non-performance risk, rather than using the current recognized net asset or liability as a basis to measure the CVA. Second, market-based views of default probabilities derived from observed credit spreads in the credit default swap (CDS) market are applied to the expected future cash flows determined in step one. Citi’s own-credit CVA is determined using Citi-specific CDS spreads for the relevant tenor. Generally, counterparty CVA is determined using CDS spread indices for each credit rating and tenor. For certain identified netting sets where individual analysis is practicable (e.g., exposures to counterparties with liquid CDSs), counterparty-specific CDS spreads are used. The CVA and FVA are designed to incorporate a market view of the credit and funding risk, respectively, inherent in the derivative portfolio. However, most unsecured derivative instruments are negotiated bilateral contracts and are not commonly transferred to third parties. Derivative instruments are normally settled contractually or, if terminated early, are terminated at a value negotiated bilaterally between the counterparties. Thus, the CVA and FVA may not be realized upon a settlement or termination in the normal course of business. In addition, all or a 27 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 2. Use of assumptions, estimates and judgements (continued) Credit valuation adjustment (continued) portion of these adjustments may be reversed or otherwise adjusted in future periods in the event of changes in the credit or funding risk associated with the derivative instruments. During 2015, the Company recorded net CVA losses of $100 million (2014: $19 million losses). These were offset by a net FVA gain of $28 million (2014: £22 million gains). The total adjustment recorded in the balance sheet at the year-end was $47 million (2014: $180 million). Pension The Company’s defined benefit schemes are measured on an actuarial basis, with the key assumptions being discount rate, inflation, mortality and investment returns. Following adoption of FRS 101, there is no separate assumption for expected return on assets. The net finance income is calculated using the discount rate. Mortality assumptions are based upon the relevant standard industry and national mortality tables. Discount rates are based on specific corporate bond indices which reflect the underlying yield curve of each scheme. Management judgement is required in estimating the rate of future salary growth and in assessing the implications of IFRIC 14 and the recoverability of any surplus. All assumptions are unbiased, mutually compatible and based upon market expectations at the reporting date. Share-based incentive plans Awards granted through Citi's Stock Option Programme are measured by applying an option pricing model, taking into account the terms and conditions of the programme. Analysis of past exercise behaviour, Citi's dividend history and historical volatility are inputs to the valuation model. Management judgement is required in estimating the forfeiture rate. 3. Turnover and results As permitted by paragraph 4 of Schedule 1 to the Companies Act 2006 The Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (SI 2008 No 410), the format of the income statement and the Balance sheet have been adapted to the circumstances of the Company. Instead of turnover, the Directors have reported commission income and fees, net dealing income and interest income less interest expense in determining the gross profit of the Company. On the face of the Balance sheet, financial investments have been broken down into different components whereas non-financial assets and liabilities have been combined within ‘Other assets’ and ‘Other liabilities’ respectively. 28 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS . 4. Commission income and fees Commission income and fees are derived from underwriting activities, marketing securities owned by other group undertakings, trading services provided to other group undertakings and corporate finance fees associated with mergers and acquisitions and other corporate finance and broking advisory activities. All fees relate to financial assets measured at fair value. 5. Interest receivable and interest payable Interest receivable comprises: Interest on collateral paid, current asset investments and collateralised financing transactions at fair value through profit and loss Interest on debtors and cash assets not at fair value through profit and loss Interest payable comprises: Interest on collateral held and collateralised financing transactions at fair value through profit and loss Interest on borrowings not at fair value through profit and loss Interest on subordinated debt 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 323 521 268 252 591 773 44 111 497 91 434 93 632 638 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Included within interest receivable is interest received on client money. 6. Gains and losses on financial assets and financial liabilities held at fair value through profit and loss Gains and losses on financial assets and financial liabilities held for trading: Net dealing income Interest receivable Interest payable Gains and losses on financial assets "designated at fair value through profit or loss": Net dealing income Interest receivable Interest payable 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 1,232 231 23 721 362 14 1,486 1,097 5 92 21 4 159 97 118 260 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 29 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 7. Operating expenses 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million 1,171 178 171 1,260 186 166 10 63 10 64 60 56 Operating expenses include: Employee remuneration Share-based incentive expense (Note 9) Payroll taxes Pension costs - defined benefit scheme (Note 8) - defined contribution scheme Depreciation (Note 19) Auditor’s remuneration: Audit of these financial statements Amounts receivable by the company's auditor and its associates in respect of: Audit related assurance services Taxation compliance services Other assurance services 1.30 1.23 0.36 0.29 0.34 0.09 - The prior year auditors’ remuneration has been restated. The Company employed an average of 4,066 (2014: 3,931) employees during the year. 8. Pension costs Defined contribution scheme The Citigroup (UK) Pension Plan was established in September 2000 and provides defined contribution benefits to all new hires. Defined benefit scheme The Citigroup Global Markets Limited Pension and Life Assurance Scheme (“the Scheme”) is a funded pension scheme providing benefits on both a defined benefit and defined contribution basis. The Scheme is now closed to new entrants. The assets of the Scheme are held separately from those of the Company, in a trustee administered fund. Employees are not required to contribute to the Scheme, which is contracted out of the State Earnings Related Pension Scheme. The pension cost in respect of defined benefit obligations is assessed in accordance with the advice of a qualified external actuary using a Projected Unit method with a triennial review. The most recent full actuarial assessment of the liabilities of the scheme was at 5 April 2014. Expected regular employer contributions to be paid into the Scheme during 2016 are $14 million (2015: $14 million). The mortality assumptions are based on standard mortality tables which allow for expected future mortality improvements. The assumptions are that a member currently aged 65 will live on average for a further 23.6 years for males and 25.2 years for females. Members currently aged 45 are expected to live a further 24.8 years and 26.9 years from age 65 for males and females respectively. The Scheme duration is an indicator of the weighted average time until benefit payment are made. For the Scheme as a whole, the duration is around 24 years, reflecting the approximate split of the defined benefit obligation between current employees, deferred members and current pensioners. Assumptions that are affected by economic conditions (financial assumptions) are based on market expectations at the balance sheet date, for the period over which the obligations are settled. FRS 101 requires the interest income on scheme assets to be determined using the same discount rate assumption applied to the scheme obligations. 30 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) Previously, under FRS 17, expected rate of return on assets was derived by aggregating the expected return for each asset class over the actual asset allocation for the Scheme, which is applicable to years prior to 2014. Prior year comparatives have been adjusted to reflect this change. The financial assumptions used in calculating the defined benefit scheme liabilities as at 31 December 2015 are as follows: 2015 2014 2013 Discount rate for scheme liabilities Interest income rate on scheme assets Expected rate of return on assets Inflation Rate of general long-term increase in salaries Rate of increase to pensions in payment - Pensions accrued from 1 May 2005 - Pensions accrued prior to 1 May 2005 3.85% 3.85% N/A 3.40% 1.50% 3.70% 3.70% N/A 3.30% 1.50% 4.50% N/A 3.70% 3.70% 1.50% 2.50% 3.20% 2.40% 3.00% 2.50% 3.20% The fair value of Scheme assets and the interest income at the reporting date are set out as follows: Government bonds Corporate bonds Insured Pensions Other Total market value of assets 2015 $ Million 1,168 575 1 10 Fair value 2014 $ Million 1,279 608 1 19 2013 $ Million 937 592 1 13 1,754 1,907 1,543 Analysis of amounts recognised in profit and loss account: 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million Current service cost Curtailment cost 10 - 9 1 Expense recognised in the profit and loss account 10 10 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 69 (51) 69 (59) 18 10 Analysis of other finance income: Interest income on pension scheme assets Interest cost on pension scheme liabilities Net finance income * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 31 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) Analysis of amount recognised in Statement of Comprehensive Income: 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million (94) 392 40 (126) (54) 266 Deferred tax adjustment on pension in Statement of Comprehensive Income (16) (100) Total gains/(losses) recognised in Statement of Comprehensive Income (70) 166 Return on scheme assets (in excess of)/below that recognised in net interest Remeasurement gains/(losses) on scheme liabilities Total remeasurement gains/(losses) recognised in Statement of Comprehensive Income * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Reconciliation to the balance sheet: Total market value of assets Present value of scheme liabilities Gross pension asset Related deferred tax liability 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 1,754 (1,308) 446 1,907 (1,405) 502 (116) (100) 330 402 Net pension asset * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million Surplus in scheme at beginning of the year Current service cost Contributions Curtailments Other finance income/(expense) Remeasurement gains/(losses) Foreign exchange adjustment 502 (10) 14 18 (53) (25) 218 (9) 30 (1) 10 266 (12) Surplus in scheme at end of year 446 502 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The entirety of the surplus has been recognised on CGML’s balance sheet with no restrictions, as it is likely that Citi will be able to derive economic benefit from the existing or any future surplus that may arise. 32 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) The changes to the present value of the defined obligation during the year are as follows: 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million Opening defined benefit obligation Current service cost Interest cost Remeasurement (gains)/losses on scheme liabilities Net benefits paid out Curtailments Foreign exchange adjustment 1,405 10 51 (40) (48) (70) 1,325 9 59 126 (35) 1 (80) Closing defined benefit obligation 1,308 1,405 The changes to the fair value of scheme assets during the year are as follows: 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million Opening fair value of scheme assets Interest income on pension scheme assets Remeasurement (losses)/gains on scheme assets Contributions by the employer Net benefits paid out Foreign exchange adjustment 1,907 69 (94) 14 (48) (94) 1,543 69 392 30 (35) (92) Closing fair value of scheme assets 1,754 1,907 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The actual return on assets is as follows: 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million Interest income on pension scheme assets Remeasurement gains/(losses) on scheme assets 69 (94) 69 392 Actual return on assets (25) 461 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The interest income on scheme assets is set using the discount rate assumption. In 2015, asset values grew by less than assumed, leading to an overall remeasurement loss of $94 million, as bond yields increased slightly in 2015. In 2014, asset values grew by more than assumed, leading to a remeasurement gain of $392 million, as bond yields fell significantly during 2014. 33 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) The table below sets out the history of experience gains and losses: 2015 2014 * 2013 * 2012 * 2011 * $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million Gains/(losses) on scheme assets due to experience Gains on scheme liabilities due to experience Gains/(losses) on scheme liabilities due to assumptions Remeasurements recognised in Statement of Comprehensive Income (94) 27 13 392 9 (135) (21) 3 (70) (13) 37 (67) 145 (58) (54) 266 (88) (43) 87 Related deferred tax (liability) (16) (100) - - - Total gains/(losses) recognised in Statement of Comprehensive Income net of tax (70) 166 (88) (43) 87 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. The key assumptions used for IAS 19 are the discount rate, inflation and mortality. If different assumptions were used, this could have a material effect on the results disclosed. The sensitivity of the results to these assumptions is set out in the table below. Change in Change in defined P&L scheme benefit Sensitivity to key assumptions change assets obligation increase/ positive/ increase/ (negative) (decrease) (decrease) $ Million $ Million $ Million Effect of decreasing the discount rate assumption by 0.5% Effect of increasing the inflation assumption by 0.5% Effect of increasing the life expectancy assumption by 1 year 34 (9) (4) (2) 0 0 0 165 94 45 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans As part of the Company’s remuneration programme it participates in a number of Citi share-based incentive plans. These plans involve the granting of restricted or deferred share awards and share payments. Such awards are used to attract, retain and motivate officers and employees, to provide incentives for their contributions to the long-term performance and growth of Citi, and to align their interests with those of the shareholders. The award programmes are administered by the Personnel and Compensation Committee of the Citigroup Inc. Board of Directors, which is composed entirely of non-employee directors. In the share award program Citi issues common shares in the form of restricted share awards, deferred share awards and share payments. For all stock award programs during the applicable vesting period, the shares awarded are not issued to participants (in the case of a deferred stock award) or cannot be sold or transferred by participants (in the case of a restricted stock award), until after the vesting conditions have been satisfied. Recipients of deferred share awards do not have any shareholder rights until shares are delivered to them, but they generally are entitled to receive dividend-equivalent payments during the vesting period. Recipients of restricted share awards are entitled to limited voting rights and to receive dividends or dividend-equivalent payments during the vesting period. Once a share award vests the shares become freely transferrable, but in the case of certain employees, may be subject to transfer restrictions by their terms or share ownership commitment. Certain stock-based awards contain discretionary clawback provisions and are subject to variable accounting. The associated value of the award fluctuates with changes in Citi’s common stock price until the date that the award is settled, either in cash or shares. Any fluctuation from the grant date value of the award until the award is fully vested is recognised through the income statement. (i) Stock award programme The Company participates in the Citigroup Capital Accumulation Program (CAP), under which shares of Citi common stock are awarded in the form of restricted or deferred stock to participating employees. Generally, CAP awards of restricted or deferred stock constitute a percentage of annual incentive compensation and vest over a three or four year period beginning on or about the first anniversary of the award date. Except in specific circumstances, continuous employment within Citi is required for CAP and other stock award programs to vest. The program provides that employees who meet certain age plus years-of-service requirements (retirement-eligible employees) may terminate active employment and continue vesting in their awards provided they comply with specified non-compete provisions. Awards granted to retirement-eligible employees are accrued in the year prior to the grant date in the same manner as cash incentive compensation is accrued. For all stock award programmes, the shares awarded cannot be sold or transferred by the participant during the applicable vesting period, and the award is subject to cancellation if the participant’s employment is terminated. After the award vests, the shares become freely transferable (subject to specific sale restrictions). From the date of award, the recipient of a restricted stock award can direct the vote of the shares and receive regular dividends to the extent dividends are paid on Citi common stock. Recipients of deferred stock awards receive dividend equivalents to the extent dividends are paid on Citi common stock, but cannot vote. Stock awards granted generally vest 25% per year over four years or 33% per year over 3 years. As part of remuneration since 2010, the Company entered into an arrangement referred to as an “EU Short Term” award. The award will be delivered in the form of immediately vested restricted shares subject to a six month sale restriction. 3hares awarded 7eighted average fair market value per share 2015 2014 2013 2012 2011 3,380,169 $50.54 3,744,987 $49.64 4,677,014 $44.23 6,488,348 $30.54 7,197,950 $49.96 35 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans (continued) (ii) Stock option programme Stock options have not been granted to Citi’s employees as part of the annual incentive award programs since 2009. In 2009 the Company made discretionary grants of options to eligible employees pursuant to the broad-based Citigroup Employee Option Grant (CEOG) Program under the Citigroup Stock Incentive Plan. Under CEOG, the options generally vest equally over three years, the option term is 6 years from the grant date and the shares acquired on exercise are not subject to a sale restriction. To the extent permitted, CEOG options granted to eligible UK employees were granted under an HMRC approved sub-plan with any excess over the applicable individual limit being granted under the global plan, which is not an HMRC approved plan. In 2011, outside the annual incentive award programme, Citi granted options to certain of its executive officers. The options have six-year terms and vest in three equal annual instalments. The exercise price of the options is $49.10, equal to the closing price of a share of Citi common stock on the grant date. Upon exercise of the options before the fifth anniversary of the grant date, the shares received on exercise (net of the amount required to pay taxes and the exercise price) are subject to a one-year transfer restriction. Under FRS 101 certain disclosure exemptions for share based payments are taken on the basis that equivalent disclosures are included within Citi’s audited consolidated financial statements. See Note 33 for details of where Citi’s audited consolidated financial statements may be obtained. The following table summarises the stock options outstanding under Citi stock option plans at 31 December 2015: 2015 Range of exercise prices Number outstanding Options outstanding Weighted average Weighted contractual average life exercise remaining price Options exercisable Number Exercisable Weighted average exercise price $ < $50.00 $50.01 - $399.99 $ 853,512 10,000 0.52 2.16 48.88 249.50 853,512 10,000 48.88 249.50 863,512 0.54 51.20 863,512 51.20 The weighted average share price at the exercise date for options exercised during the year was $54.64 (2014: $52.42). The following table summarises the stock options outstanding under Citi stock option plans at 31 December 2014: 2014 Range of exercise prices Number outstanding Options outstanding Weighted average Weighted contractual average life exercise remaining price Options exercisable Number Exercisable $ < $50.00 $50.01 - $399.99 Weighted average exercise price $ 3,770,010 32,564 1.00 1.54 42.98 161.43 3,769,314 32,564 42.98 161.43 3,802,574 1.01 43.99 3,801,878 43.99 36 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. (iii) Share-based incentive plans (continued) Profit and loss statement impact The table below details the profit and loss impact of the share based incentive plans. 2015 2014 $ million $ million Stock Awards Granted in 2015 119 - Granted in 2014 27 132 Granted in 2013 9 35 Granted in 2012 (1) 13 Granted in 2011 (3) (3) Granted in 2010 - (1) 27 10 178 186 Accrued Expenses Total Expense (Note 7) Fair value adjustment of intercompany recharges in equity reserve Total carrying amount of equity-settled transaction liability Total carrying amount of cash-settled transaction liability 14 (9) 344 439 7 5 2015 $’000 2014 $’000 5,174 94 4,936 97 5,268 5,033 10. Directors’ remuneration Directors’ remuneration in respect of services to the Company was as follows: Aggregate emoluments Contributions to money purchase pension scheme Contributions to the money purchase pension schemes were accruing to four of the Directors (2014: four). Four of the Directors (2014: five) of the Company participated in parent company share and share option plans and, during the year, four of the Directors (2014: none) exercised options. The remuneration of the highest paid Director was $2,587,491 (2014: $2,438,014) and accrued pension of $58,416 (2014: $59,620). The highest paid Director did (2014: did not) exercise share options during the year. The Directors benefited from qualifying third party indemnity provisions in place during the financial year and at the date of this report. The above remuneration was based on the apportionment of time incurred by the Directors for services to the Company, both in their capacity as a Director and, where applicable, their normal employment. 37 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 11. Tax on profit on ordinary activities (a) Analysis of tax charge in the year 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million Current tax: UK corporation tax Double taxation relief Overseas current tax Adjustment in respect of overseas tax for previous years Total current tax 21 (21) 28 (3) 25 20 20 Deferred tax: Origination and reversal of temporary differences - UK - overseas Rate change adjustment Total deferred tax 14 (4) (30) (20) (100) 7 (93) 5 (73) Tax charge on ordinary activities * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. (b) Factors affecting tax charge for the year Profit/(loss) on ordinary activities before tax 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 373 113 75 24 23 (21) 28 (23) (43) (3) (15) (30) 14 23 (3) 20 (19) (18) (100) 5 (73) Profit/(loss) on ordinary activities multiplied by the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK of 20.25% (2014: 21.49%) Effects of: Expenses not deductible for tax purposes Foreign tax deductions Foreign tax credits Overseas tax in respect of European branch operations and dividends received Group relief surrendered / (received) Utilisation of losses carried forward Adjustments in relation to previous years Unrecognised current year deferred tax Rate change adjustment Dererred tax on pension recognised in equity Total tax charge for year * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 38 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 11. Tax on profit on ordinary activities (continued) (c) Factors that may affect future tax charges: The Company has not recognised a deferred tax asset of $291 million (2014: $347 million) in relation to temporary differences where the recoverability of potential benefits is not considered likely. The UK Corporate tax rate applying to CGML was 20.25%. Other subsidiaries and overseas branches provided for taxation at the appropriate rates for the countries in which they operate. The main rate of corporation tax in the UK was reduced from 21% to 20% on 1 April 2015. Finance (No. 2) Act 2015 provides that the rate of corporation tax will reduce to 19% from 1 April 2017 and further to 18% from 1 April 2020. It also introduced a surcharge of 8% on the taxable profits of banking companies arising on or after 1 January 2016 over a threshold of £25 million per banking group. These rates were enacted in November 2015. 12. Cash at bank and in hand The following amounts are included within cash at bank and in hand: Cash at bank held by third parties Cash at bank held by other group undertakings 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million 1,027 912 950 621 1,939 1,571 Included within cash held by third parties is $555 million (2014: $852 million) that is held on behalf of clients in segregated accounts. Included within cash held by other group undertakings is $238 million (2014: $228 million) on behalf of clients in segregated accounts. 13. Derivatives 2015 Fair Value Asset Liability $ Million $ Million Swap agreements, swap options and interest rate cap and floor agreements 145,331 144,336 190,734 188,922 3,888 4,961 5,661 7,219 13,231 12,561 16,988 15,618 162,450 161,858 213,383 211,759 Index and equity options and similar contractual commitments Other options and contractual commitments 2014 * Fair Value Asset Liability $ Million $ Million * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 39 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets classed as held for trading Current asset investments form part of the asset trading portfolio of the Company and comprise marketable securities and other financial assets. The following amounts are included in current asset investments: Financial assets classed as held for trading Derivatives (Note 13) Inventory Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Physical Commodities Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Collateralised financing transactions 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 162,450 213,383 22,022 7,275 11,223 1,063 41,583 21,902 11,629 10,144 1,458 45,133 47,126 44,290 251,159 302,806 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 40 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values The table below sets out the Company’s classification of each class of financial assets and liabilities, and their fair values. 31 December 2015 Cash Inventory Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans 31 December 2014 * Cash Inventory Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Held for Designated at fair value Trading $ Million $ Million 41,583 162,450 - - Amortised Available for Sale cost $ Million $ Million Total carrying amount $ Million Fair value $ Million 47,126 - 1,939 46,335 15,515 7,420 114 - 31 1,939 41,583 162,450 93,461 15,515 7,420 114 31 1,939 41,583 162,450 93,461 15,515 7,420 114 31 204,033 47,126 71,323 31 322,513 322,513 161,858 28,996 - 41,067 - 11,995 34,729 18,081 6,433 1,051 5,437 - 11,995 75,796 161,858 18,081 28,996 6,433 1,051 5,437 11,995 75,796 161,858 18,081 28,996 6,433 1,051 5,941 190,854 41,067 77,726 - 309,647 310,151 Amortised Available for cost Sale $ Million $ Million Total carrying amount $ Million Fair value $ Million Held for Designated at Trading fair value $ Million $ Million 45,133 213,383 - 44,290 - 1,571 48,764 19,598 9,459 257 - 40 1,571 45,133 213,383 93,054 19,598 9,459 257 40 1,571 45,133 213,383 93,054 19,598 9,459 257 40 258,516 44,290 79,649 40 382,495 382,495 211,759 32,754 - 40,193 - 10,104 39,025 24,625 6,360 1,043 4,080 - 10,104 79,218 211,759 24,625 32,754 6,360 1,043 4,080 10,104 79,218 211,759 24,625 32,754 6,360 1,043 4,547 244,513 40,193 85,237 - 369,943 370,410 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 41 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) The following table shows an analysis of financial assets and liabilities classified as held for trading or designated at fair value by level in the hierarchy: 31 December 2015 Level 1 $ Million Level 2 $ Million Level 3 $ Million Total $ Million 43 20,455 84 10,602 - 159,376 1,564 6,968 590 1,063 3,031 3 223 31 - 162,450 22,022 7,275 11,223 1,063 31,184 169,561 3,288 204,033 - 46,907 219 47,126 31,184 216,468 3,507 251,159 18 26,280 26,298 158,206 2,713 160,919 3,634 3 3,637 161,858 28,996 190,854 Financial assets held for trading Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Physical Commodities Financial assets designated at fair value Collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Securities sold but not yet purchased Financial liabilities designated at fair value - 41,067 - 41,067 26,298 201,986 3,637 231,921 Level 1 $ Million Level 2 $ Million Level 3 $ Million Total $ Million 31 20,662 11 8,487 0 210,733 1,228 11,197 1,540 1,458 2,619 12 421 117 0 213,383 21,902 11,629 10,144 1,458 29,191 226,156 3,169 258,516 - 44,025 265 44,290 29,191 270,181 3,434 302,806 24 28,486 28,510 208,186 4,263 212,449 3,549 5 3,554 211,759 32,754 244,513 - 40,193 - 40,193 28,510 252,642 3,554 284,706 Collateralised financing transactions 31 December 2014 * Financial assets held for trading Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Physical Commodities Financial assets designated at fair value Current asset investments Collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Securities sold but not yet purchased Financial liabilities designated at fair value Collateralised financing transactions * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 42 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Given the short term nature and characteristics of trade debtors, other debtors, trade creditors, other creditors and accruals the fair value has been assumed to approximate the carrying value. The fair value of subordinated loans has been calculated using the present value of future estimated cash flows, discounted using a discount rate of USD 3 month Overnight Indexed Swap (OIS) or 3 month Euro Overnight Index Average (EONIA) plus the Company’s credit spread as at 31 December 2015. Fair Value Measurement IFRS 13 – Fair Value Measurement defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and requires disclosures about fair value measurements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Among other things, the standard requires the Company to maximise the use of observable inputs and minimise the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. Under IFRS 13, the probability of default of a counterparty is factored into the valuation of derivative positions and includes the impact of the Company’s own credit risk on derivatives and other liabilities measured at fair value. Fair Value Hierarchy The calculation of fair value incorporates the Company’s estimate of the fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities. Other entities may use different valuation methods and assumptions in determining fair values, so comparisons of fair values between entities may not necessarily be meaningful. The Company measures fair values using the following fair value hierarchy that indicates whether the inputs to those valuation techniques are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs denote market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s market assumptions. The types of inputs have created the following fair value hierarchy: • Level 1: Quoted prices for identical instruments in active markets. • Level 2: Quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets; quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active; and model-derived valuations in which all significant inputs and significant value drivers are observable in active markets. • Level 3: Valuations derived from valuation techniques in which one or more significant inputs or significant value drivers are unobservable. The Company considers relevant and observable market prices in its valuations where possible. The frequency of transactions and the size of the bid-ask spread when comparing similar transactions are factors that are driven by the liquidity of markets and determine the relevance of observed prices in those markets. Financial instruments may move between levels in the fair value hierarchy when factors such as liquidity or the observability of input parameters change. As conditions around these factors deteriorate or improve, financial instruments may transfer lower down or higher up the fair value hierarchy. The Company’s policy with respect to transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy is to recognise transfers into and out of each level as of the end of the reporting period. 43 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Determination of Fair Value As set out more fully in Note 1(c) of these financial statements, when available, the Company generally uses quoted market prices in an active market to calculate the fair value of a financial asset or liability and classifies such items as Level 1. In some cases where a market price is available, the Company will make use of alternative pricing techniques, such as matrix pricing, whereby a similar instrument is used as a proxy, to calculate fair value, in which case the items are classified as Level 2. If quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based upon internally developed valuation techniques that use, where possible, current market-based or independently sourced market parameters such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates and option volatilities. Items valued using such internally generated valuation techniques are classified according to the lowest level input or value driver that is significant to the valuation. Thus an item may be classified in Level 3 even though there may be some significant inputs that are readily observable. Where available, the Company may also make use of quoted prices for recent trading activity in positions with the same or similar characteristics to that being valued. The frequency and size of transactions and the amount of the bid-ask spread are among the factors considered in determining the liquidity of markets and the relevance of observed prices from those markets. If relevant and observable prices are available, those valuations would be classified as Level 2. If such prices are not available, other valuation techniques would be used and the item would be classified as Level 3. Fair value estimates from internal valuation techniques are verified, where possible, to prices obtained from independent vendors or brokers. Vendors’ and brokers’ valuations may be based on a variety of inputs ranging from observed prices to proprietary valuation models. The Company values a number of assets and liabilities using valuation techniques that use one or more significant inputs that are not based on observable market data. The Company grades all such assets and liabilities in order to identify those items for which a reasonably possible change in one or more assumptions is likely to have a significant impact on the fair value. Adjustments may be applied to the “base” valuations of financial assets and liabilities calculated using one of the valuation techniques described above, to ensure that the fair value measurement incorporates all factors that market participants would consider when determining fair value. Note that no such adjustments are applied to instruments that are valued using quoted prices for identical instruments in an active market. Set out below is a description of the procedures used by CGML to determine the fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities irrespective of whether they are “held for trading” or have been “designated at fair value”. This description includes an indication of the level in the fair value hierarchy in which each financial instrument is generally classified. Where appropriate, it also includes details of the valuation models, the key inputs to those models and any significant assumptions. Market valuation adjustments Market valuation adjustments are applied to items in Level 2 and Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy to ensure that the fair value reflects the liquidity or illiquidity of the market. The liquidity reserve may utilise the bid-ask spread for an instrument as one of the factors. Credit valuation adjustments Counterparty credit-risk adjustments are applied to derivatives, such as over-the-counter uncollateralised derivatives, where the base valuation uses market parameters based on the relevant base interest rate curves. Not all counterparties have the same credit risk as that implied by the relevant base curve, so it is necessary to consider the market view of the credit risk of a counterparty in order to estimate the fair value of such an item. Bilateral or “own” credit-risk adjustments are applied to reflect the Company’s own credit risk when valuing derivative liabilities and other liabilities measured at fair value. Counterparty and own credit adjustments consider the expected future cash flows between the Company and its counterparties under the terms of the instrument and the effect of credit risk on the valuation of those cash flows, rather than a point-in-time assessment of the current recognised net asset or liability. Furthermore, the credit-risk adjustments take into account the effect of credit-risk mitigants, such as pledged collateral and any legal right of offset (to the extent such offset exists) with a counterparty through arrangements such as netting agreements. 44 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Derivatives Exchange-traded derivatives in active markets are generally fair valued using quoted market prices (i.e. exchange prices) and are therefore classified as Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. The majority of derivatives entered into by the Company are executed over the counter and are valued using a combination of external prices and internal valuation techniques, including benchmarking to pricing vendor services. The valuation techniques and inputs vary according to the type of derivative and the nature of the underlying instrument. The principal methods used to value these instruments are those adopted industry wide and include discounted cash flows, modelling and numerical approaches. The type of inputs may include interest rate yield curves, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, volatilities and correlations. The Company discounts future cash flows using appropriate interest rate curves. In the case of collateralised interest rate derivatives the Company follows the terms in the collateral agreement governing the transaction. The agreements generally provide that an OIS curve is used. The OIS curves reflect the interest rate paid on the collateral against the fair value of these derivatives. Citi uses the relevant benchmark curve for the currency of the derivative (e.g., the U.S. Dollar London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) for U.S. dollar derivatives) as the discount rate for uncollateralized derivatives. Government bonds, corporate bonds and equities CGML uses quoted market prices to determine the fair value of government bonds and exchange traded equities; such items are typically classified as Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. For government bonds, corporate bonds and equities traded over the counter, for which a quoted price is not available, CGML generally determines fair value utilising internal valuation techniques. Fair value estimates from internal valuation techniques are verified, where possible, to prices obtained from independent vendors. Vendors compile prices from various sources and may apply alternative pricing techniques, such matrix pricing, whereby a similar instrument is used as a proxy for similar bonds or loans where no price is observable. If available, the Company may also use quoted prices for recent trading activity of assets with similar characteristics to the bond being valued. Government bonds, corporate bonds and equities priced using such methods are generally classified as Level 2. However, when less liquidity exists for government bonds, corporate bonds or equities, a quoted price is stale or prices from independent sources vary, they are generally classified as Level 3. Collateralised financing transactions No quoted prices exist for such financial instruments and so fair value is determined using a discounted cash-flow technique. Cash flows are estimated based on the terms of the contract, taking into account any embedded derivative or other features. Expected cash flows are discounted using market rates appropriate to the maturity of the instrument as well as the nature and amount of collateral taken or received. Generally, when such instruments are held at fair value, they are classified within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy as the inputs used in the valuation are readily observable. 45 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Category The following tables present the changes in the Level 3 fair value category for the years ended 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014. Gains and losses presented below include changes in the fair value related to both observable and unobservable inputs. CGML often hedges positions with offsetting positions that are classified in a different level. Gain/(loss) recorded in the profit and loss statement 2015 Financial assets held for trading Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Financial assets designated at fair value Collateralised financing transactions At 1 January $ Million Realised $ Million 2,619 12 421 117 (2,193) 65 27 2,488 (1) (14) (24) 21 7 278 32 (138) (13) (551) (97) (441) - 1,052 1 307 20 (377) (3) (283) (44) 3,031 3 223 31 265 (87) (7) 90 - (126) 804 (721) 218 3,434 (2,188) 2,442 428 (799) (567) 2,184 (1,428) 3,506 Unrealised Purchases $ Million $ Million Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million Transfers Transfers out At 31 into Level 3 of Level 3 December $ Million $ Million $ Million (Gain)/loss recorded in the profit and loss statement Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Securities sold but not yet purchased At 1 January $ Million 3,549 5 Realised $ Million (2,827) 2 3,554 (2,825) Unrealised Purchases $ Million 3,064 (8) 297,580 3,064 (8) Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million 28 (473) 6 (8) 34 (481) Transfers Transfers out At 31 into Level 3 of Level 3 December $ Million $ Million $ Million 1,102 (801) 3,634 3 (5) 3 1,105 (806) 3,637 Gain/(loss) recorded in the profit and loss statement 2014 * Financial assets held for trading Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Financial assets designated at fair value Collateralised financing transactions At 1 January $ Million Realised $ Million 2,741 19 1,141 111 (3,114) 32 (28) 2,525 (1) (15) 10 68 313 1,227 150 (116) (222) (1,698) (132) 94 - 800 25 315 152 (379) (122) (581) (146) 2,619 12 421 117 343 13 - 153 (58) (186) - - 265 4,355 (3,097) 2,519 1,911 (2,226) (92) 1,292 (1,228) 3,434 Unrealised Purchases $ Million $ Million Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million Transfers Transfers out At 31 into Level 3 of Level 3 December $ Million $ Million $ Million (Gain)/loss recorded in the profit and loss statement Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Securities sold but not yet purchased At 1 January $ Million 3,376 20 Realised $ Million (5,230) 2 3,396 (5,228) Unrealised Purchases $ Million 4,492 (23) 10 4,502 (23) Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million 39 70 36 (51) 75 19 Transfers Transfers out At 31 into Level 3 of Level 3 December $ Million $ Million $ Million 1,574 (749) 3,549 (12) 5 1,574 (761) 3,554 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Included in the Level 3 balance at 31 December 2015 above are intercompany assets of $1,964 million (2014: $1,570 million) and liabilities of $1,941 million (2014: $1,655 million). 46 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Valuation process for Level 3 Fair Value Measurements Price verification procedures and related internal control procedures are governed by the Citi Pricing and Price Verification Policy and Standards, which are jointly owned by Finance and Risk Management. Finance has implemented the Pricing and Price Verification Standards and Procedures to facilitate compliance with this policy. For fair value measurements of substantially all assets and liabilities held by CGML, individual business units are responsible for valuing the trading account assets and liabilities, and Product Control within Finance performs independent price verification procedures to evaluate those fair value measurements. Product Control is independent of the individual business units and reports into the Global Head of Product Control, who ultimately reports to the Citi Chief Financial Officer. Fair value measurements of assets and liabilities are determined using various techniques including, but not limited to, discounted cash flows and internal models, such as option and correlation models. Based on the observability of inputs used, Product Control classifies the inventory as Level 1, Level 2 or Level 3 within the fair value hierarchy. When a position involves one or more significant inputs that are not directly observable, additional price verification procedures are applied. These procedures may include reviewing relevant historical data, analysing profit and loss, valuing each component of a structured trade individually and benchmarking, amongst others. Reports of Level 3 inventory of each business line of the Company are distributed to senior management in Finance, Risk and the individual business lines. Reports are also discussed at the EMEA Risk Committee, the CGML Risk Committee and in monthly meetings with Senior Management. Whenever a valuation adjustment is needed to bring the price of an asset or liability to its exit price, Product Control reports it to management along with other price verification results. In addition, the pricing models used in measuring fair value are governed by an independent control framework. Although the models are developed and tested by the individual business units, they are independently validated by the Model Validation Group within Model Risk Management and reviewed by Finance with respect to their impact on the price verification procedures. The purpose of this independent control framework is to assess model risk arising from models’ theoretical soundness, calibration techniques where needed, and the appropriateness of the model for a specific product in a defined market. To ensure their continued applicability, models are independently reviewed annually. In addition, Risk Management approves and maintains a list of products permitted to be valued under each approved model for a given business. Transfers into or out of Level 3 are primarily driven by changes in the availability of independent data for positions where the Company has risk exposure, yet the market is no longer considered to be active. As liquidity and transparency improves, the financial instrument may transfer back to a previous classification level. The Level 3 financial instruments inventory remained relatively flat over the course of 2015, the main contributors to the Level 3 fair value inventory being the Rates, Finance Desk and Equity Markets businesses. Movements across purchases and sales were largely driven by asset backed securities across the European ABS business and corporate bonds across the Rates and Credit Markets. Settlements were driven by exotic equity derivatives across the Equities business and credit derivatives across the Emerging Markets Credit Trading business. Transfers into Level 3 were driven by Equity and Credit Markets, specifically activity across the Corporate Equity Derivatives and Exotics businesses, and across the European Credit and Emerging Markets Credit 47 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Trading businesses. Transfers out of Level 3 were driven by greater observability around Equity Markets, mainly across exotic equity derivatives. Unobservable inputs During the year, total changes in fair value, representing a gain of $108 million (2014: $147 million gain) were recognised in the profit and loss account relating to items where fair value was estimated using a valuation technique that incorporated one or more significant inputs based on unobservable market data. As these valuation techniques were based upon assumptions, changing the assumptions would change the estimate of fair value. The potential impact of using reasonably possible alternative assumptions for the valuation techniques for both observable and unobservable market data has been quantified as approximately $152 million (2014: $176 million). The main contributors to this impact are Equity Markets, Emerging Markets Credit Trading, Credit Trading and other cross-asset businesses. Valuation uncertainty is computed on a quarterly basis. The methodology used to derive the impact across each product is determined by applying adjustments to the price or significant model input parameters used in the valuation. The adjustments are typically computed with reference to proxy analysis using third party data. Examples of the approach used to derive sensitivity adjustments are outlined below: • Equity Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. • Credit Trading and Securitised Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data, broker data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. • Commodity Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. 48 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Valuation Techniques and Inputs for Level 3 Fair Value Measurements The following tables presents the valuation techniques covering the majority of Level 3 inventory and the most significant unobservable inputs used in Level 3 fair value measurements as of 31 December 2015 and 31 December 2014. Note that this table represents key drivers by disclosures line and may not agree back to the Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Category table. 2015 Assets Commodity and other contracts Credit derivatives Credit derivatives Equity contracts Equity contracts Equity contracts Foreign exchange contracts Interest rate contracts Interest rate contracts Securities financing transactions Corporate Bonds MBS (Non US Residential) Liabilities Commodity and other contracts Credit derivatives Credit derivatives Equity contracts Equity contracts Equity contracts Foreign exchange contracts Interest rate contracts 2014 Assets Commodity and other contracts Credit derivatives Equity contracts Equity contracts Equity contracts Foreign exchange contracts Interest rate contracts Securities financing transactions Corporate Bonds Liabilities Commodity and other contracts Credit derivatives Equity contracts Equity contracts Foreign exchange contracts Interest rate contracts Fair Value $ million Methodology Input 221 301 551 258 686 184 34 466 18 60 40 148 Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Price-based Cashflow Price-based Price-based Commodity Volatility Credit Spread Recovery Rate Equity Forward Equity Volatility Equity-Equity Correlation FX Volatility IR Lognormal Volatility Price Yield Price Price 2.0 1.0 1.0 3.0 0.0 (80.5) 0.4 10.4 0.9 1.5 0.0 1.5 83.0 597.1 75.0 100.5 440.6 100.0 25.7 137.0 100.7 4.5 139.0 98.7 % bps % % % % % % $ % $ $ 173 284 547 1,107 1,513 1,014 35 416 Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Commodity Volatility Credit Spread Recovery Rate Equity Forward Equity Volatility Equity-Equity Correlation FX Volatility IR Lognormal Volatility 2.0 1.0 1.0 82.7 0.0 (80.5) 0.4 10.4 83.0 597.1 75.0 100.5 440.6 100.0 25.7 137.0 % bps % % % % % % Fair Value $ million Methodology Input Low High Unit 349 147 429 306 108 38 587 164 195 Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Price-based Forward Price Credit Spread Equity Forward Equity Volatility Equity-Equity Correlation FX Volatility IR Lognormal Volatility Interest Rate Price 308 140 1,364 404 38 568 Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Model-based Forward Price Credit Spread Equity Forward Equity Volatility FX Volatility IR Lognormal Volatility 49 Low High Unit 35.3 1.1 89.5 9.6 (36.0) 0.4 10.3 8.0 0.0 268.8 7,815.9 100.8 82.4 53.2 58.4 196.8 9.0 146.4 % bps % % % % % % $ 35.3 1.1 89.5 9.6 0.4 10.3 268.8 3,380.0 100.8 82.4 58.4 196.8 % bps % % % % CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Sensitivity to unobservable inputs and interrelationships between unobservable inputs The impact of key unobservable inputs on the Level 3 fair value measurements may not be independent of one another. In addition, the amount and direction of the impact on a fair value measurement for a given change in an unobservable input depends on the nature of the instrument as well as whether the Company holds the instrument as an asset or a liability. For certain instruments, the pricing, hedging and risk management are sensitive to the correlation between various inputs rather than on the analysis and aggregation of the individual inputs. The following section describes the sensitivities and interrelationships of the most significant unobservable inputs used by the Company in Level 3 fair value measurements. Yield Adjusted yield is generally used to discount the projected future principal and interest cash flows on instruments, such as loans. Adjusted yield is impacted by changes in the interest rate environment and relevant credit spreads. In some circumstances, the yield of an instrument is not observable in the market and must be estimated from historical data or from yields of similar securities. This estimated yield may need to be adjusted to capture the characteristics of the security being valued. In other situations, the estimated yield may not represent sufficient market liquidity and must be adjusted as well. Whenever the amount of the adjustment is significant to the value of the security, the fair value measurement is classified as Level 3. Recovery Recovery is the proportion of the total outstanding balance of a bond or loan that is expected to be collected in a liquidation scenario. For many credit securities (such as asset-backed securities), there is no directly observable market input for recovery, but indications of recovery levels are available from pricing services. The assumed recovery of a security may differ from its actual recovery that will be observable in the future. The recovery rate impacts the valuation of credit securities. Generally, an increase in the recovery rate assumption increases the fair value of the security. An increase in loss severity, the inverse of the recovery rate, reduces the amount of principal available for distribution and, as a result, decreases the fair value of the security. Credit Spread Credit spread is a component of the security’s yield representing its credit quality. Credit spread reflects the market perception of changes in prepayment, delinquency and recovery rates. Changes in credit spread affect the fair value of securities differently depending on the characteristics and maturity profile of the security. For example, credit spread is a more significant driver of the fair value measurement of a high yield bond as compared to an investment grade bond. Generally, the credit spread for an investment grade bond is also more observable and less volatile than its high yield counterpart. Volatility Volatility represents the speed and severity of market price changes and is a key factor in pricing options. Typically, instruments can become more expensive if volatility increases. For example, as an index becomes more volatile, the cost to Citi of maintaining a given level of exposure increases because more frequent rebalancing of the portfolio is required. Volatility generally depends on the tenor of the underlying instrument and the strike price or level defined in the contract. Volatilities for certain combinations of tenor and strike are not observable. The general relationship between changes in the value of a portfolio to changes in volatility also depends on changes in interest rates and the level of the underlying index. Generally, long option positions (assets) benefit from increases in volatility, whereas short option positions (liabilities) will suffer losses. Some instruments are more sensitive to changes in volatility than others. For example, an at-the-money option would experience a larger percentage change in its fair value than a deep-in-the-money option. In addition, the fair value of an option with more than one underlying security (for example, an option on a basket of bonds) depends on the volatility of the individual underlying securities as well as their correlations. 50 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Correlation Correlation is a measure of the co-movement between two or more variables. A variety of correlation-related assumptions are required for a wide range of instruments, including equity baskets, foreign-exchange options and many other instruments. For almost all of these instruments, correlations are not observable in the market and must be estimated using historical information. Estimating correlation can be especially difficult where it may vary over time. Extracting correlation information from market data requires significant assumptions regarding the informational efficiency of the market (for example, swaption markets). Changes in correlation levels can have a major impact, favorable or unfavorable, on the value of an instrument, depending on its nature. Qualitative discussion of the ranges of significant unobservable inputs The following section describes the ranges of the most significant unobservable inputs used by the Company in Level 3 fair value measurements. The level of aggregation and the diversity of instruments held by the Company lead to a wide range of unobservable inputs that may not be evenly distributed across the Level 3 inventory. Price The price input is a significant unobservable input for certain fixed income instruments. For these instruments, the price input is expressed as a percentage of the notional amount, with a price of 100 meaning that the instrument is valued at par. For most of these instruments, the price varies between zero and slightly above 100. Relatively illiquid assets that have experienced significant losses since issuance, such as certain asset-backed securities, are at the lower end of the range, whereas most investment grade corporate bonds will fall in the middle to the higher end of the range. The price input is also a significant unobservable input for certain equity securities; however, the range of price inputs varies depending on the nature of the position, the number of shares outstanding and other factors. Yield Ranges for the yield inputs vary significantly depending upon the type of security. For example, securities that typically have lower yields, such as German or U.S. government bonds, will fall on the lower end of the range, while more illiquid securities or securities with lower credit quality, such as certain residual tranche asset-backed securities, will have much higher yield inputs. Credit Spread Credit spread is relevant primarily for fixed income and credit instruments; however, the ranges for the credit spread input can vary across instruments. For example, certain fixed income instruments, such as certificates of deposit, typically have lower credit spreads, whereas certain derivative instruments with high-risk counterparties are typically subject to higher credit spreads when they are uncollateralized or have a longer tenor. Other instruments, such as credit default swaps, also have credit spreads that vary with the attributes of the underlying obligor. Stronger companies have tighter credit spreads, and weaker companies have wider credit spreads. Volatility Similar to correlation, asset-specific volatility inputs vary widely by asset type. For example, ranges for foreign exchange volatility are generally lower and narrower than equity volatility. Equity volatilities are wider due to the nature of the equities market and the terms of certain exotic instruments. For most instruments, the interest rate volatility input is on the lower end of the range; however, for certain structured or exotic instruments (such as market-linked deposits or exotic interest rate derivatives), the range is much wider. Correlation There are many different types of correlation inputs, including credit correlation, cross-asset correlation (such as equity-interest rate correlation), and same-asset correlation (such as interest rate-interest rate correlation). Correlation inputs are generally used to value hybrid and exotic instruments. Generally, same-asset correlation inputs have a narrower range than cross-asset correlation inputs. However, due to the complex nature of many of these instruments, the ranges for correlation inputs can vary widely across portfolios. 51 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 16. Fixed asset investments and Related undertakings Cost At 1 January Additions Disposals Gains/(losses) recognised in profit and loss account At 31 December Unlisted Investments 2015 $ Million Unlisted Investments 2014 $ Million 40 8 (15) (2) 50 (9) (1) 31 40 The following amounts for subsidiary undertakings are included in fixed asset investments: 2015 $’000 2014 $’000 Cost At 1 January Additions 3,580 - 3,268 312 At 31 December 3,580 3,580 Details of all related undertakings held at 31 December 2015 as required by section 409 of the Companies Act 2006 are as follows: Subsidiary undertakings Name Country of incorporation Citigroup South Africa Credit Products (Proprietary) Limited (CSA) CGM (Monaco) SAM Citigroup Global Markets Luxembourg LLC Citigroup Global Markets Funding Luxembourg SCA Citigroup Global Markets Funding Luxembourg SaRL South Africa Monaco Luxembourg Luxembourg Luxembourg % holding in ordinary share capital 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 17. Involvement with unconsolidated structured entities The table below describes the types of structured entities that CGML does not consolidate but in which it holds an interest. CGML does not sponsor or provide any funding or liquidity facilities to any of the below entities. Type of structured entity Nature and purpose Collateralised Debt Obligation (CDO) CDO Investment Funds Fund/Limited Partnership Structure Total VIE assets CGML exposure $ millions $'000 - - 233 482 233 482 CDO CGML has synthetic exposure to the super senior tranche of the CDO which is hedged with single name credit default swaps. There is no exposure on this deal and no funding or other commitment in place. Investment funds The investors in these funds are professional or institutional investors. CGML is the derivative swap counterparty to the fund. The derivative transactions are FX options and swaps. 52 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 18. Other Assets The following amounts are included in Other Assets: Trade debtors Cash collateral pledged Other debtors Prepayments and accrued income Corporation tax recoverable Deferred tax asset (Note 21) Intangible fixed assets (Note 19) Tangible fixed assets - equipment (Note 19) Tangible fixed assets - premises improvement (Note 19) 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 7,420 15,515 114 19 6 125 223 1 6 9,459 19,598 257 17 12 105 210 2 7 23,429 29,667 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Included within Other Assets is $1,520 million (2014: $1,013 million) that is held on behalf of clients. Other Assets includes the following balances due from group undertakings: Trade debtors Cash collateral pledged Other debtors Prepayments and accrued income 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 1,383 3,165 7 1 1,776 666 45 1 4,556 2,488 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Included within Other Assets due from group undertakings is $1,082 million (2014: $546 million) that is held on behalf of clients. 53 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 19. Intangible and Tangible fixed assets The movement in Intangible and Tangible fixed assets for the year was as follows: Intangible Software $ Million Cost At 1 January 2015 Additions Disposals Tangible Fixed Assets Premises Equipment improvements $ Million $ Million 448 72 (9) 11 - 15 - At 31 December 2015 Accumulated depreciation At 1 January 2015 Charge for the year (Note 7) Additions Disposals 511 11 15 238 58 (8) 9 1 - 8 1 - At 31 December 2015 288 10 9 Net book value At 31 December 2015 223 1 6 Intangible Tangible Fixed Assets Premises Software Equipment improvements $ Million $ Million $ Million 392 11 15 56 - - - 448 11 15 181 9 7 55 - 1 Cost At 1 January 2014 Additions Disposals At 31 December 2014 Accumulated depreciation At 1 January 2014 Charge for the year (Note 7) Additions 2 - - Disposals - - - 238 9 8 210 2 7 At 31 December 2014 Net book value At 31 December 2014 54 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 20. Pledged assets Collateral accepted as security for assets The fair value of financial assets including government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities, and cash accepted that were permitted to be sold or re-pledged in the absence of default was $165 billion (2014: $150 billion). The fair value of the collateral accepted that had been re-pledged at 31 December 2015 was $163 billion (2014: $144 billion). The Company was obliged to return equivalent securities. These transactions were conducted under terms that are usual and customary to standard lending and securities borrowing and lending activities. Financial assets pledged to secure liabilities The total value of purchased financial assets including government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities and cash that were pledged as collateral for liabilities at 31 December 2015 was $42 billion (2014: $45 billion). These transactions were conducted under terms that are usual and customary to standard lending and securities borrowing and lending activities. 21. Deferred tax asset The following amounts are included within deferred tax: 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million Short term temporary differences 125 105 At 1 January (Released) / arising during the year in P&L Rate change adjustment FX movement 105 (10) 30 - 14 93 (2) At 31 December 125 105 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits from which the reversal of the underlying temporary differences can be deducted. Deferred tax is recognised on temporary differences arising in the Company's non-UK branch operations, including differences in relation to share based payments and pensions. The recognition accords with the Company's accounting policies, because it is more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits arising in these operations from which the future reversal of underlying temporary differences can be deducted. There is also a UK deferred tax asset included in the above balance to offset the deferred tax liability on the pension asset. The Company has not recognised a deferred tax asset of $291 million (2014: $347 million) in relation to temporary differences where the recoverability of potential benefits is not considered likely. The deferred tax asset is based on a rate of 26% on the assumption that the £25 million banking surcharge threshold will be allocated to another group entity. The deferred tax asset in the balance sheet comprises: Accelerated tax depreciation Deferred compensation Provisions and other temporary differences 55 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 62 46 17 125 78 11 16 105 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 21. Deferred tax asset (continued) The deferred tax charge or credit in the income statement comprises: 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million (16) 35 1 20 78 11 2 91 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million (10) 30 20 93 (2) 91 Accelerated tax depreciation Deferred compensation Provisions and other temporary differences This is made up of: (Released) / arising during the year P & L FX Rate change adjustment 22. Other Liabilities The following amounts are included within Other Liabilities. Included within ‘Other creditors and accruals’ is the accrual in respect of the bank levy. Cash collateral held Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Payroll taxes Corporation tax payable Deferred tax liability on pensions (Note 8) Provisions for liabilities and charges (Note 23) 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 18,081 6,433 1,051 40 19 116 70 24,625 6,360 1,043 38 15 100 119 25,810 32,300 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. Included within Other Liabilities are the following balances due to group undertakings: Cash collateral held Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals 2015 $ Million 2014 * $ Million 902 315 298 5,407 631 354 1,515 6,392 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 56 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 23. Provisions for liabilities Restructuring provision $ Million Litigation provisions $ Million Other provisions $ Million Total $ Million 30 (29) - 27 6 - 62 16 (39) (3) 119 22 (68) (3) 1 33 36 70 At 1 January 2015 Charge to profits Provisions utilised Exchange adjustments At 31 December 2015 No further information is disclosed in respect of the litigation provision due to its sensitive nature. Other provisions are held in respect of accounting reconciliation and control procedures as part of the balance sheet substantiation process. 24. Derecognition of financial assets and financial liabilities Transferred financial assets that are not derecognised in their entirety There are certain instances where the Company continues to recognise financial assets that it has transferred. CGML enters into collateralised financing transactions where it sells or lends debt or equity securities with a concurrent agreement to repurchase them. As significantly all of the risks and rewards of the underlying securities are retained, a collateralised financing liability is recognised and the securities remain on balance sheet. As at 31 December 2015 the Company recognised $41,632 million of assets (2014: $44,893 million), with an associated $39,131 million of collateralised financing liabilities (2014: $41,916 million). 25. Trading financial assets and liabilities Any initial gain or loss on financial instruments where valuation is dependent on techniques using unobservable parameters is deferred over the life of the contract or until the instrument is redeemed, transferred or sold or the fair value becomes observable. The table below sets out the aggregate difference yet to be recognised in profit or loss at the beginning and end of the year with a reconciliation of the changes of the balance during the year for those financial assets and liabilities classified as trading. Unamortised balance at 1 January Deferral on new transactions Recognised in profit and loss during the period: - amortisation Unamortised balance at 31 December 57 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million 53 19 35 34 (24) (16) 48 53 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 26. Subordinated loans The subordinated loans form part of the Company’s Tier 2 regulatory capital resources held to meet the capital adequacy requirements of the PRA and can only be repaid with their consent. The loans, on which interest is payable at market rates, are due to other group undertakings and are denominated in both USD and EUR. The following amounts were included within subordinated loans: Amounts falling due after five years 2015 $ Million 2014 $ Million 5,437 4,080 5,437 4,080 On 4 February 2015 the Company drew down $800 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. On 10 March 2015 the Company drew down $750 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. 27. Called up share capital CGML’s share capital comprises: Allotted, called-up and fully paid: 1,499,626,620 ordinary shares of $1 each 2015 $ Million 1,500 2014 $ Million 1,500 1,500 1,500 28. Other commitments a) Letters of credit As at 31 December 2015, the Company had $11 million (2014: $14 million) of unsecured letters of credit outstanding from banks to satisfy collateral requirements under securities borrowing agreements and margin requirements. b) Capital commitments As at 31 December 2015, the Company had no capital commitments (2014: $nil). 58 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 29. FRS 101 transition adjustments The following adjustments have been applied in order to transition the Company’s balance sheet and profit and loss account in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 with effect from 1 January 2013 as described in Note 1 'Principal Accounting Policies'. Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2013 As originally Transition reported to FRS 101 2013 $ Million Assets Financial assets at amortised cost - cash at bank and in hand - collateralised financing transactions Financial assets classed as held for trading - derivatives - inventory - financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Financial assets classed as available for sale Net pension asset Other assets Total Assets Liabilities and Equity Financial liabilities at amortised cost - bank loans and overdrafts - collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities classed as held for trading - derivatives - securities sold but not yet purchased - financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss Other liabilities Subordinated loans Total Liabilities Capital and reserves Called up share capital Capital reserve Profit and loss account Shareholders' funds Total Liabilities and Shareholders' Funds 59 2013 $ Million 2,805 50,659 Adjusted for FRS 101 2013 $ Million 2,805 50,659 77,648 41,926 48,215 50 103 12,983 5,901 115 5,055 83,549 41,926 48,215 50 218 18,038 234,389 11,071 245,460 5,881 38,244 79,999 29,429 49,230 14,652 4,200 221,635 5,881 38,244 5,087 11,033 85,086 29,429 49,230 20,598 4,200 232,668 1,500 9,989 1,265 38 1,500 9,989 1,303 12,754 38 12,792 234,389 11,071 245,460 5,946 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 29. FRS 101 transition adjustments (continued) Balance Sheet as at 31 December 2014 As originally Transition reported to FRS 101 2014 $ Million Assets Financial assets at amortised cost - cash at bank and in hand - collateralised financing transactions Financial assets classed as held for trading - derivatives - inventory - financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Financial assets classed as available for sale Net pension asset Other assets Total Assets Liabilities and Equity Financial liabilities at amortised cost - bank loans and overdrafts - collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities classed as held for trading - derivatives - securities sold but not yet purchased - financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss Other liabilities Subordinated loans Total Liabilities Capital and reserves Called up share capital Capital reserve Profit and loss account Shareholders' funds Total Liabilities and Shareholders' Funds 60 2014 $ Million 1,571 48,764 Adjusted for FRS 101 2014 $ Million 1,571 48,764 203,894 45,133 44,290 40 97 21,498 9,489 405 8,169 213,383 45,133 44,290 40 502 29,667 365,287 18,063 383,350 10,104 39,025 203,375 32,754 40,193 22,895 4,080 352,426 10,104 39,025 8,384 17,789 211,759 32,754 40,193 32,300 4,080 370,215 1,500 9,989 1,372 274 1,500 9,989 1,646 12,861 274 13,135 365,287 18,063 383,350 9,405 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 29. FRS 101 transition adjustments (continued) Profit and Loss Account for the year ended 31 December 2014 As originally Transition to reported FRS 101 Adjusted for FRS 101 $ Million $ Million $ Million Commission income and fees Net dealing income 2,195 731 (6) 2,195 725 Interest receivable Interest payable 773 (638) Gross profit 3,061 (6) 3,055 (2,955) 4 3 6 (2,955) 10 3 113 0 113 (3) 76 73 110 76 186 Operating expenses Other finance income Other income Operating profit on ordinary activities before taxation Tax on profits on ordinary activities Profit for the financial year 773 (638) Under FRS 101 the full surplus attributable to the Company's defined benefit pension scheme is recognised before any tax impact on the Company's balance sheet (2013: $115 million, 2014: $405 million). A deferred tax liability is recognised on the additional pension surplus, with a corresponding deferred tax asset also recognised up to the amount of the deferred tax liability. The deferred tax asset is expected to unwind at the same time as the taxable profit arising from the unwinding of the deferred tax liability, and will offset it. Movements on the deferred tax asset will impact the profit and loss account (2014: $76 million) with movements on the deferred tax liability being reflected in the Statement of Comprehensive Income. The Company is required to recognise on its balance sheet the fair value of positive and negative derivative assets for which it provides a clearing service on behalf of clients (2013: assets of $5,901 million, liabilities of $5,087 million; 2014: assets of $9,489 million, liabilities of $8,384 million). The collateral held or posted against these derivative assets and liabilities is recognised within Other Liabilities (2013: $5,869 million, 2014: $9,221 million) and Other Assets (2013: $5,035 million, 2014: $8,116 million). CGML has reinstated a liability that had previously been derecognised, as it was considered that the probability of having to settle the liability was very low. Under FRS 101 the liability may not be derecognised until it is extinguished. The effect of reinstating the liability is reflected in retained earnings (2013: $77 million, 2014: $83 million) with subsequent movements being included in the profit and loss account (2014: loss of $6 million). 61 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management Risk Management Overview and Culture Effective risk management is of primary importance to the Company and accordingly, the Company seeks to maintain a comprehensive risk management process. The Company utilises Citi’s risk management model and organisation, with its multi-dimensional risk oversight and its people, processes and systems to ensure robust oversight of entity risks. In addition, the Company has entity specific risk management and controls, to ensure local challenge to risk-taking and to ensure that Citi’s approach is appropriate for the Company. The activities that the Company engages in, and the risks those activities generate, must be consistent with the underlying commitment to the principles of “Responsible Finance”. “Responsible Finance” denotes conduct that is transparent, prudent and dependable, and that delivers better outcomes for Citi’s clients and society. In order to achieve these principles, Citi establishes and enforces expectations for its risk-taking activities through its risk culture, through defined roles and responsibilities and through its supporting policies, procedures and processes that enforce these standards. While the management of risk is the collective responsibility of all employees, Citi and the Company assign accountability into three lines of defence: • • • first line of defence: the business owns all of its risks and is responsible for the management of those risks; second line of defence: the Company’s control functions (e.g., risk, finance, compliance, etc.) establish standards for the management of risks and effectiveness of controls; and third line of defence: Citi’s internal audit function independently provides assurance, based on a riskbased audit plan, that processes are reliable and governance and controls are effective. Significant focus has been placed on fostering a risk culture based on a policy of taking intelligent risk with shared responsibility, without forsaking individual accountability: • • • taking intelligent risk means that the Company must identify, measure and aggregate risks and it must establish risk tolerances based on a full understanding of concentrations and tail risk; shared responsibility means that all individuals collectively bear responsibility to seek input and leverage knowledge across and within the “Three Lines of Defence”; and individual accountability means that all individuals must actively manage risk, identify issues, and make fully informed decisions that take into account all risks to the Company. The Company applies Citi’s global risk management framework, tailored as appropriate for the Company, based on the following principles established by the Chief Risk Officer: • • • • • • a defined risk appetite, aligned with business strategy; accountability through a common framework to manage risks; risk decisions based on transparent, accurate and rigorous analytics; a common risk capital model to evaluate risks; expertise, stature, authority and independence of risk managers; and risk managers empowered to make decisions and escalate issues. Reputational and Franchise Risk and New Products or Services A Citi-wide (including an EMEA-based) Business Practices Committee (BPC) reviews practices involving reputational or franchise issues. These committees review whether Citi’s business practices have been designed and implemented in a way that meets the highest standards of professionalism, integrity and ethical behaviour. Additional committees ensure that product risks are identified, evaluated and determined to be appropriate for Citi and its customers, and safeguard the existence of necessary approvals, controls and accountabilities. The New Product Approval Committee (NPAC) is designed to ensure that significant risks, including reputation and franchise risks, for all new ICG products, services or complex transactions, are identified and evaluated, determined to be appropriate, properly recorded for risk aggregation purposes, effectively controlled, and have accountabilities in place. 62 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Reputational and Franchise Risk and New Products or Services (continued) The Investment Products Risk (IPR) Committee oversees two product approval committees that facilitate analysis and discussion of new retail investment products and services created and/or distributed by Citi. The Manufacturing Product Approval Committee (MPAC) is responsible for reviewing new or modified products or transactions created by Citi that are distributed to individual investors as well as third-party retail distributors. The Distribution Product Approval Committee (DPAC) approves new investment products and services, including those created by third parties as part of Citi’s “open architecture” distribution model, before they are offered to individual investors via Citi distribution businesses (e.g. private bank, consumer, etc.). Risk Appetite Framework The Company’s risk appetite framework includes principle-based qualitative boundaries to guide behaviour and quantitative boundaries within which the Company will operate, focusing on ensuring it has sufficient capital resources for the risks to which the Company could be exposed. The Company’s Board of Directors sets the Company’s risk appetite, and incorporates management judgement regarding prudent risk taking and growth in light of the business environment within which the Company operates. The Company’s Board of Directors, with input from senior Citi and Company management, sets overarching expectations and holds management accountable for ensuring the risk profile remains within this appetite. CGML Risk Committee The CGML Risk Committee assists the Board in fulfilling its responsibility for oversight of the risks the Company faces including market, liquidity, credit, operational and certain other risks; their alignment with the Company’s strategy, capital adequacy and the macroeconomic environment; and the development of a strategy to manage these risks in line with Citi’s global risk strategy. The CGML Risk Committee meets not less than quarterly. Managing Risk across Businesses, Regions and Products Citi manages risk across three dimensions: businesses, regions and critical products. The Company’s risk management framework aims to recognise the range of the Company’s global business activities by combining corporate oversight with independent risk management functions within each business. Each of the major business groups has a Business Chief Risk Officer who is the focal point for risk decisions (such as setting risk limits or approving transactions) in the business. The independent risk managers at the business level are responsible for establishing and implementing risk management policies and practices within their business, for overseeing the risk in their business, and for responding to the needs and issues of their business. This ensures the active management of the principal risks of the Company. Regional Chief Risk Officers are accountable for the risks in their geographic area and are the primary risk contact for the regional business heads and local regulators. In addition, Product Chief Risk Officers are accountable for those areas of critical importance to Citi and are accountable for the risks within their specialities across businesses and regions, such as real estate and fundamental credit. The Product Risk Officers serve as a resource to the Chief Risk Officer, as well as enabling the Business and Regional Chief Risk Officers to focus on the dayto-day management of risks and respond in a timely manner to business needs. Risk management within the Company is overseen by the Regional Risk Manager along with the managers for the different risk types within the region, such as market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk and operational risk. The Business Management team within the Citi risk organisation seek to ensure that the risk organisation has the appropriate infrastructure, processes and management reporting capabilities, and includes the following groups: • the risk capital group, which continues to enhance the risk capital model and its consistency across all business activities; • the risk architecture group, which seeks to ensure integrated systems and common metrics, and thereby facilitates aggregation and stress testing of exposures across the institution; • the operational risk management group, which focuses on improving the effectiveness of existing controls while increasing accountability and eliminating redundancy; and • the office of Strategic Regulatory Relationships and the Chief Administrative Officer, which focuses on critical regulatory relationships as well as risk communications. 63 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Risk Aggregation and Stress Testing The Citi Chief Risk Officer is responsible for monitoring and controlling major risk exposures and concentrations across the organisation. This means aggregating risks, within and across businesses, as well as subjecting those risks to alternative stress scenarios in order to assess the potential economic impact they may have on Citi. This aggregation is also performed at a Company level. Stress tests are undertaken across Citi and the Company and cover mark-to-market, available-for-sale, and amortised cost portfolios. These firm-wide stress reports seek to measure the potential impact to Citi, the Company and its component businesses, of stresses such as the risk of very large movements in a number of key risk factors (e.g. interest rates, credit spreads), as well as the potential impact of a range of historical and hypothetical forwardlooking systemic stress scenarios. Supplementing the stress testing described above, risk management works with input from the businesses and finance to provide periodic updates to senior management and the Board of Directors on significant potential exposures across the Company arising from risk concentrations, financial market participants and other systemic issues. These risk assessments are forward-looking exercises, intended to inform senior management and the Board of Directors about the potential economic impacts to the Company that may occur, directly or indirectly, as a result of hypothetical scenarios, based on judgmental analysis from independent risk managers. The stress testing and risk assessment exercises are a supplement to the standard limit-setting and risk capital exercises described later in this section, as these processes incorporate events in the marketplace and within the Company that impact the firm’s view of the form, magnitude, correlation and timing of identified risks that may arise. In addition to enhancing awareness and understanding of potential exposures within the Company, the results of these processes serve as the starting point for risk management and mitigation strategies. Market Risk Market risk is the risk to earnings or capital from adverse changes in market factors. Price risk losses arise from fluctuations in the market value of trading and non-trading positions resulting from changes in interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, equity and commodity prices, and in their implied volatilities. The Company’s trading results are particularly exposed to movements in these market factors. The Company’s derivative transactions are principally in the equity, interest rate, credit and commodity markets. Most of the counterparties to the Company’s derivative transactions are banks and other financial institutions. Market risk is measured through a complementary set of tools, including factor sensitivity limits, Value at Risk (VaR) and stress testing. In addition the Company has a defined risk appetite framework which is supplemented by regular stress testing and daily monitoring against the Company’s VaR limit with monthly and quarterly reporting to senior management and the Board of Directors respectively. Each business that uses the Company in client facing transactions is required to establish, with approval from the independent market risk management function, a market risk limit framework for identified risk factors. This framework must clearly define approved risk profiles, include permitted product lists, and must remain within the parameters of Citi’s overall risk appetite. The established limits are monitored by market risk management. In all cases, the businesses are ultimately responsible for the market risks taken and for remaining within their defined limits. Management of this process begins with the employees who work most closely with the Group’s customers, products and markets and extends up to the senior executives who manage these businesses with a complementary aggregation up to the country level. The Company’s VaR reports are circulated daily for monitoring of: (i) the VaR usage against the overall VaR limit; (ii) the standalone VaR by market risk factor; (iii) the component Value at Risk (CVaR) contribution to total VaR; and (iv) the stressed VaR. As well as an overall VaR limit, the Company has factor sensitivity limits in place for each market risk factor that are monitored daily. Factor sensitivities are defined as the change in the value of a position for a defined change in a market risk factor (e.g. the change in the value of a Treasury bill for a one basis point change in interest rates). It is the responsibility of each business to seek to ensure that factor sensitivities are calculated and reported for all relevant risks taken within a trading portfolio. 64 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Market Risk (continued) Exposure that approaches or exceeds limit or trigger levels is escalated within market risk management and to the Company’s Market Risk Manager and Legal Entity Risk Manager, with necessary actions taken. Where the Equities business is concerned, an ex-ante stress loss based escalation framework has been put in place to cover all block trades, including accelerated equity offerings, equity underwritings, rights offerings and special situation (event-driven) transactions. Transactions with estimated stress losses above certain levels require escalation to the EMEA Chief Risk Officer, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and to the Company’s board. VaR Methodology VaR estimates the potential decline in the value of a position or a portfolio, under normal market conditions, over a specified holding period and confidence level. The VaR methodology developed and applied at Citi at a global level is also used at subsidiary level, including the Company. The Citi standard is a one-day holding period, at a 99 per cent confidence level. The VaR methodology incorporates the factor sensitivities of the trading portfolio and the volatilities and correlations of those factors. The Company’s VaR is based on the volatilities of, and correlations between, a wide range of market risk factors, including factors that track the specific issuer risk in debt and equity securities. VaR statistics can be materially different across firms due to differences in portfolio composition, differences in VaR methodologies, and differences in model parameters. Citi believes that VaR statistics can be used more effectively as indicators of trends in risk taking within a firm, rather than as a basis for inferring differences in risk taking across firms. Citi and the Company use Monte Carlo simulation, which they believe is conservatively calibrated to incorporate the greater of short-term (most recent month) and long-term (three years) market volatility. The Monte Carlo simulation involves approximately 300,000 market factors, making use of 180,000 time series, with market factors updated daily and model parameters updated weekly. VaR Limitations Although extensive back-testing of VaR hypothetical portfolios is performed, with varying concentrations by industry, risk rating and other factors, the VaR measure cannot necessarily provide an indication of the potential size of loss when it occurs. Hence a varied set of factor sensitivity limits and stress tests are used, in addition to VaR limits. A VaR limit is in place for the Company, to ensure that any excesses are discussed and resolved between risk officers and the business and entity management. This limit is complemented by the factor sensitivity triggers defined above. Although it provides a valuable guide to risk, VaR should also be viewed in the context of its limitations: • • • • • the use of historical data as a proxy for estimating future events may not encompass all potential events, particularly those of an extreme nature; the use of a one day holding period assumes that all positions can be liquidated or their risks offset in one day. This may not fully reflect the market risk arising at times of severe illiquidity, when a one day holding period may be insufficient to fully liquidate or hedge positions; the use of a 99% confidence level, by definition, does not take into account losses that might occur beyond this confidence level; VaR is calculated on the basis of exposures outstanding at close of business and therefore does not necessarily reflect intra-day exposures; and VaR is unlikely to reflect loss potential on exposures that only arise under significant market movements. Stress testing is performed on portfolios on a weekly basis to estimate the impact of extreme market movements. Stress testing is performed on individual portfolios, as well as on aggregations of portfolios and businesses, as appropriate. It is the responsibility of independent market risk management, in conjunction with the businesses, to develop stress scenarios, review the output of periodic stress testing exercises, and use the information to make judgments concerning the on-going suitability of exposure levels and limits. 65 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Market Risk (continued) The following table summarises market risk by disclosing the Company’s average VaR during the reporting period, together with the VaR as at 31 December, broken down into component Value at Risk (CVaR). CVaR represents the correlation or diversification adjusted standalone VaR contribution from a particular sub-portfolio, and to the overall 31 December VaR: Average As at 31 December Peak Average As at 31 December Peak Equity risk Interest rate risk 4.4 4.0 11.6 12.4 10.5 26.9 Equity risk Interest rate risk 9.7 6.3 24.2 20.1 9.9 32.3 2015 $ Million Foreign exchange Commodity risk risk Credit Risk 1.8 0.4 7.6 6.0 2.3 10.1 27.2 18.3 38.7 2014 $ Million Foreign exchange Commodity risk Credit Risk risk Overall VaR 1.9 3.4 6.8 66 2.6 1.1 7.6 Overall VaR 0.9 1.9 6.9 4.2 8.0 8.8 36.8 29.5 53.1 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk The Company defines liquidity risk as the risk that it will not be able to meet efficiently both expected and unexpected current and future cash flow and collateral needs without adversely affecting either daily operations or its financial condition. Citi operates as a centralised treasury model, where the overall balance sheet is managed by Treasury, through its Global Franchise and Regional Treasurers. The EMEA Regional Treasurer is supported by the UK Treasurer who is responsible for the Company’s balance sheets and liquidity profile. The UK Treasurer heads the EMEA Markets Liquidity and Balance Sheet Management group which includes a liquidity management team responsible for managing CGML’s liquidity on a day to day basis. The liquidity management team is specifically responsible for the Company’s daily funding, liquidity risk management, liquidity stress testing, and provision of oversight to the Fixed Income and Equity Finance desks (including setting and monitoring limits). The Company adheres to the Citi Global Liquidity Risk Management Policy which requires it to define its liquidity risk appetite and operate limit and trigger structures to ensure compliance. The Company is also required to comply with the European Union CRD IV delegated act which sets out certain regulatory qualitative and quantitative standards for managing liquidity. The Company’s liquidity position is calculated and reported to senior management on a daily basis and reviewed formally by the UK ALCO committee and Board of Directors. Funding and Liquidity Objectives Adequate liquidity and sources of funding are essential to Citi’s businesses. Funding and liquidity risks arise from multiple factors, many of which are beyond Citi’s control, such as disruptions in the financial markets, changes in key funding sources, credit spreads, alterations to Citi’s credit ratings and political and economic conditions across the globe. Citi’s funding and liquidity objectives are to maintain adequate liquidity to: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) fund its existing asset base; grow its core businesses; maintain sufficient excess liquidity, structured appropriately, to enable operation under a wide variety of market conditions, including both short and long term market disruptions; and satisfy regulatory requirements. These Citi-wide primary liquidity objectives are also applied at the individual Company level. CGML funds itself through a combination of secured financing, equity, long term subordinated debt, and long term and short term unsecured intercompany borrowings. Long term structural liquidity is funded through subordinated debt, stockholder’s equity and intercompany loans with a maturity of greater than a year. Short- term intercompany loans are used to manage day to day funding fluctuations. Citigroup employs a single face to the market approach for long term benchmark unsecured borrowing. Structural liquidity is originated primarily through issuance of long term debt by the parent company, Citigroup Inc. and is passed down stream to CGML and other broker dealer entities via explicit intercompany lending transactions or investment in subsidiaries. In order to meet its liquidity stress testing requirements and liquidity ratio hurdles, the Company holds a pool of liquid assets including highly liquid government bonds. This liquidity pool is reviewed on a daily basis and adjusted as necessary to maintain CGML’s key liquidity ratios and metrics. Increases to the liquidity pool are typically funded through increased unsecured long term borrowing from CGML’s parent. Liquidity Risk Management Framework The Company’s liquidity risk management framework is defined by Citi's Global Liquidity Risk Management Policy (Policy). The Policy establishes the standards for defining, measuring, limiting and reporting liquidity risk to ensure the transparency and comparability of liquidity risk taking activities and the establishment of an appropriate risk appetite. 67 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) The Policy is collectively owned by the Citi Treasurer and the Citi Chief Risk Officer and is applicable to Citigroup Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries. The Policy and any material amendments to it must be approved by the Citigroup Board of Directors. As a part of the global framework, the Company is required to prepare a detailed plan of its liquidity position which also considers the forecast of future business activities. This plan is called the Funding and Liquidity Plan (FLP) and it addresses strategic liquidity issues and establishes the parameters for identifying, measuring, monitoring and limiting liquidity risk and sets forth key assumptions for liquidity risk management. In short, the FLP is a strategic implementation of the global framework which is divided into the following components: • Contingency Funding Plan (CFP); • Intra-day liquidity risk management plan; and • Balance Sheet Funding and Liquidity Plan. The Company’s FLP is prepared annually and the liquidity profile is monitored on an on-going basis and reported daily. Liquidity risk is monitored using various ratios and limits in accordance with the Liquidity Risk Management Policy for Citi. The FLP includes analysis of the balance sheet as well as of the economic and business conditions impacting the major operating subsidiaries in the UK. As part of the FLP, liquidity limits, liquidity ratios and assumptions for periodic stress tests are reviewed and approved. Funding and Liquidity Risk Governance The UK Asset-Liability Committee (ALCO) is the primary governance committee for CGML’s balance sheet management. Among its key responsibilities are: • • • • • • • • Provide oversight of market and liquidity risks, transfer pricing and balance sheet management across businesses; Evaluation of capital adequacy, and oversight of regulatory constraints; Oversight of balance sheet trends and mix; Oversight of liquidity levels, structure, metrics and policies, including Contingency Funding Plans; Review and approval of the Annual Funding and Liquidity Plan; Management and oversight of local regulatory requirements related to the balance sheet, including liquidity and market risk regulations; Adherence to capital standards and determination of dividend repatriation recommendations; and Assessment of market conditions and macro-economic environment. Citi’s UK management team and UK ALCO monitor changes in the economic environment and any corresponding impact to the asset quality on Citi’s local and consolidated balance sheets including CGML. The UK ALCO also functions as a forum for senior management to ensure adherence to corporate wide policies and procedures, regulatory requirements and rating agency commitments. The membership of the UK ALCO includes the UK Citi Country Officer (CCO), CGML Chief Executive Officer (CEO) (chair), UK Chief Financial Officer (CFO), UK Treasurer, EMEA Regional Treasurer, UK Legal Entity Risk Manager, Independent Treasury Market Risk, Financing Desk Heads and other key business and functional heads. The UK ALCO committee meets on a monthly basis. CGML’s non-executive directors are standing invitees and regularly attend UK ALCO meetings to provide additional review and challenge. External Liquidity Risk Management Metrics From a regulatory perspective, the Company monitors its liquidity position against the European Commission liquidity coverage ratio (LCR) and the PRA’s Individual Liquidity Guidance (ILG) which advises entities of the amount and quality of high quality liquid assets which it considers appropriate, having regard to the liquidity risk 68 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) profile of an entity. Prior to 1 October 2015, the ILG referenced liquidity metrics reported under BIPRU (Prudential sourcebook for Banks, Building Societies and Investment Firms) whereas from 1 October 2015 the ILG references the LCR and also covers liquidity risks to which the Company is exposed to but which are not captured by the LCR. The Company also monitors its position against the Net Stable Funding Ratio (NSFR) adopting Basel III guidelines. Final European Commission regulatory rules and standards for the NSFR have not yet been set. The LCR is designed to promote short term resilience of an entity’s liquidity risk profile by ensuring that it has sufficient high quality liquid assets to survive an acute stress scenario lasting 30 days. The NSFR has a time horizon of one year and has been developed to promote a sustainable maturity structure of assets and liabilities. The key regulatory liquidity metrics used by the Company are summarised below: Stress Test Time Horizon Calculation ILG 3 months Liquid assets to net cash outflows LCR 30 days Liquid assets to net cash outflows NSFR 1 year Stable funding resources to stable funding requirements Throughout the year the Company was in compliance with its ILG and LCR regulatory requirements. Internal Liquidity Risk Management Metrics From an internal perspective, the Company uses two stress tests to monitor its liquidity position. The first stress test covers a 12 month survival horizon in a highly stressed market disruption scenario (S2) whilst the other covers 30 days in a severely stressed market disruption scenario with a loss of confidence in Citi (LCR Prime): Highly Stressed Market Disruption Scenario (Referred to as S2) – This scenario assumes market, credit and economic conditions are moderately to highly stressed with potential further deterioration covering a one year period. Access to the unsecured wholesale funding market is severely constrained and assumed to be unavailable. Access to the wholesale secured financing markets is also assumed to be constricted with the level of access based on the underlying collateral type. Potential changes in counterparty haircut requirements and other relevant market factors are considered when determining expected liquidity value; the severity of these impacts takes into account the quality of the underlying asset, as well as the depth of the relevant market. Other than highly liquid assets, access should be primarily limited to the rollover of existing activity. As a consequence of these conditions, Citi and CGML’s long term ratings are downgraded one notch from their current levels. Scenario modelling is designed to reflect these conditions, and where appropriate, potential operational, collateral and counterparty constraints are factored in. Loss of Confidence/Severe Market Disruption Scenario (Referred to as LCR Prime) – This is a stressed cash flow used to measure the short term (30 calendar days) survival horizon under a severe loss of confidence (idiosyncratic event) and severe market disruption scenario. The LCR Prime metric is aligned to the LCR Regulatory framework, but utilises internal assumptions which are most appropriate for managing short term liquidity risk. Overall, the LCR Prime stress test is more severe than S2, with both Citigroup and CGML assumed to experience a three-notch downgrade to their long term ratings and a one-notch downgrade to their short term ratings. Additionally, CGML’s ability to roll over existing secured financing transactions is limited to only the highest quality of securities. This is coupled with the more conservative stress assumptions relating to the Prime Brokerage business and loss of liquidity from its top 5 liquidity providers. 69 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) These metrics are calculated and monitored on a universal currency basis and in the most material currencies that constitute CGML’s balance sheet (EUR, GBP and USD). Stress Test Time Horizon Calculation LCR Prime 30 days Liquid assets to net cash outflows S2 1 year Liquid assets to net cash outflows Both LCR Prime and S2 internal liquidity metrics were in surplus as at 31 December 2015. Liquidity Stress Testing and Scenario Analysis Framework The Company’s use of stress testing and scenario analysis is intended to quantify the potential impact of a liquidity event on the Company’s balance sheet and liquidity position, and to identify viable funding alternatives that can be utilised. These scenarios include: • potential significant changes in key funding sources; • market triggers (such as credit rating downgrades); • uses of funding; and • political and economic conditions, including standard and stressed market conditions as well as Company-specific events. Some tests span liquidity events over a full year while others may cover a more intense shock over a shorter period such as 30 days. These tests can identify potential mismatches between liquidity sources and uses over a variety of time horizons, and liquidity limits are set accordingly. The stress tests and potential mismatches may be calculated with varying frequencies, with several important tests performed daily. They are also performed for the material currencies that constitute CGML’s balance sheet. CGML’s stress testing framework ensures that sufficient contingent liquidity is maintained (the liquidity pool of highly liquid assets mentioned above) after considering the impact of key liquidity risks including: • • • • • • • restriction of wholesale secured and unsecured funding through widening of haircuts, reluctance of counterparties to roll maturing transactions or lack of availability for financing for certain asset classes; intraday liquidity risk where correspondent banks and securities settlement agents or depositories withdraw or restrict secured or unsecured intraday credit facilities upon which the Company relies to make payments and settle its transactions; cross currency liquidity shortfalls arising from cash flow mismatches within a particular currency; potential outflows from off balance sheet activities such as security versus security transactions, letters of credit or committed facilities (e.g. underwriting); loss of liquidity from derivatives transactions due to asymmetric margining terms, legally agreed conditions such as rating downgrade triggers, margin calls due to large market revaluations or clearing house/exchange action, novation of liquidity accretive contracts away from the Company or increased operational diligence of certain counterparties; recognition that the Company may continue to provide funding to certain customers to preserve its franchise despite there being no legal obligation to do so; and incremental funding requirements of the Company’s Prime Brokerage and Delta One businesses from loss of internal coverage and cross funding, inability to roll repo or increased repo haircuts. Given the range of potential stresses, Citi maintains a series of contingency funding plans on a consolidated basis as well as for individual entities, including the Company. The Contingency Funding Plan (CFP) is a key component of the Global Framework and it incorporates the management plan of contingent actions in the event of crisis. The Company’s CFP includes the “playbook” for addressing liquidity and funding challenges in crisis situations, triggers, procedures, roles and responsibilities, communication plan and key contact list to manage a liquidity event. The CFP defines a crisis committee responsible for decision making and execution of contingency plans to address both short-term and longer term disruptions in funding sources. 70 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) The following table assigns the Company’s assets and liabilities to relevant maturity groupings based on the remaining period from the balance sheet date to the contractual maturity date. Note that in managing liquidity risk, management uses certain assumptions based on a combination of contractual and behavioural maturity profiles which differ from the contractual maturity dates shown below. Total $ Million On demand $ Million Cash Inventory Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments 1,939 41,583 162,450 333 41,583 162,450 1,606 - 93,461 22,965 59,005 Total financial assets 322,513 227,331 Total $ Million On demand $ Million 11,995 1,293 - 75,796 18,953 45,121 161,858 18,081 28,996 161,858 - 18,081 28,996 6,433 1,051 - 31 December 2015 Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Total financial liabilities Net liquidity gap Cumulative liquidity gap 15,515 7,420 114 31 6,433 1,051 5,437 3 months & less 3 - 12 months $ Million $ Million More than 5 years $ Million - - 376 807 - 31 10,308 376 838 3 months & less 3 - 12 months $ Million $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million 5,327 2,061 3,314 10,861 861 - - - - - - - - - - 15,515 7,420 114 83,660 - - 1 – 5 years $ Million 10,308 - 5,437 309,647 182,104 99,682 16,188 2,922 8,751 12,866 45,227 (16,022) (5,880) (2,546) (7,913) 45,227 29,205 23,325 20,779 12,866 71 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) Total $ Million On demand $ Million Cash Current asset investments Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments 1,571 45,133 213,383 111 45,133 213,383 1,460 - - - - 93,054 28,220 61,287 2,820 264 463 19,598 9,459 257 40 - 19,598 9,459 257 - - - 40 Total financial assets 382,495 286,847 92,061 2,820 264 503 Total $ Million On demand $ Million 31 December 2014 * Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Total financial liabilities Net liquidity gap Cumulative liquidity gap 3 months & less $ Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million 10,104 1,310 3,922 841 2,675 1,356 79,218 19,617 51,282 7,252 1,067 - 211,759 24,625 211,759 24,625 - - - 32,754 - 32,754 - - - 6,360 1,043 4,080 - 6,360 1,043 - - - 4,080 369,943 232,686 119,986 8,093 3,742 5,436 54,161 (27,925) (5,273) (3,478) (4,933) 54,161 26,236 20,963 17,485 12,552 12,552 * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 72 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) The table below assigns the Company’s liabilities to relevant maturity groupings based on the remaining contractual future undiscounted cash flows up to maturity. The amounts disclosed in the table are the contractual undiscounted cash flows, whereas the Company manages the liquidity risk based on a combination of contractual and behavioural maturity profiles. Derivatives are excluded from the table because they are not held for settlement over the period of contractual maturity. 31 December 2015 Contractual value $ Million On demand $Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million Subordinated loans 6,220 - 23 70 373 5,754 Total financial liabilities 6,220 - 23 70 373 5,754 31 December 2014 Contractual value $ Million On demand $Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million Subordinated loans 4,610 - 14 42 225 4,329 Total financial liabilities 4,610 - 14 42 225 4,329 Credit risk Credit risk is the potential for financial loss resulting from the failure of a borrower or counterparty to honour its financial or contractual obligations. Credit risk arises in many of the Company’s business activities, including: • • • • • • sales and trading; derivatives; securities transactions; settlement; when Citi acts as an intermediary on behalf of its clients and other third parties; and when acting as underwriter or within a capital raising capacity. Credit risk arises from the Company’s activities in OTC derivatives markets, repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements as well as securities borrowing and lending transactions and margin lending. The Company’s credit exposure on derivatives and foreign exchange contracts is primarily to professional counterparties in the global financial sector, including banks, investment banks, hedge funds, insurance companies and asset management companies. The Company enters into derivatives principally to enable customers to transfer, modify or reduce their credit, equity, interest rate and other market risks. In addition, the Company uses derivatives, and other instruments, as an end user to manage the risks to which the Company is exposed. Credit risk also arises from settlement and clearing activities, when the Company transfers an asset in advance of receiving its counter-value or advances funds to settle a transaction on behalf of a client. Concentration risk, within credit risk, is the risk associated with having credit exposure concentrated within a specific client, industry, region or other category. Credit risk is one of the most significant risks the Company faces as an institution. As a result, Citi has a wellestablished framework in place for managing credit risk across all businesses. This includes a defined risk appetite, credit limits and credit policies, both at the business level as well as at the firm-wide level. Citi’s credit risk management also includes processes and policies with respect to problem recognition, including “watch lists,” portfolio review, updated risk ratings and classification triggers. The framework is supplemented by regular stress testing and monitoring of exposures, with monthly and quarterly reporting to the senior management and the Board of Directors respectively. 73 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Credit risk (continued) The credit process is based on a series of fundamental policies, including: • • • • • joint business and independent risk management responsibility for managing credit risks; a single centre of control for each credit relationship to coordinate credit activities with that client; a requirement for a minimum of two authorised credit officer signatures on extensions of credit, one of which must be from a sponsoring credit officer in the business and the other from a credit officer in independent credit risk management; consistent risk rating standards, applicable to every Citi obligor and facility; consistent standards for credit origination documentation and remedial management; and portfolio limits to ensure diversification and maintain risk/capital alignment. Large exposure limit reports are circulated daily that show the Company’s exposure to various counterparty groupings as a proportion of its own funds. Regulations require that the Company does not exceed specified limits for its non trading book exposures. Within a certain percentage below the maximum permitted level, the Regulatory Reporting group conducts initial analysis and provides a breakdown of exposures to credit risk management. At or above the maximum permitted level, the credit risk management team takes action and escalates to the front office in order to reduce exposure to that counterparty and thereby bring exposure back within permitted levels. Similar reporting is carried out against internal limits for the trading book exposures. Wrong-way risk is an aggravated form of concentration risk and arises when there is a strong correlation between the counterparty’s probability of default and the mark-to-market value of the underlying transaction. Citi uses a range of procedures to monitor and control wrong-way risk, including requiring entities to obtain prior approval before undertaking wrong-way risk transactions outside pre-agreed guidelines. This is monitored at a Company level, and includes circulation of a monthly report that identifies CDS based, OTC or securities finance transactions (SFT) that generate specific wrong-way risk. Wrong-way risk is mitigated through the use of enforceable netting agreements and margining. The Company seeks to restrict its exposure to credit losses by entering into master netting arrangements with most counterparties with which it undertakes a significant volume of transactions. Master netting arrangements do not generally result in an offset of balance sheet assets and liabilities, as transactions are usually settled on a gross basis. However, the credit risk associated with favourable contracts is reduced by a master netting arrangement to the extent that if an event of default occurs, all amounts with the counterparty are terminated and settled on a net basis. Many of these arrangements also provide for the calling and posting of variation margin or collateral, further reducing the Company’s exposures. The internal measurement of exposure on each credit facility takes into account legally enforceable netting and margining arrangements – both in terms of current exposure and in terms of the simulated calculation of potential future exposure. 74 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Credit risk (continued) The following table presents the maximum exposure to credit risk, before taking account of any collateral held or other credit enhancements (where such credit enhancements do not meet offsetting requirements). 2015 Gross exposure Assets Impact of Amounts set Net exposure master netting off on the agreements balance sheet Cash collateral Derivatives 183,938 (21,488) 162,450 (138,737) SFTs 104,573 (11,112) 93,461 (14,595) 288,511 (32,600) 255,911 (153,332) (18,081) 183,346 (21,488) 161,858 (138,737) (15,515) 86,909 (11,112) 75,797 (14,595) 270,255 (32,600) 237,655 (153,332) (15,515) Amounts set Net exposure Impact of off on the master netting balance sheet agreements Cash collateral (18,081) - Securities Net exposure collateral (2,980) 2,652 (78,866) - (81,846) 2,652 (2,001) 5,605 Liabilities Derivatives SFTs 2014 Gross exposure Assets - (24,625) (61,202) (63,203) 5,605 Securities Net exposure collateral Derivatives 259,672 (46,289) 213,383 (182,811) SFTs 105,973 (12,919) 93,054 (11,552) 365,645 (59,208) 306,437 (194,363) (24,625) (83,423) 4,026 258,048 (46,289) 211,759 (182,811) (19,598) (1,290) 8,060 92,137 (12,919) 79,218 (11,552) (67,666) - 350,185 (59,208) 290,977 (194,363) (68,956) 8,060 - (1,921) (81,502) 4,026 - Liabilities Derivatives SFTs (19,598) * Prior periods have been adjusted in accordance with the requirements of FRS 101 as set out in Note 29. 75 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Credit risk (continued) The current asset investments offset amount in the above table relates to exposures where the counterparty has an offsetting derivative exposure with the Company and a master netting agreement is in place. These amounts do not qualify for net presentation for accounting purposes as settlement may not actually be made on a net basis. The collateralised financing transactions offset adjustment relates to balances arising from repo and reverse repo transactions. The offsets relate to balances where there is a legally enforceable right of offset in the event of counterparty default and consequently a net exposure for credit risk management purposes. However as there is no intention to settle individual transactions on a net basis under normal circumstances, they do not qualify for net presentation for accounting purposes. Credit risk exposure is monitored on an asset basis except for positions which are specifically collateralised, normally in the form of cash. As at 31 December the Company’s third party credit exposure (mark to market plus potential future exposure as determined by the Company’s internal measure) in relation to collateralised financing transactions and derivatives was distributed as shown in the table below (these exposures do not include derivative and collateralised financing transactions with other group undertakings). Since December 2015, CGML exposures are reported on a Global Organisation Code (GOC) basis. This is a consistent format across corporate risk reporting at the firm. Under this method, the amount of exposure from market-sensitive Pre-Settlement Exposure (PSE) that estimates the amount that a counterparty may owe over the life of a transaction (or a portfolio of transactions), is calculated to a higher degree of statistical confidence. The following percentages for CGML’s 2015 and 2014 exposures by industry have been reflected on the same basis. Industry 2015 % 2014 % 42.6 30.4 5.2 21.8 47.6 25.1 6.7 20.6 100 100 Commercial and universal banks Insurance and fund management (pension funds and mutual funds) Brokers and investment banks Other (including Corporates, SPVs and Hedge Funds) The credit quality of the Company’s financial assets is maintained by adherence to Citi policies on the provision of credit to counterparties. The Company monitors the credit ratings of its counterparties with the table below presenting an analysis of the Company's current asset investments and derivative transactions by rating agency designation based on Standard & Poor, Moody’s and Fitch ratings as at 31 December: Government bonds 2015 2014 Eurobonds and corporate bonds 2015 2014 Derivatives 2015 2014 % % % % % % 57.0 39.0 4.0 54.0 32.0 14.0 71.0 15.0 10.0 81.0 8.0 7.0 47.6 8.2 0.7 47.6 3.9 0.5 CCC or below Central counterparty clearing house (unrated) - - 1.0 - 1.0 - 15.5 26.8 Unrated - - 3.0 3.0 28.0 21.2 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 AAA / AA / A BBB BB / B As discussed above the maximum credit risk is mitigated through the use of collateral, netting arrangements and the application of credit limits. 76 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Country Risk Country risk is the risk that an event in a country (precipitated by developments within or external to that country) will impair the value of Citi’s franchise or will adversely affect the ability of obligors within that country to honour their obligations to Citi. Country risk events may include sovereign defaults, banking defaults or crises, currency crises and/or political events. The information below is based on Citi’s internal risk management measures. The country designation in Citi’s risk management systems is based on the country to which the client relationship, taken as a whole, is most directly exposed with regard to economic, financial, socio-political or legal risks. This includes exposure to subsidiaries within the client relationship that are domiciled outside of the country. Citi assesses the risk of loss associated with certain of the country exposures on a regular basis. These analyses take into consideration alternative scenarios that may unfold, as well as specific characteristics of the Company’s portfolio, such as transaction structure and collateral. The Company currently believes that the risk of loss associated with the exposures set forth below is likely to be materially lower than the exposure amounts disclosed below and is sized appropriately relative to its operations in these countries. The sovereign entities of all the focus countries disclosed below, as well as the financial institutions and corporations domiciled in these countries, are important clients both to the Company and to the global Citi franchise. Citi fully expects to maintain its presence in these markets to service all of its global customers. Hence the Company’s exposure in these countries may vary over time, based upon its franchise, client needs and transaction structures. The economic and fiscal situations of several European countries remained fragile in 2015, and geopolitical tensions throughout the region, including in Russia and Greece, added to the uncertainties. Fiscal and monetary actions, or expected actions, throughout the region further impacted the global financial markets. Concerns relating to sovereign defaults or a partial or complete break-up of the European Monetary Union (EMU), including potential accompanying redenomination risks and uncertainties, eventually abated somewhat in the latter half of 2015, once the EU and Greece reached agreement on the terms of the EU bail-out. The weaker performing members of the EU (Greece, Italy, Portugal and Spain, collectively referred to as GIPS countries) and Russia continued to be countries of particular focus for risk management during 2015. 2015 $ Millions Greece Italy Portugal Spain Russia Total (6) - 121 Net current funded credit exposure 1 127 (1) Net trading exposure 8 2,180 (18) 974 (372) 2,772 Net current funded exposure 9 2,307 (19) 968 (372) 2,893 Sovereigns - 41 - - - 41 Financial institutions - 25 - 9 - 34 Corporations 1 61 (1) (15) - 46 Total net current funded credit exposure 1 127 (1) (6) - 121 - - - - 40 40 - - - - 40 40 Net current funded credit exposure: Unfunded commitments Sovereigns Total unfunded commitments 77 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Country Risk (continued) 2014 $ Millions Greece Italy Portugal Spain Russia Total - 282 8 14 44 348 Net trading exposure 45 1,308 356 1,502 (2) 3,209 Net current funded exposure 45 1,590 364 1,516 42 3,557 Sovereigns - 177 - - 20 197 Financial institutions - 101 - 5 24 130 Corporations - 5 7 8 - 20 Total net current funded credit exposure - 283 7 13 44 347 - - - - - - - - - Net current funded credit exposure Net current funded credit exposure: Unfunded commitments Sovereigns Total unfunded commitments - The exposures detailed above represent nominal levels of exposure without taking account of the benefit of any collateral, but including the benefits of margin and credit protection. The net trading exposures are marked to market daily, and levels of exposure vary as the positions are maintained consistent with customer needs. As discussed above, the Company’s net exposure is significantly lower than shown in this table. Pension Risk The Company’s defined benefit schemes are measured on an actuarial basis, with the key assumptions being inflation, discount rate, mortality, and investment returns. Return on assets is an average of expected returns weighted by asset class. Mortality assumptions are based upon the relevant standard industry and national mortality tables. Discount rates are based on specific corporate bond indices which reflect the underlying yield curve of each scheme. Management judgement is required in estimating the rate of future salary growth. All assumptions are unbiased, mutually compatible and based upon market expectations at the reporting date. Operational risk (unaudited) Operational Risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, systems, or human factors, or from external events. It includes reputation and franchise risks associated with Citi’s business practices or market conduct. It also includes the risk of failing to comply with applicable laws, regulations, ethical standards or Citi policies. Operational Risk does not encompass strategic risk or the risk of loss resulting solely from authorised judgments made with respect to taking credit, market, liquidity, or insurance risk. The objective is to keep operational risk at appropriate levels relative to the characteristics of Citi’s businesses, the markets in which it operates, its capital and liquidity, and the competitive, economic and regulatory environment. Operational risk is part of the Company’s defined risk appetite framework supplemented with regular reporting and updates to the senior management and the Board of Directors. Citi maintains an Operational Risk Management (ORM) framework with a Governance Structure to ensure effective management of Operational Risk across Citi. The Governance Structure presents Three Lines of Defence as follows: 78 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Operational risk (unaudited) (continued) • • • First Line of Defence - the Business owns all risks arising from its activities, including its Operational Risk, and is responsible for its management. For example, the operational risks of new product strategies must be understood and addressed. The Business Senior management, in partnership with Independent Risk Management, must determine each Business’ Key Operational Risks. Second Line of Defence - Citi’s Independent Control Functions establish the second line of defence to oversee and challenge the effectiveness of controls and manage operational risks. The Second Line of Defence Control Functions include Risk Management and its Operational Risk Management (ORM) organisation, Compliance, Finance, Human Resources, and Legal. Operational Risk Management oversees the implementation of the ORM Framework for the management of operational risk across Citi. Third Line of Defence - Internal Audit recommends enhancements on an ongoing basis and provides independent assessment and evaluation. There are five Event Types (Categories) used by Citi for categorising Operational Risk: • • • • • Clients, Products and Business Practices; Execution, Delivery and Process Management; Fraud, Theft and Unauthorised Activity; Employment Practices and Workplace Environment; and Physical Asset and Infrastructure. To anticipate, mitigate and control operational risk, Citi maintains a system of policies and has established a consistent framework for monitoring, assessing and communicating operational risks and the overall effectiveness of the internal control environment across Citi. As part of this framework, Citi has established a Manager’s Control Assessment (MCA) programme which helps managers to self-assess key operational risks and controls and to identify and address weaknesses in the design and effectiveness of internal controls that mitigate significant operational risks. The ORM Framework establishes a foundation on which the activities of Businesses, Regions, and Functions, the resulting operational risks, and the associated controls are identified, periodically assessed, subject to corrective action, appropriately documented, and communicated. Specifically, the ORM Framework establishes minimum standards for consistent identification, measurement, monitoring, reporting, and management of operational risk across Citi. The process established by the ORM Framework is expected to lead to effective anticipation and mitigation of operational risk and improved operational risk loss experience and includes the following steps: • • • • • • Identify and assess Key Operational Risks (KOR); Design controls to mitigate identified risks; Establish Key Risk Indicators (KRI); Implement a process for early problem recognition and timely escalation; Produce comprehensive operational risk reporting; and Ensure that sufficient resources are available to actively improve the operational risk environment and mitigate emerging risks. As new products and business activities are developed, processes are designed, modified or sourced through alternative means and operational risks are considered. In addition, Operational Risk Management, within Citi’s Franchise Risk and Strategy group, proactively assists the businesses, operations and technology and the other independent control groups in enhancing the effectiveness of controls and managing operational risks across products, business lines and regions, and facilitates the management of operational risk at a Citi and Company level. Measurement To support advanced capital modelling and management, each business is required to capture relevant operational risk event information. An enhanced version of the Citi risk capital model for operational risk has been developed 79 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Operational risk (unaudited) (continued) and applied across the major business segments. The PRA has approved this model, including the associated capital allocation, for use within the Company as an “Advanced Measurement Approach”. It uses a combination of internal and external loss data to support statistical modelling of capital requirement estimates, which are then adjusted to incorporate qualitative aspects of the operational risk and control environment. To enhance its operational risk management the Company has implemented a forward looking scenario analysis to identify and quantify emerging operational risks, through a systematic process of obtaining opinions from business managers and risk management experts to devise reasoned assessments of the likelihood and loss impact of plausible, high severity operational risk losses. This development has been integrated into the operational risk capital assessment for the Company. Key operational risks identified for CGML include those set out below. Unauthorised Trading Risk / Fraud The risk of unauthorised trading and P&L manipulation is a key risk for CGML. A number of initiatives are ongoing to enhance Citi’s rogue trading prevention and detection controls framework. These include the implementation of consistent Markets-wide controls, designed to identify and prevent unauthorised trading in the Markets business and Corporate Treasury. Cyber and Data Protection Risk The cyber security threat landscape is rapidly evolving with increasingly sophisticated attacks for gain (e.g. denial of service, account takeover) on Citi, our clients and third-party applications. Citi’s Information Security programme strategy is built on a deep understanding of the threat environment through the work of the Global Information Security (GIS) Cyber Intelligence Centre (CIC). External benchmarks indicate that Citi appears to be well placed to deal with today’s threat, but due to the ever-changing evolution of the threat landscape, Citi continues to invest in its identification, prevention and detection capabilities. Conduct Risk Conduct risk is the risk that Citi’s employees or agents may – intentionally or through negligence – harm customers, clients, or the integrity of the markets, and thereby the integrity of the Company. Conduct risk spans all conduct and behaviour at the Company. Citi’s exposure to conduct risk resulted in the issuance of a Citi-wide Conduct Risk Policy which sets out a framework through which Citi manages, minimises, and mitigates its significant conduct risks, and describes the responsibilities of each of the three lines of defence for complying with the policy. Client Assets Sourcebook (CASS) Non-Compliance Risk The FCA’s Client Assets Sourcebook (CASS) sets out the requirements with which Companies must comply when holding or controlling client money and safe custody assets. The EU Directive covering the protection of client assets is contained in The Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID) and enacted through UK legislation by rules implemented by The Financial Conduct Authority (FCA). These rules are designed to help ensure that clients’ assets are protected by being held separately from the Company’s own and returned to clients within a reasonable timeframe in the event of a Company’s failure. The legislative framework also has rules that prescribe requirements for organisational arrangements, controls and governance. Citi has a Client Asset Oversight Officer whose function it is to oversee the operational effectiveness of the Company’s systems and controls, designed to achieve compliance with the regulatory requirements and who reports to the Board on this function. Citi continues to build and enhance its client asset control environment, including the operation of a governance structure. Anti-Money Laundering and Sanctions Risk Local and international Anti-Money Laundering (AML) and Sanctions requirements impact the activities carried out by the Company and its clients. Following the development of Sectoral Sanctions to address the political situation in Ukraine, Citi has developed an enhanced control infrastructure around activities that may be affected 80 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Operational risk (unaudited) (continued) by applicable Sanctions regimes. Regulatory requirements concerning AML controls continue to focus particularly on customer due diligence and suspicious activity monitoring, and Citi continues to implement enhancements in these areas. Regulatory risk and developments Dodd Frank Act The Dodd–Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and the Wall Street Transparency and Accountability Act (together commonly referred to as the Dodd-Frank Act) introduced an array of new regulations in respect of financial instruments, and the activities of major institutions transacting these products. These included: • • • • • • registration and regulatory requirements for swap dealers; an enhanced risk management framework for swaps; business conduct rules applicable when transacting swaps with certain types of counterparties; rules on mandatory clearing and trade execution of certain swaps; application of initial and variation margin rules for uncleared swaps; and a new regulatory and compliance regime relating to proprietary trading and certain relationships with, and interests in, covered funds. Financial intermediaries that transact above certain thresholds with U.S. counterparties (or counterparties with US originated guarantees) were required to register with the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC). The Directors and senior management of the Company accordingly elected to register the Company as a Swap Dealer, and the Company was provisionally registered by the CFTC as a non-US Swap Dealer in October 2013. A consequence of registering as a Swap Dealer is increased regulatory oversight by the CFTC and enhanced compliance obligations. 2015 represented the second full year of the Company operating as a CFTC-registered non-US Swap Dealer for purposes of the Dodd-Frank Act Title VII. In addition, the Volcker Rule (part of DoddFrank Title VI) finalised by US Regulators in December 2013 and became effective for compliance from July 2015, applies to Citigroup globally including activity undertaken by CGML. In December 2013 the CFTC granted limited relief from certain requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act for EUbased Swap Dealers, to the extent that Swap Dealers comply with comparable regulatory obligations under European law. The Company elected to take advantage of certain elements of this relief. Whilst this CFTC relief has, to some extent, reduced the compliance burden of the Dodd-Frank Act upon the Company, it continues to be subject to significant aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act. A governance structure was implemented to assist the Board of Directors in overseeing ongoing compliance with the Company’s regulatory obligations under the Dodd-Frank Act. This included the establishment of a Swap Dealer Governing Body (constituted by the Company’s CEO and senior representatives of the Business and control functions including Compliance and Risk) and various subcommittees. The CEO and EMEA Head of Markets act as co-chairs of the Swap Dealer Governing Body and are responsible for updating the Company’s Board of Directors on a regular basis as to the Company’s compliance with the Dodd-Frank Act and any material breaches thereof. Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company’s Head of Compliance and CF10 Compliance Oversight Officer also produces an annual report addressed to the Chief Executive Officer, outlining the Company’s compliance with certain matters prescribed under the DoddFrank Act. European Market Infrastructure Regulation (EMIR) Similarly to the Dodd-Frank Act in the US, the EU’s EMIR regulation introduces mandatory central clearing of transactions with certain counterparties that will impact the Company, with potential liquidity, expense and capital considerations. The regulation requires all counterparties to report details of contracts to an authorised trade repository (TR) and to comply with certain risk mitigation requirements for non-cleared derivatives. Exposure to Central Counterparty Clearing Houses (CCPs) will need to be carefully monitored and managed as any other relationship within the Company’s credit risk management framework. Final rules for client clearing of OTC derivatives and the implications of mandatory margin requirements for derivatives not cleared will continue to be closely monitored, as will the rules for intragroup trades with EU and non-EU affiliates. The Company is 81 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 30. Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Regulatory risk and developments (continued) currently engaged in system developments to ensure implementation readiness once the final phases of the regulation come into effect. Recast Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID II) and Regulation on Markets in Financial Instruments (MiFIR) MiFID II and MiFIR, which shall replace the current Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID), were originally planned to be implemented in January 2017, but may now be subject to a delay of one year. The MiFID II and MiFIR reforms will have a significant impact on a number of areas including: • scope of exemptions; • market structure; • transparency requirements; • transaction reporting; • algorithmic trading; • commodities; • the third country regime; • investment research; and • supervision. MiFID II and MiFIR will increase the transparency requirements for the equities market and introduce new transparency requirements for fixed income instruments and derivatives, with additional requirements including the submission of post-trade data to Authorised Reporting Mechanisms. There will be increased conduct of business requirements aimed at increasing investor protection to a broader range of clients, including rules relating to inducements and the provision of investment research. Strengthened supervisory powers and administrative sanctions will also apply. As well as revising and enhancing some existing MiFID requirements, MiFID II and MiFIR also introduces new concepts and obligations including, a new multilateral, discretionary trading venue for non-equity instruments, the Organised Trading Facility (OTF), and an extension of the Systematic Internaliser (SI) regime to non-equity instruments. There will also be a requirement for investment firms to trade listed equities on a Regulated Market, Multilateral Trading Facility, OTF or SI. There are new requirements for: • • • • • commodity position limits and reporting; organised trading venues; trading controls for algorithmic trading activities; an obligation to trade clearable derivatives on trading venues; and the introduction of a harmonised EU regime for access to trading venues, CCPs and benchmarks. 31. Registered charges The Company has granted to various banks and other entities a number of fixed and floating charges over certain holdings in securities, properties, collateral and monies held by or on behalf of such banks or other entities. 32. Post balance sheet events During 2016 a number of staff, assets and contracts were transferred from CGML to another Citi affiliate in order to comply with various regulatory requirements concerning operational continuity. Whilst this will have an impact of the direction of transfer pricing activities, the overall net impact to CGML’s earnings is not material. 82 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 33. Group structure The Company’s immediate parent undertaking is Citigroup Global Markets Holdings Bahamas Limited (CGMHBL), a company registered in the Bahamas. It was transferred from its previous parent, CGMEL, on a going concern basis during 2015. The Company’s ultimate parent company and ultimate controlling party is Citigroup Inc., incorporated in the State of Delaware, United States of America. The audited consolidated financial statements of Citigroup Inc. are made available to the public annually in accordance with Securities and Exchange Commission regulations and may be obtained from http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/overview.html 34. Segmental analysis As outlined in the Strategic Report, the Company is Citi’s international broker dealer and management reviews its performance by geography in the same way as Citigroup Inc. reports its performance. It is organised into four regions, Asia Pacific, EMEA, Latin America and North America. Asia EMEA Latin America North America Total Regional Other / Corp Total $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million 2015 Revenues 149 1,677 (5) 19 1,840 1,419 3,259 2014 Revenues * 192 1,439 15 63 1,709 1,346 3,055 Increase (decrease) compared to prior year (43) (20) (44) 131 73 204 Revenue by Region 238 35. Country by country reporting The information relating to Country-by-Country reporting, required by Article 89 of Directive 2013/36/EU (Capital Requirements Directive), will be published at http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/reg.htm. 83 INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT TO THE MEMBER OF CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED We have audited the financial statements of Citigroup Global Markets Limited for the year ended 31 December 2014 set out on pages 15 to 69. The financial reporting framework that has been applied in their preparation is applicable law and United Kingdom Accounting Standards (United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice). This report is made solely to the Company's member, as a body, in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company's member those matters we are required to state to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company's member, as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. Respective responsibilities of Directors and Auditor As explained more fully in the Directors' Responsibilities Statement set out on pages 3 and 4, the Directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. Our responsibility is to audit, and express our opinion on, the financial statements in accordance with applicable law and International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland). Those standards require us to comply with the Auditing Practices Board's (APB's) Ethical Standards for Auditors. Scope of the audit of the financial statements A description of the scope of an audit of financial statements is provided on the Financial Reporting Council's website at www.frc.org.uk/auditscopeukprivate. Opinion on financial statements In our opinion the financial statements: • give a true and fair view of the state of the Company's affairs as at 31 December 2014 and of its profit for the year then ended; • have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice; and • have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. Opinion on other matter prescribed by the Companies Act 2006 In our opinion the information given in the Strategic Report and the Directors' Report for the financial year for which the financial statements are prepared is consistent with the financial statements. Matters on which we are required to report by exception We have nothing to report in respect of the following matters where the Companies Act 2006 requires us to report to you if, in our opinion: • adequate accounting records have not been kept, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or • the financial statements are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns; or • certain disclosures of directors' remuneration specified by law are not made; or • we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit. Richard Faulkner (Senior Statutory Auditor) for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor Chartered Accountants 15 Canada Square London E14 5GL 27th March 2015 14 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNT for the year ended 31 December 2014 Notes 2014 2013 $ Million $ Million Commission income and fees Net dealing income 4 6 2,195 731 1,618 1,085 Interest receivable Interest payable 5 5 773 (638) 897 (797) 3,061 2,803 (2,955) 4 3 (3,021) (3) 12 113 (209) (3) (25) 110 (234) Gross profit Operating expenses Other finance income/( expense) Other income 7 8 Operating profit/(loss) on ordinary activities before taxation Tax on profits/(losses) on ordinary activities 11(a) Profit/(loss) for the financial year The accompanying notes on pages 18 to 69 form an integral part of these financial statements. 15 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED STATEMENT OF TOTAL RECOGNISED GAINS AND LOSSES (STRGL) for the year ended 31 December 2014 Notes 2014 2013 $ Million $ Million 110 (234) 5 (50) 115 (284) Profit/(loss) for the financial year Net movement in STRGL in respect of the pension scheme 8 Total recognised gain/(loss) for the financial year RECONCILIATION OF MOVEMENTS IN SHAREHOLDER’S FUNDS for the year ended 31 December 2014 2014 2013 $ Million $ Million 110 (234) (8) 5 3,000 (83) (50) Opening shareholder’s funds 12,754 10,119 Closing shareholder’s funds 12,861 12,754 Notes Profit/(loss) for the financial year Capital Contribution Share based payment transactions Other recognised gains/(losses) relating to the year (net) 27 9 8 The accompanying notes on pages 18 to 69 form an integral part of these financial statements. 16 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED BALANCE SHEET as at 31 December 2014 Notes 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Fixed assets Tangible fixed assets Fixed Asset Investments 12 13 219 40 259 221 50 271 Current assets Debtors Investments Cash at bank and in hand 15 17 19 114,304 249,027 1,571 111,623 119,574 2,805 Debtors: amounts due after more than one year Debtors 15 29 364,931 13 234,015 Creditors: amounts falling due within one year Creditors 21 348,105 348,105 217,219 217,219 16,797 17,085 16,796 17,067 122 4,080 4,202 119 160 4,200 4,360 56 12,764 12,651 97 103 12,861 12,754 1,500 9,989 1,372 1,500 9,989 1,265 12,861 12,754 Net current assets Total assets, less current liabilities Creditors: amounts falling due after more than one year Creditors Subordinated loans 21 24 Provisions for liabilities 25 Net assets excluding net pension asset Net pension asset 8 Net assets Capital and reserves Called up share capital Capital reserve Profit and loss account 26 27 27 Shareholder’s funds The accompanying notes on pages 18 to 69 form an integral part of these financial statements. The financial statements on pages 15 to 69 were approved by the Directors on 26 March 2015 and were signed on their behalf by: J Bardrick Director Registered Number: 01763297 17 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (a) Basis of presentation The financial statements have been prepared in accordance with UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice and the Companies Act 2006. The financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention with the following exceptions: • • derivative and trading financial instruments are measured at fair value; and financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss are measured at fair value. The risks and uncertainties faced by the Company are discussed further in the Directors’ Report and Strategic Report on pages 1 to 13, including details on where to find information about the risks faced by the Company’s parent. The Directors acknowledge and accept the intent and ability of Citi to provide support to the Company if required and consequently present these financial statements on a going concern basis. The principal accounting policies have been applied consistently throughout the current and preceding year. Forthcoming changes to accounting standards: The Financial Reporting Council (FRC) revised the financial reporting standards for the United Kingdom and Republic of Ireland. This revision fundamentally reforms financial reporting, replacing almost all extant standards with three Financial Reporting Standards which are effective for periods beginning on or after 1 January 2015. • • • FRS 100 “Application of Financial Reporting Requirements” sets out a new financial reporting regime explaining which standards apply to which entity and when an entity can apply the reduced disclosure framework. FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework” sets out the disclosure exemptions for the individual financial statements of subsidiaries, including intermediate parents, and ultimate parents that otherwise apply the recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements of EU-adopted International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). FRS 102 “The Financial Reporting Standard applicable in the UK and Republic of Ireland” based on the IFRS for SMEs, with amendments for application in the UK and Republic of Ireland. For periods beginning 1 January 2015, the Company will adopt FRS 101. The adoption is not expected to result in significant changes to assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity of the Company as at 1 January 2015. Other matters: The financial statements have been prepared in US Dollars, which is the functional currency of the Company, and any reference to $ in these financial statements refers to US Dollars. As permitted under section 400 of the Companies Act 2006, consolidated financial statements have not been prepared because the Company is a wholly owned subsidiary of Citigroup Global Markets Europe Limited (CGMEL) which prepares annual consolidated financial statements and is incorporated and registered in England and Wales. Under the wholly owned group exemption of FRS 8, “Related Party Disclosures”, the Company is not required to disclose all transactions with other group companies and investees of the group qualifying as related parties. The Company has taken the subsidiary undertaking exemption permitted by FRS 1, “Cash Flow Statements”, and has not prepared a cash flow statement. The Company’s results are included in the consolidated financial statements of Citigroup Inc., the Company’s ultimate parent company. Citigroup Inc. makes its financial statements available to the public on an annual basis. 18 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (b) Financial instruments Trading assets and trading liabilities Financial instruments that have been acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the near term, or form part of a portfolio of financial instruments that are managed together and for which there is evidence of short term profit taking are classified as “held for trading”. Financial assets classified as “held for trading” include collateralised financing transactions, government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities, certificates of deposit, commercial paper and derivatives. Financial liabilities classified as “held for trading” include securities sold but not yet purchased, collateralised financing transactions and derivatives. Trading assets and liabilities are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. Any changes in fair value between trade date and settlement date are reported in the profit and loss account. Gains and losses realised on disposal or redemption and unrealised gains and losses from changes in fair value are reported in the profit and loss account. Derivative contracts Derivative contracts used in trading activities are recognised at fair value on the date the derivative is entered into and are subsequently re-measured at fair value. All derivatives are carried as assets when fair value is positive and as liabilities when fair value is negative. Gains and losses realised on disposal or redemption and unrealised gains and losses from changes in fair value are reported in the profit and loss account. . Repurchase and resale agreements Repurchase and resale agreements are treated as collateralised financing transactions. Securities which have been sold with an agreement to repurchase continue to be shown on the balance sheet and the sale proceeds are recorded as a collateralised financing transaction within creditors. Securities acquired in purchase and resale transactions are not recognised in the balance sheet and the purchase is recorded as a collateralised financing transaction within debtors. The difference between the sale price and the repurchase price is recognised over the life of the transaction and is charged or credited to the profit and loss account as interest payable or receivable. Assets and liabilities recognised under collateralised financing transactions are classified as “held for trading” and are recorded at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in the profit and loss account. Financial instruments designated at fair value Financial instruments, other than those held for trading, are classified as fair value through profit and loss when they meet one or more of the criteria set out below, and are so designated by management. The Company may designate financial instruments at fair value when this will: • • • eliminate or significantly reduce valuation or recognition inconsistencies that would otherwise arise from measuring financial assets or financial liabilities, or recognising gains and losses on them, on different bases; apply to groups of financial assets, financial liabilities or combinations thereof that are managed, and their performance evaluated, on a fair value basis in accordance with a documented risk management or investment strategy, and where information about groups of financial instruments is reported to management on that basis; and relate to financial instruments containing one or more embedded derivatives that significantly modify the cash flows resulting from those financial instruments. The fair value designation, once made, is irrevocable. Designated financial instruments are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. Gains and losses realised on disposal or redemption and unrealised gains and losses from changes in fair value are reported in the profit and loss account. 19 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. (b) Principal accounting policies (continued) Financial instruments (continued) The Company has elected to apply the fair value option to certain corporate bonds on the basis that such bonds are part of a portfolio that is managed and evaluated on a fair value basis. Other financial assets Financial assets other than those which are classified as “held for trading” or “designated at fair value through profit and loss” are classified as loans and receivables. Loans and receivables incorporate trade debtors, including settlement receivables, and are initially recognised at fair value including direct and incremental transaction costs and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. At each reporting date the Company assesses whether there is objective evidence that financial assets carried at amortised cost are impaired. A financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired when objective evidence demonstrates that a loss event has occurred after the initial recognition of the asset(s), and that the loss event has an impact on the future cash flows of the asset(s) that can be estimated reliably. Objective evidence that financial assets are impaired can include significant financial difficulty of the debtor or other observable data such as adverse changes in the payment status of debtors, or economic conditions that correlate with defaults of the debtor. Impairment losses on assets carried at amortised cost are measured as the difference between the carrying amount of the financial asset and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the asset’s original effective interest rate. Impairment losses are recognised in profit or loss and reflected in an allowance account against loans and receivables. Interest on impaired assets continues to be recognised through the unwinding of the discount. When a subsequent event causes the amount of impairment loss to decrease, the decrease in impairment loss is reversed through profit or loss. The Company writes off loans and receivables and fixed asset investments when they are determined to be uncollectible. Other financial liabilities and subordinated loans Financial liabilities and subordinated loans are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate, except those which are “held for trading”, which are held at fair value through the profit and loss account. Determination of fair value Where the classification of a financial instrument requires it to be stated at fair value, this is determined by reference to the quoted market value in an active market wherever possible. Where no such active market exists for the particular instrument, the Company uses a valuation technique to arrive at the fair value, including the use of prices obtained in recent arms’ length transactions, discounted cash flow analysis, option pricing models and other valuation techniques commonly used by market participants. See Note 14 ‘Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values’ for further details. Collateral The Company receives collateral from customers as part of its business activities. Collateral can take the form of cash, securities or other assets. Where cash collateral (client money) is received this is recorded on the balance sheet and, where required by collateral agreements, is held in segregated client cash accounts. The Company does not recognise non-cash collateral on its balance sheet. Offsetting financial instruments Financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the balance sheet only when there is a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. 20 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (b) Financial instruments (continued) Derecognition of financial assets and financial liabilities Financial assets are derecognised when the right to receive cash flows from the assets has expired or when the Company has transferred its contractual right to receive the cash flows of the financial assets and either substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership have been transferred or substantially all the risks and rewards have neither been retained nor transferred but control is not retained. If the Company enters into a transaction that results in it retaining significantly all of the risks and rewards of a financial asset it will continue to recognise that financial asset and will recognise a financial liability equal to the consideration received under the transaction. In transactions in which the Company neither retains nor transfers substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a financial asset and it retains control over the asset, the group continues to recognise the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement, determined by the extent to which it is exposed to changes in the value of the transferred asset. Financial liabilities are derecognised when they are extinguished, that is when the obligation is modified, exchanged, discharged, cancelled or expired. (c) Physical commodities Physical commodities are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. Realised gains and losses on sales of commodities inventory are included in Net dealing income. (d) Commission income and fees Commission revenues and expenses are recognised when the right to consideration has been obtained in exchange for performance. (e) Interest receivable and payable Interest income and expense is recognised in the profit and loss account for all financial assets classified as loans and receivables and non-trading financial liabilities, using the effective interest rate method. Interest arising on financial assets or financial liabilities that are “held for trading” or “designated at fair value” is reported within interest income and expense respectively. (f) Net dealing income Net dealing income comprises gains and losses related to trading assets, trading liabilities and financial assets designated at fair value and physical commodities, and includes all realised and unrealised fair value changes, dividends and foreign exchange differences. (g) Tangible fixed assets Tangible fixed assets are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation. The cost of developed software includes directly attributable internal costs and the cost of external consultants. Depreciation is provided at rates calculated to write-off the cost, less the estimated residual value of each asset, on a straight-line basis over its expected economic useful life, as follows: Premises improvements Equipment Capitalised software - lesser of the life of the lease or 10 years 3 to 5 years 5 to 10 years At each reporting date the Company assesses whether there is any indication that tangible fixed assets are impaired. 21 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (h) Fixed asset investments Investments in subsidiary undertakings are stated at cost, less any write down for diminution in value regarded as permanent. Non-subsidiary investments are initially recognised at fair value on settlement date and subsequently re-measured with value changes being recognised in earnings. (i) Taxation The charge for taxation is based on the taxable profits/losses for the year and takes into account taxation deferred because of timing differences between the treatment of certain items for taxation and accounting purposes. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits from which the future reversal of the underlying timing differences can be deducted. Full provision is made for deferred tax assets and liabilities arising from timing differences between the recognition of gains and losses in the financial statements and their treatment for tax purposes except as otherwise provided by FRS 19 on an undiscounted basis. (j) Pension and other post retirement benefit costs The Company operates both a defined benefit and a defined contribution pension scheme. The cost of the Company’s defined contribution pension scheme is the amount of contributions payable in respect of the year. For defined benefit obligations, the current service cost and any past service costs are included in the profit and loss account within operating expenses and the expected return on the scheme’s assets, net of the impact of the unwinding of the discount on scheme liabilities, is included within other finance income. The postretirement benefit surplus or deficit is included on the balance sheet, net of the related deferred tax. Actuarial gains and losses are recognised in the statement of total recognised gains and losses. These include differences between the expected and actual return on scheme assets and differences which arise from experience and assumption changes. (j) Pension and other post retirement benefit costs (continued) Under FRS 17 paragraph 41, net asset surpluses can only be recognised on the balance sheet if the surplus can be recovered either by a refund to the Company (which must have been agreed at the balance sheet date) or by the reduction of future employer contributions. FRS 17 specifies that the maximum amount that can be recognised in respect of the reduction of future contributions is the present value of the liability expected to arise from future service, net of employee contributions. (k) Foreign currencies Transactions in foreign currencies are recorded using the rate of exchange at the date of transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollars are translated into US Dollars using the year end spot exchange rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollar that are classified as “held for trading” or “designated at fair value” are translated into US Dollars using the year end spot rate. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than US Dollars that are not measured at fair value have been translated at the relevant historical exchange rates. Any gains or losses on exchange are taken to the profit and loss account as incurred. 22 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Principal accounting policies (continued) (l) Share-based incentive plans The Company participates in a number of Citigroup Inc. (Citi) share-based incentive plans under which Citi grants shares to the Company’s employees. Pursuant to a separate Stock Plans Affiliate Participation Agreement (SPAPA) the Company makes a cash settlement to Citi for the fair value of the share-based incentive awards delivered to the Company’s employees under these plans. The Company applies equity-settled accounting for its share based incentive plans, with separate accounting for its associated obligations to make payments to Citigroup Inc. The Company recognises the fair value of the awards at grant date as compensation expense over the vesting period with a credit to the intercompany payable to Citigroup Inc. All amounts paid to Citigroup Inc. and the associated obligations are recognised over the vesting period. Subsequent changes in the fair value of all unexercised awards are reviewed annually and any changes in value are recognised in the equity reserve, again over the vesting period. The SPAPA is also updated annually. For Citi’s share based incentive plans that have a graded vested period each “tranche” of the award is treated as a separate award. Where a plan has a cliff vest, the award only has a single “tranche”. The expense is recognised as follows: % of expense recognised Year 3 Year 1 Year 2 75% 25% 50% 50% 61% 28% 11% 33% 33% 33% 52% 27% 15% 25% 25% 25% Vesting Period of Award 2 Years (2 Tranches) 2 Years (1 Tranche) 3 Years (3 Tranches) 3 years (1 Tranche) 4 Years (4 Tranches) 4 Years (1 Tranche) Year 4 6% 25% Employees who meet certain age plus years of service requirements (retirement eligible employees) may terminate active employment and continue vesting in their awards provided they comply with specified non-compete provisions. The cost of share based incentive plans are recognised over the requisite service period. For awards granted to retirement eligible employees, the services are provided prior to grant date, and subsequently the costs are accrued in the year prior to the grant date. EU Short Term awards are a form of Capital Accumulation Program (CAP) awarded to qualifying staff. The award is accounted for similarly to CAP awards but is delivered in the form of immediately vested restricted shares subject to a six month sale restriction. (m) Profit sharing plan In October 2010, the Committee approved awards under the 2010 Key Employee Profit Sharing Plan (KEPSP) which entitled participants to profit-sharing payments if performance measurements between 1 January 2010 and 31 December 2012 were achieved. Participants received an initial payment in 2013 and the remaining payment in 2014. As the vesting and performance conditions were satisfied, participants received the product of the cumulative pre-tax income of Citicorp (as defined in the KEPSP) for the performance period and the participant’s applicable percentage. These have been accounted for on an accrual basis and the expense recognised in employee remuneration. 23 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 2. Use of assumptions, estimates and judgements The results of the Company are sensitive to the accounting policies, assumptions and estimates that underlie the preparation of its financial statements. The accounting policies used in the preparation of the financial statements are described in detail above. The preparation of financial statements requires management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from these estimates. Estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimate is revised and in any future periods affected. Further information about those areas where estimation, uncertainty and the application of critical judgements to accounting policies have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the financial statements are set out below. Valuation of financial instruments The Company’s accounting policy for valuation of financial instruments is described in Note 1(b). The fair values of financial instruments that are not quoted in active markets are determined by using valuation techniques. To the extent practicable, models use only observable data. Where this is not possible, management may be required to make estimates. Note 14 ‘Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values’ discusses further the valuation of financial instruments. Credit value adjustment The Company has a number of financial liabilities that are valued at fair value. Under FRS 26, the Company is required to consider its own credit risk in determining the fair value of such financial liabilities. Management judgement is required in determining the appropriate measure of own credit risk to be included in the valuation model of the financial liability. Credit valuation adjustments (CVA) and, effective in the third quarter of 2014, funding valuation adjustments (FVA), are applied to OTC derivative instruments in which the base valuation generally discounts expected cash flows using the relevant base interest rate curve for the currency of the derivative (e.g., LIBOR for uncollateralized U.S. dollar derivatives). As not all counterparties have the same credit risk as that implied by the relevant base curve, a CVA is necessary to incorporate the market view of both counterparty credit risk and Citi’s own credit risk in the valuation. FVA reflects a market funding risk premium inherent in the uncollateralized portion of derivative portfolios and in collateralized derivatives where the terms of the agreement do not permit the reuse of the collateral received. Citi’s CVA methodology is composed of two steps. First, the credit exposure profile for each counterparty is determined using the terms of all individual derivative positions and a Monte Carlo simulation or other quantitative analysis to generate a series of expected cash flows at future points in time. The calculation of this exposure profile considers the effect of credit risk mitigants, including pledged cash or other collateral and any legal right of offset that exists with counterparty through arrangements such as netting agreements. Individual derivative contracts that are subject to an enforceable master netting agreement with a counterparty are aggregated for this purpose, since it is those aggregate net cash flows that are subject to non-performance risk. This process identifies specific, point-in-time future cash flows that are subject to non-performance risk, rather than using the current recognized net asset or liability as a basis to measure the CVA. Second, market-based views of default probabilities derived from observed credit spreads in the credit default swap (CDS) market are applied to the expected future cash flows determined in step one. Citi’s own-credit CVA is determined using Citi-specific CDS spreads for the relevant tenor. Generally, counterparty CVA is determined using CDS spread indices for each credit rating and tenor. For certain identified netting sets where individual analysis is practicable (e.g., exposures to counterparties with liquid CDSs), counterparty-specific CDS spreads are used. The CVA and FVA are designed to incorporate a market view of the credit and funding risk, respectively, inherent in the derivative portfolio. However, most unsecured derivative instruments are negotiated bilateral contracts and are not commonly transferred to third parties. Derivative instruments are normally settled contractually or, if terminated early, are terminated at a value negotiated bilaterally between the counterparties. Thus, the CVA and FVA may not be realized upon a settlement or termination in the normal course of business. In addition, all or a 24 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 2. Use of assumptions, estimates and judgements (continued) Credit value adjustment (continued) portion of these adjustments may be reversed or otherwise adjusted in future periods in the event of changes in the credit or funding risk associated with the derivative instruments. During 2014 the Company recorded net CVA losses of $19 million (2013: $63 million losses) due to the narrowing of the Company’s credit spreads. These were offset by a net FVA gain of $ 22 million (2013: nil) due to the tightening of Citi’s bond spreads throughout 2014. The total adjustment recorded in the balance sheet at the year-end was $180 million (2013: $193 million). Pension The Company’s defined benefit schemes are measured on an actuarial basis, with the key assumptions being inflation, discount rate, mortality, and investment returns. Return on assets is an average of expected returns weighted by asset class. Returns on investments in equity are based upon government bond yields with a premium to reflect an additional return expected on equity investments. Mortality assumptions are based upon the relevant standard industry and national mortality tables. Discount rates are based on specific corporate bond indices which reflect the underlying yield curve of each scheme. Management judgement is required in estimating the rate of future salary growth. All assumptions are unbiased, mutually compatible and based upon market expectations at the reporting date. Share-based incentive plans Awards granted through Citi's Stock Option Programme are measured by applying an option pricing model, taking into account the terms and conditions of the programme. Analysis of past exercise behaviour, Citi's dividend history and historical volatility are inputs to the valuation model. Management judgement is required in estimating the forfeiture rate. 3. Turnover and results As permitted by paragraph 4 of Schedule 1 to the Companies Act 2006 The Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 (SI 2008 No 410), the format of the profit and loss account has been adapted to the circumstances of the Company. Instead of turnover, the Directors have reported commission income and fees, net dealing income and interest income less interest expense in determining the gross profit of the Company. 25 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS . 4. Commission income and fees Commission income and fees are derived from underwriting activities, marketing securities owned by other group undertakings, trading services provided to other group undertakings and corporate finance fees associated with mergers and acquisitions and other corporate finance advisory activities. 5. Interest receivable and interest payable Interest receivable comprises: Interest on current asset investments and collateralised financing transactions at fair value through profit and loss Interest on debtors and cash assets not at fair value through profit and loss Interest payable comprises: Interest on collateral held and collateralised financing transactions at fair value through profit and loss Interest on borrowings not at fair value through profit and loss Interest on subordinated debt 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 751 22 890 7 773 897 414 131 93 377 208 212 638 797 Included within interest receivable is interest received on client money. 6. Gains and losses on financial assets and financial liabilities held at fair value through profit and loss Gains and losses on financial assets and financial liabilities held for trading: Net dealing income Interest receivable Interest payable 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 739 751 (414) 1,120 890 (377) (8) (35) 1,068 1,598 Gains and losses on financial assets "designated at fair value through profit or loss": Net dealing expense 26 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 7. Operating expenses 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 1,260 186 166 1,243 224 185 10 64 10 57 56 53 0.84 1.25 0.51 0.09 0.65 0.12 Operating expenses include: Employee remuneration Share-based incentive expense (Note 9) Payroll taxes Pension costs - defined benefit scheme (Note 8) - defined contribution scheme Depreciation (Note 12) Auditor’s remuneration: Audit of these financial statements Amounts receivable by the company's auditor and its associates in respect of: Audit related assurance services Taxation compliance services The Company employed an average of 3,931 (2013: 3,824) employees during the year. 8. Pension costs Defined contribution scheme The Citigroup (UK) Pension Plan was established in September 2000 and provides defined contribution benefits to all new hires. Defined benefit scheme The Citigroup Global Markets Limited Pension and Life Assurance Scheme (“the Scheme”) is a funded pension scheme providing benefits on both a defined benefit and defined contribution basis. The Scheme is now closed to new entrants. The assets of the Scheme are held separately from those of the Company, in a trustee administered fund. Employees are not required to contribute to the Scheme, which is contracted out of the State Earnings Related Pension Scheme. The pension cost in respect of defined benefit obligations is assessed in accordance with the advice of a qualified external actuary using a Projected Unit method with a triennial review. The most recent full actuarial assessment of the liabilities of the scheme was at 5 April 2014. Expected regular employer contributions to be paid into the scheme during 2015 are $15 million (2014: $30 million). The assumptions which have the most significant effect on the results of the valuation are those relating to the discount rate on scheme liabilities and mortality assumptions. The Company changed its approach to setting the discount rate assumption at 31 December 2014. The yield curve used for determining the discount rate in 2014 is based on all corporate bonds from the UK market which have a rating of AA from at least one of the three ratings agencies (Moody’s, S&P and Fitch). The yield curve used in 2013 was based on all corporate bond yields from the UK market which have an average rating of AA from the three ratings agencies. The discount rate used as at 31 December 2014 is 3.7%. Using an approach consistent with 2013, the discount rate would have been 3.4%, leading to an estimated difference of $112 million in the defined benefit obligation. The mortality assumptions are based on standard mortality tables which allow for expected future mortality improvements. The assumptions are that a member currently aged 65 will live on average for a further 23.5 years for males and 25.1 years for females. Members currently aged 45 are expected to live a further 24.6 years and 26.7 years from age 65 for males and females respectively. 27 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) The financial assumptions used in calculating the defined benefit scheme liabilities as at 31 December 2014 are as follows: 2014 2013 2012 Discount rate for scheme liabilities Inflation Rate of general long-term increase in salaries Rate of increase to pensions in payment - Pensions accrued from 1 May 2005 - Pensions accrued prior to 1 May 2005 3.7% 3.3% 1.5% 4.5% 3.7% 1.5% 4.7% 3.3% 3.3% 2.4% 3.0% 2.5% 3.2% 2.4% 3.0% In addition to the assumptions on which the Scheme obligation at the balance sheet date is based, it is also necessary to select expected rates of return on assets. Assumptions that are affected by economic conditions (financial assumptions) are based on market expectations, at the balance sheet date, for the period over which the obligations are settled. The overall expected rate of return on assets is derived by aggregating the expected return for each asset class over the actual asset allocation for the scheme. The expected rate of return on assets (EROA) in 2015 of 3.7% is set at the 2014 year end discount rate. As such, the EROA is provided as the total rate and is not split by asset category. The expected return and fair value at the reporting date are set out as follows: 2014 $ Million 1,279 608 1 19 Fair value 2013 $ Million 937 592 1 13 2012 $ Million 906 569 1 4 Total market value of assets 1,907 1,543 1,480 Expected rate of return on assets 3.7% 4.1% 3.6% Government bonds Corporate bonds Insured Pensions Other Analysis of amounts recognised in profit and loss account: Current service cost Curtailment cost Expense recognised in the profit and loss account Expected return on pension scheme assets Interest cost on pension scheme liabilities Net finance income/(cost) 28 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 9 1 10 - 10 10 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 63 (59) 52 (54) 4 (2) CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) Analysis of amount recognised in Statement of Total Recognised Gains and Losses (STRGL): Actual return less expected return on pension scheme assets Actuarial losses on scheme liabilities Change in unrecognised surplus in respect of FRS 17 para 41 Impact of foreign exchange Actuarial gains/(losses) recognised in STRGL Deferred tax adjustment in respect of losses in STRGL Total gains/(losses) recognised in STRGL net of tax Cumulative amount of pre tax losses recognised in STRGL 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 398 (126) (266) 23 (21) (67) 51 (13) 29 (50) (24) - 5 (50) (486) (515) Under FRS 17, any surplus in a Scheme can only be recognised on the balance sheet if the surplus can be recovered either by an agreed refund to the Company or by the reduction of future contributions. As the Scheme is closed to new entrants, the surplus has been calculated as the present value of the service cost expected to arise over the average future working lifetime of the active membership resulting in an unrecognised asset of $381 million (2013: $115 million). Reconciliation to the balance sheet: Total market value of assets Present value of scheme liabilities Net pension asset excluding unrecognised asset Unrecognised asset due to limit in para 41 Gross pension asset/(liability) Related deferred tax asset/(liability) Net pension asset/(liability) 29 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 1,907 (1,405) 1,543 (1,325) 502 218 (381) (115) 121 103 (24) - 97 103 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 103 (9) 30 (1) 4 272 (12) (266) 111 (10) 34 (3) (88) 8 51 121 103 Surplus in scheme at beginning of the year Current service cost Contributions Curtailments Other finance income/(expense) Actuarial gain/(loss) Foreign exchange adjustment Change in unrecognised asset due to FRS 17 para 41 Surplus in scheme at end of year The impact of para 41 limitation in FRS 17: 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 1,907 (1,405) 502 1,543 (1,325) 218 (121) (103) 381 115 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Opening defined benefit obligation Current service cost Interest cost Actuarial losses on scheme liabilities Net benefits paid out Curtailments Foreign exchange adjustment 1,325 9 59 126 (35) 1 (80) 1,203 10 54 67 (38) 29 Closing defined benefit obligation 1,405 1,325 Fair value of scheme assets Defined benefit obligation Net asset Present value of service cost over next 11 years Unrecognisable surplus in respect of FRS 17 para 41 The changes to the present value of the defined obligation during the year are as follows: 30 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 8. Pension costs (continued) The changes to the fair value of scheme assets during the year are as follows: 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Opening fair value of scheme assets Expected return on scheme assets Actuarial gains/(losses) on scheme assets Contributions by the employer Net benefits paid out Foreign exchange adjustment 1,543 63 398 30 (35) (92) 1,480 52 (21) 34 (38) 36 Closing fair value of scheme assets 1,907 1,543 Less unrecognisable surplus in respect of FRS 17 para 41 (381) (115) 1,526 1,428 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Expected return on assets Actuarial gains/(losses) on scheme assets 63 398 52 (21) Actual return on assets 461 31 The actual return on assets is as follows: The actual return on the pension scheme assets of $398 million was significantly higher than the expected return of $63 million, which is based on a long-term assumption about the rate of return on assets. History of experience gains and losses: 2014 2013 2012 2011 2010 $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million Difference between expected and actual return on scheme assets Gains on scheme liabilities due to experience Gains/(losses) on scheme liabilities due to assumptions Change in unrecognised surplus in respect of FRS 17 Foreign exchange adjustment Remeasurements recognised in STRGL Related deferred tax (asset)/ liability Total gains/(losses) recognised in STRGL net of tax 31 398 9 (135) (266) 23 29 (21) 3 (70) 51 (13) (50) (13) 37 (67) (28) (4) (75) 145 (58) (138) 1 (50) (12) 23 11 (24) - - - - 5 (50) (75) (50) 11 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans As part of the Company’s remuneration programme it participates in a number of Citi share-based incentive plans. These plans involve the granting of restricted or deferred share awards and share payments. Such awards are used to attract, retain and motivate officers and employees, to provide incentives for their contributions to the long-term performance and growth of Citi, and to align their interests with those of the shareholders. The award programmes are administered by the Personnel and Compensation Committee of the Citigroup Inc. Board of Directors, which is composed entirely of non-employee directors. In the share award program Citi issues common shares in the form of restricted share awards, deferred share awards and share payments. For all stock award programs during the applicable vesting period, the shares awarded are not issued to participants (in the case of a deferred stock award) or cannot be sold or transferred by participants (in the case of a restricted stock award), until after the vesting conditions have been satisfied. Recipients of deferred share awards do not have any shareholder rights until shares are delivered to them, but they generally are entitled to receive dividend-equivalent payments during the vesting period. Recipients of restricted share awards are entitled to limited voting rights and to receive dividends or dividend-equivalent payments during the vesting period. Once a share award vests the shares become freely transferrable, but in the case of certain employees, may be subject to transfer restrictions by their terms or share ownership commitment. Certain stock-based awards contain discretionary clawback provisions and are subject to variable accounting. The associated value of the award fluctuates with changes in Citi’s common stock price until the date that the award is settled, either in cash or shares. Any fluctuation from the grant date value of the award until the award is fully vested is recognised through the income statement. (i) Stock award programme The Company participates in the Citigroup Capital Accumulation Program (CAP), under which shares of Citi common stock are awarded in the form of restricted or deferred stock to participating employees. Generally, CAP awards of restricted or deferred stock constitute a percentage of annual incentive compensation and vest over a three or four year period beginning on or about the first anniversary of the award date. Except in specific circumstances, continuous employment within Citi is required for CAP and other stock award programs to vest. The program provides that employees who meet certain age plus years-of-service requirements (retirement-eligible employees) may terminate active employment and continue vesting in their awards provided they comply with specified non-compete provisions. Awards granted to retirement-eligible employees are accrued in the year prior to the grant date in the same manner as cash incentive compensation is accrued. For all stock award programmes, the shares awarded cannot be sold or transferred by the participant during the applicable vesting period, and the award is subject to cancellation if the participant’s employment is terminated. After the award vests, the shares become freely transferable (subject to specific sale restrictions). From the date of award, the recipient of a restricted stock award can direct the vote of the shares and receive regular dividends to the extent dividends are paid on Citi common stock. Recipients of deferred stock awards receive dividend equivalents to the extent dividends are paid on Citi common stock, but cannot vote. Stock awards granted generally vest 25% per year over four years or 33% per year over 3 years. As part of remuneration since 2010, the Company entered into an arrangement referred to as an “EU Short Term” award. The award will be delivered in the form of immediately vested restricted shares subject to a six month sale restriction. Shares awarded Weighted average fair market value per share 2014 2013 2012 2011 3,744,987 $49.64 4,677,014 $44.23 6,488,348 $30.54 7,197,950 $49.96 32 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans (continued) (ii) Stock option programme Stock options have not been granted to Citi’s employees as part of the annual incentive award programs since 2009. In 2009 the Company made discretionary grants of options to eligible employees pursuant to the broad-based Citigroup Employee Option Grant (CEOG) Program under the Citigroup Stock Incentive Plan. Under CEOG, the options generally vest equally over three years, the option term is 6 years from the grant date and the shares acquired on exercise are not subject to a sale restriction. To the extent permitted, CEOG options granted to eligible UK employees were granted under an HMRC approved sub-plan with any excess over the applicable individual limit being granted under the global plan, which is not an HMRC approved plan. In 2011, outside the annual incentive award programme, Citi granted options to certain of its executive officers. The options have six-year terms and vest in three equal annual instalments. The exercise price of the options is $49.10, equal to the closing price of a share of Citi common stock on the grant date. Upon exercise of the options before the fifth anniversary of the grant date, the shares received on exercise (net of the amount required to pay taxes and the exercise price) are subject to a one-year transfer restriction. The stock option activity with respect to 2014 and 2013 under Citi stock option plans is as follows: 2014 Options 2013 Weighted average exercise price $ Options Weighted average exercise price $ Outstanding, beginning of year 4,535,017 44.50 4,887,279 44.00 Forfeited Exercised Transfers to/from other Citi entities Expired (673,720) (38,160) (20,563) 41.46 41.50 244.50 (2,393) (372,155) 23,453 (1,167) 244.50 40.80 135.08 543.80 Outstanding, end of year 3,802,574 43.99 4,535,017 44.50 Exercisable, end of year 3,801,878 43.99 4,459,305 44.43 33 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans (continued) The following table summarises the stock options outstanding under Citi stock option plans at 31 December 2014: 2014 Range of exercise prices Number outstanding Options outstanding Weighted average Weighted contractual average life exercise remaining price Options exercisable Number Exercisable Weighted average exercise price $ < $50.00 $50.01 - $399.99 $ 3,770,010 32,564 1.00 1.54 42.98 161.43 3,769,314 32,564 42.98 161.43 3,802,574 1.01 43.99 3,801,878 43.99 The weighted average share price at the exercise date for options exercised during the year was $52.42 (2013: $43.24). The following table summarises the stock options outstanding under Citi stock option plans at 31 December 2013: 2013 Range of exercise prices Number outstanding Options outstanding Weighted average Weighted contractual average life exercise remaining price Options exercisable Number Exercisable $ < $50.00 $50.00 - $399.90 Weighted average exercise price $ 4,475,634 59,383 1.98 1.61 42.62 186.08 4,399,922 59,383 42.51 186.08 4,535,017 1.97 44.50 4,459,305 44.43 Fair value assumptions Valuation and related assumption information for the Citi option plans is presented below. Citi used a binomial model to value stock options. Volatility was estimated by taking the historical implied volatility in traded Citi options over a recorded 31 month period and adjusting where there were known factors that could affect future volatility. 34 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 9. Share-based incentive plans (continued) Weighted average fair value for options granted during the year Weighted average expected life Option life Valuation assumptions Expected volatility (per annum) Risk-free interest rate Expected annual dividend yield per share Expected annual forfeitures (iii) 2014 2013 $0.00 $0.00 1 year 2 years 35.69% 0.35% 0.08% 9.62% 37.23% 0.45% 0.08% 9.62% 2014 2013 $ million $ million Profit and loss statement impact The table below details the profit and loss impact of the share based incentive plans. Stock Awards Granted in 2014 132 - Granted in 2013 35 157 Granted in 2012 13 43 Granted in 2011 (3) 24 Granted in 2010 (1) (7) Granted in 2009 & prior - (2) Granted in 2011 - 1 Accrued Expenses 10 8 Total Expense (Note 7) 186 224 Fair value adjustment of intercompany recharges in equity reserve (Note 27) (8) (83) Total carrying amount of equity-settled transaction liability 439 512 5 10 Stock Options Total carrying amount of cash-settled transaction liability 35 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 10. Directors’ remuneration Directors’ remuneration in respect of services to the Company was as follows: Aggregate emoluments Contributions to money purchase pension scheme 2014 $’000 2013 $’000 4,936 97 3,564 76 5,033 3,640 The contributions to the money purchase pension schemes were accruing to four of the Directors (2013: five). Five of the Directors (2013: five) of the Company participated in parent company share and share option plans and, during the year, none of the Directors (2013: none) exercised options. The remuneration of the highest paid Director was $2,438,014 (2013: $1,872,397) and accrued pension of $59,620 (2013: $3,222). The Directors benefited from qualifying third party indemnity provisions in place during the financial year and at the date of this report. The above remuneration was based on the apportionment of time incurred by the Directors for services to the Company, both in their capacity as a Director and, where applicable, their normal employment. 11. Tax on profit on ordinary activities (a) Analysis of tax charge in the year Current tax: Overseas current tax Adjustment in respect of overseas tax for previous years Total current tax (Note 11(b)) Deferred tax: Origination and reversal of timing differences -UK - overseas Total deferred tax Tax charge on ordinary activities 36 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 20 20 21 5 26 (24) 7 (17) (1) (1) 3 25 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 11. Tax on profit on ordinary activities (continued) (b) Factors affecting tax charge for the year Profit/(loss) on ordinary activities before tax Profit/(loss) on ordinary activities multiplied by the standard rate of corporation in the UK of 21.49% (2013: 23.25%) 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 113 (209) 24 (49) 24 (4) 15 3 (6) 20 (56) - 20 (5) (8) (134) 6 (10) 21 179 5 20 25 Effects of: Expenses not deductible for tax purposes Foreign tax deductions Depreciation in excess of capital allowances Accrued interest paid Other timing differences Pensions Overseas tax in respect of European branch operations and dividends received Group relief for nil consideration Losses carried forward Adjustments in relation to previous years Current tax charge for year (c) Factors that may affect future tax charges: The Company has not recognised a deferred tax asset of $347 million (2013: $379 million) in relation to carried forward losses and timing differences where the recoverability of potential benefits is not considered likely. The UK Corporate tax rate applying to CGML was 21.49%. Other subsidiaries and overseas branches provided for taxation at the appropriate rates for the countries in which they operate. The main rate of corporation tax in the UK was reduced from 23% to 21% on 1 April 2014 and will be further reduced to 20% on 1 April 2015. The reduction in the corporate tax rate was enacted through the 2013 Finance Act on 17 July 2013. It is not expected that the future rate reduction will have a significant impact on the group. 37 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 12. Tangible fixed assets The movement in tangible fixed assets for the year was as follows: Equipment and software $ Million Premises improvements $ Million Total $ Million 403 56 15 - 418 56 At 31 December 2014 Accumulated depreciation At 1 January 2014 Charge for the year (Note 7) Additions 459 15 474 190 55 2 7 1 - 197 56 2 At 31 December 2014 247 8 255 Net book value At 31 December 2014 At 31 December 2013 212 213 7 8 219 221 Cost At 1 January 2014 Additions 13. Fixed asset investments Unlisted Investments 2014 $ Million Unlisted Investments 2013 $ Million Cost At 1 January Additions Disposals Gains/(losses) recognised in profit and loss account 50 (9) (1) 36 2 12 At 31 December 40 50 The following amounts for subsidiary undertakings are included in fixed asset investments: 2014 $’000 Cost At 1 January 3,268 Additions 312 At 31 December 3,580 2013 $’000 3,253 15 3,268 Details of principal Group subsidiary undertakings held at 31 December 2014 are as follows: Name Country of incorporation Citigroup South Africa Credit Products (Proprietary) Limited (CSA) CGM (Monaco) SAM Citigroup Global Markets Luxembourg LLC Citigroup Global Markets Funding Luxembourg SCA Citigroup Global Markets Funding Luxembourg SaRL South Africa Monaco Luxembourg Luxembourg Luxembourg 38 % holding in ordinary share capital 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values The table below sets out the Company’s classification of each class of financial assets and liabilities, and their fair values. 31 December 2014 Cash Current asset investments Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans 31 December 2013 Cash Current asset investments Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Other Total Held for Designated Loans and amortised carrying Trading at fair value receivables cost amount Fair value $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million 44,557 203,894 93,054 - 576 - 1,571 11,482 9,459 281 - 40 1,571 45,133 203,894 93,054 11,482 9,459 281 40 1,571 45,133 203,894 93,054 11,482 9,459 281 40 341,505 576 22,793 40 364,914 364,914 79,218 203,375 32,754 - - - 10,104 15,404 6,276 1,043 4,080 10,104 79,218 203,375 15,404 32,754 6,276 1,043 4,080 10,104 79,218 203,375 15,404 32,754 6,276 1,043 4,547 315,347 - - 36,907 352,254 352,721 Other Total Held for Designated Loans and amortised carrying Trading at fair value receivables cost amount Fair value $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million 40,529 77,648 98,874 - 1,397 - 2,805 4,650 7,930 130 - 50 2,805 41,926 77,648 98,874 4,650 7,930 130 50 2,805 41,926 77,648 98,874 4,650 7,930 130 50 217,051 1,397 15,515 50 234,013 234,013 87,474 79,999 29,429 - - - 5,881 7,457 5,781 1,214 4,200 5,881 87,474 79,999 7,457 29,429 5,781 1,214 4,200 5,881 87,474 79,999 7,457 29,429 5,781 1,214 5,003 196,902 - - 24,533 221,435 222,238 39 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) The following table shows an analysis of financial assets and liabilities classified as held for trading or designated at fair value by level in the hierarchy: 31 December 2014 Level 1 $ Million Level 2 $ Million Level 3 $ Million Total $ Million 31 20,662 11 8,487 - 201,244 1,228 10,621 1,540 1,458 2,619 12 421 117 - 203,894 21,902 11,053 10,144 1,458 - 92,789 265 93,054 29,191 308,880 3,434 341,505 - 576 - 576 29,191 309,456 3,434 342,081 24 28,486 199,802 79,218 4,263 3,549 5 203,375 79,218 32,754 28,510 283,283 3,554 315,347 Level 1 $ Million Level 2 $ Million Level 3 $ Million Total $ Million 17 20,418 6,943 - 74,890 2,464 8,345 506 530 52 2,741 19 1,140 112 - 77,648 22,901 9,485 7,561 530 52 - 98,531 343 98,874 27,378 185,318 4,355 217,051 - 1,397 - 1,397 27,378 186,715 4,355 218,448 7 24,637 76,616 87,474 4,772 3,376 20 79,999 87,474 29,429 24,644 168,862 3,396 196,902 Financial assets held for trading Current asset investments Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Physical Commodities Collateralised financing transactions Financial assets designated at fair value Current asset investments Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Securities sold but not yet purchased 31 December 2013 Financial assets held for trading Current asset investments Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Physical Commodities Commercial Paper Collateralised financing transactions Financial assets designated at fair value Current asset investments Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Securities sold but not yet purchased 40 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Given the short term nature and characteristics of trade debtors, other debtors, trade creditors, other creditors and accruals the fair value has been assumed to approximate the carrying value. The fair value of subordinated loans has been calculated using the present value of future estimated cash flows, discounted using a discount rate of USD 3 month Overnight Indexed Swap (OIS) or 3 month Euro Overnight Index Average (EONIA) plus the Company’s credit spread as at 31 December 2014. Fair Value Hierarchy The calculation of fair value incorporates the Company’s estimate of the fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities. Other entities may use different valuation methods and assumptions in determining fair values, so comparisons of fair values between entities may not necessarily be meaningful. The Company measures fair values using the following fair value hierarchy that indicates whether the inputs to those valuation techniques are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs denote market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s market assumptions. The types of inputs have created the following fair value hierarchy: • Level 1: Quoted prices for identical instruments in active markets. • Level 2: Quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets; quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active; and model-derived valuations in which all significant inputs and significant value drivers are observable in active markets. • Level 3: Valuations derived from valuation techniques in which one or more significant inputs or significant value drivers are unobservable. The Company considers relevant and observable market prices in its valuations where possible. The frequency of transactions and the size of the bid-ask spread when comparing similar transactions are factors that are driven by the liquidity of markets and the relevance of observed prices in those markets. The Company’s policy with respect to transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy is to recognise transfers into and out of each level as of the end of the reporting period. Determination of Fair Value As set out in Note 1(b), when available, the Company generally uses quoted market prices in an active market to calculate the fair value of a financial asset or liability and classifies such items as Level 1. In some cases where a market price is available, the Company will make use of acceptable practical expedients (such as matrix pricing) to calculate fair value, in which case the items are classified as Level 2. If quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based upon internally developed valuation techniques that use, where possible, current market-based or independently sourced market parameters such as interest rates, currency rates and option volatilities. Items valued using such internally generated valuation techniques are classified according to the lowest level input or value driver that is significant to the valuation. Thus an item may be classified in Level 3 even though there may be some significant inputs that are readily observable. Where available, the Company may also make use of quoted prices for recent trading activity in positions with the same or similar characteristics to that being valued. The frequency and size of transactions and the amount of the bid-ask spread are among the factors considered in determining the liquidity of markets and the relevance of observed prices from those markets. If relevant and observable prices are available, those valuations would be classified as Level 2. If such prices are not available, other valuation techniques would be used and the item would be classified as Level 3. Fair value estimates from internal valuation techniques are verified, where possible, to prices obtained from independent vendors or brokers. Vendors’ and brokers’ valuations may be based on a variety of inputs ranging from observed prices to proprietary valuation models. 41 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) The Company uses the following procedures to determine the fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities irrespective of whether they are “held for trading” or have been “designated at fair value”. The description includes an indication of the level in the fair value hierarchy in which each financial instrument is generally classified. Where appropriate, details are provided of the valuation models, the key inputs to those models and any significant assumptions. Derivatives Exchange-traded derivatives in active markets are generally fair valued using quoted market prices (i.e. exchange prices) and are therefore classified as Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. The majority of derivatives entered into by the Company are executed over the counter and are valued using a combination of external prices and internal valuation techniques, including benchmarking to pricing vendor services. The valuation techniques and inputs vary according to the type of derivative and the nature of the underlying instrument. The principal methods used to value these instruments are those adopted industry wide and include discounted cash flows, modelling and numerical approaches. The type of inputs may include interest rate yield curves, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, volatilities and correlations. Government bonds, Corporate bonds and Equities When available, the Company uses quoted market prices to determine the fair value of government bonds and exchange traded equities; such items are typically classified as Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. For government bonds, corporate bonds and equities traded over the counter, the Company generally determines fair value utilising internal valuation techniques. Fair value estimates from internal valuation techniques are verified, where possible, to prices obtained from independent vendors. Vendors compile prices from various sources and may apply matrix pricing for similar bonds or loans where no price is observable. If available, the Company may also use quoted prices for recent trading activity of assets with similar characteristics to the bond or loan being valued. Government bonds, corporate bonds and equities and loans priced using such methods are generally classified as Level 2. However, when less liquidity exists for government bonds, corporate bonds or equities, a quoted price is stale or prices from independent sources vary, they are generally classified as Level 3. The Company discounts future cashflows using appropriate interest rate curves. In the case of collateralised interest rate derivatives and equity derivatives the Company follows the terms in the collateral agreement governing the transaction. The agreements generally provide that an OIS curve is used. The OIS curves reflect the interest rate paid on the collateral against the fair value of these derivatives. Collateralised financing transactions No quoted prices exist for such financial instruments and so fair value is determined using a discounted cashflow technique. Cash flows are estimated based on the terms of the contract, taking into account any embedded derivative or other features. Expected cash flows are discounted using market rates appropriate to the maturity of the instrument as well as the nature and amount of collateral taken or received. Generally, when such instruments are held at fair value, they are classified within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy as the inputs used in the valuation are readily observable. The Company values a number of assets and liabilities using valuation techniques that use one or more significant inputs that are not based on observable market data. The Company grades all such assets and liabilities in order to identify those items for which a reasonably possible change in one or more assumptions is likely to have a significant impact on the fair value. Adjustments may be applied to the “base” valuations of financial assets and liabilities calculated using one of the valuation techniques described above, to ensure that the fair value measurement incorporates all factors that market participants would consider when determining fair value. Note that no such adjustments are applied to instruments that are valued using quoted prices for identical instruments in an active market. 42 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) The movement on Level 3 items for the year was: 2014 Financial assets held for trading Current asset investments Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Long Term Debt Securities sold but not yet purchased Gain/(loss) recorded in At 1 the profit and January loss statement Purchases $ Million $ Million $ Million 2,741 19 1,141 111 (589) (1) 17 (18) 68 313 1,227 150 (116) (222) (1,698) (132) 94 - 421 (97) (266) 6 2,619 12 421 117 343 13 153 (58) (186) - 265 4,355 (578) 1,911 (2,226) (92) 64 3,434 At 1 January $ Million 3,376 20 3,396 2013 Financial assets held for trading Current asset investments Derivatives Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities Collateralised financing transactions Financial liabilities held for trading Derivatives Long Term Debt Securities sold but not yet purchased Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million Transfer from/(to) At 31 Level 1 and Level 2 December $ Million $ Million (Gain)/loss recorded in the profit and loss statement Purchases $ Million $ Million (738) (23) 12 (726) (23) Gain/(loss) recorded in At 1 the profit and January loss statement Purchases $ Million $ Million $ Million Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million 39 70 36 (51) 75 19 Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million Transfer from/(to) At 31 Level 1 and Level 2 December $ Million $ Million 825 3,549 (12) 5 813 3,554 Transfer from/(to) Level 1 and At 31 Level 2 December $ Million $ Million 3,447 77 679 60 (771) (23) 439 24 13 113 1,663 42 (11) (143) (1,480) (37) (551) (6) 614 (5) (161) 29 2,741 19 1,140 112 - - 292 - (391) 442 343 4,263 (331) 2,123 (1,671) (948) 919 4,355 At 1 January $ Million 4,729 19 4,748 (Gain)/loss recorded in the profit and loss statement Purchases $ Million $ Million (222) 145 1 (16) (237) 145 Sales Settlements $ Million $ Million 5 (1,588) (1) 90 (91) 95 (1,680) Transfer from/(to) Level 1 and At 31 Level 2 December $ Million $ Million 307 3,376 18 20 325 3,396 Included in the Level 3 balance at 31 December 2014 above are intercompany assets of $1,570 million (2013: $1,786 million) and liabilities of $1,655 million (2013: $1,704 million). 43 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 14. Financial assets and liabilities accounting classifications and fair values (continued) Financial instruments may move between levels in the fair value hierarchy when factors such as liquidity or the observability of input parameters change. As conditions around these factors improve, financial instruments may transfer higher up the fair value hierarchy. There were no significant transfers of investments between Level 1 and Level 2 during the years ended 31 December 2014 and 2013. Valuation process for Level 3 Fair Value Measurements Price verification procedures and related internal control procedures are governed by the Citi Pricing and Price Verification Policy and Standards, which are jointly owned by Finance and Risk Management. Finance has implemented the ICG Securities and Banking Pricing and Price Verification Standards and Procedures to facilitate compliance with this policy. Transfers into or out of Level 3 are primarily driven by changes in the availability of independent data for positions where the Company has risk exposure, yet the market is no longer considered to be active. As liquidity and transparency improves, the financial instrument may transfer back to a previous classification level. The key derivative contributors to the Level 3 financial instrument decrease over 2014 focussed on exotic inventory across the Rates, Commodities and Credit Trading businesses. Movements across purchases, issuances, sales and settlements were driven by asset backed securities across the Securitised Markets business and corporate bonds across the European Rates and Credit Trading businesses. Transfers into Level 3 were driven by Credit Trading across trading securities, and a decrease in observability of input parameters, such as correlation, over the year. Transfers out of Level 3 were driven by greater observability around Securitised Markets and Credit Trading, mainly across asset backed securities, as visibility improved. During the year, total changes in fair value, representing a gain of $147 million (2013: $94 million loss) were recognised in the profit and loss account relating to items where fair value was estimated using a valuation technique that incorporates one or more significant inputs based on unobservable market data. As these valuation techniques are based upon assumptions, changing the assumptions will change the estimate of fair value. The potential impact of using reasonably possible alternative assumptions for the valuation techniques for both observable and unobservable market data has been quantified as approximately $176 million (2013: $185 million). The main contributors to this impact are Equity Markets, Emerging Markets Credit Trading, Credit Trading and other cross-asset businesses. Valuation uncertainty is computed on a quarterly basis. The methodology used to derive the impact across each product is determined by applying adjustments to the price or significant model input parameters used in the valuation. The adjustments are typically computed with reference to proxy analysis using third party data. Examples of the approach used to derive sensitivity adjustments are outlined below: • Equity Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. • Credit Trading and Securitised Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data, broker data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. • Commodity Markets: Valuation uncertainty is computed from a combination of consensus market data and proxy analysis using third party data providers. 44 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 15. Debtors The following amounts are included in debtors: Amounts due within one year: Trade debtors Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Other debtors Prepayments and accrued income Corporation tax recoverable Amounts due in greater than one year: Deferred tax asset (Note 20) 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 9,459 93,054 11,482 281 16 12 7,930 98,874 4,650 130 18 21 29 13 114,333 111,636 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 3,118 28,335 666 45 3,068 24,324 776 13 32,164 28,181 Included within debtors are the following balances due from group undertakings: Amounts due within one year: Trade debtors Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Other debtors 16. Pledged assets Collateral accepted as security for assets The fair value of financial assets including government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities, and cash accepted that were permitted to be sold or re-pledged in the absence of default was $150.2 billion (2013: $124.1 billion). The fair value of the collateral accepted that had been re-pledged at 31 December 2014 was $144.3 billion (2013: $110.4 billion). The Company was obliged to return equivalent securities. These transactions were conducted under terms that are usual and customary to standard lending and securities borrowing and lending activities. Financial assets pledged to secure liabilities The total value of purchased financial assets including government bonds, eurobonds and other corporate bonds, equities and cash that were pledged as collateral for liabilities at 31 December 2014 was $44.9 billion (2013: $42.9 billion). These transactions were conducted under terms that are usual and customary to standard lending and securities borrowing and lending activities. 45 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 17. Current asset investments Current asset investments form part of the asset trading portfolio of the Company and comprise marketable securities and other financial assets. The following amounts are included in current asset investments: Government bonds Eurobonds and other corporate bonds Equities - listed on a recognised UK exchange - listed elsewhere Physical Commodities Certificates of deposit Commercial Paper Derivatives (Note 18) 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 21,902 11,629 2,201 7,943 1,458 0 0 203,894 22,901 10,881 1,440 6,121 530 1 52 77,648 249,027 119,574 Eurobonds and other corporate bonds include $576 million (2013: $1,397 million) of bonds that are “designated at fair value” and the remainder are classified as “held for trading”. 18. Derivatives 2014 Fair Value Asset Liability $ Million $ Million Swap agreements, swap options and interest rate cap and floor agreements Index and equity options and similar contractual commitments Other options and contractual commitments 2013 Fair Value Asset Liability $ Million $ Million 181,245 180,538 60,879 62,556 5,661 7,219 8,379 9,863 16,988 15,618 8,390 7,580 203,894 203,375 77,648 79,999 19. Cash at bank and in hand The following amounts are included within cash at bank and in hand: Cash at bank held by third parties Cash at bank held by other group undertakings 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 950 621 2,201 604 1,571 2,805 Included within cash held by third parties is $852 million (2013: $1,115 million) that is held on behalf of clients in segregated accounts. Included within cash held by other group undertakings is $228 million (2013: $142 million) on behalf of clients in segregated accounts. 46 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 20. Deferred tax asset The following amounts are included within deferred tax: 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Short term timing differences 29 13 At 1 January Increase during the year - P&L FX movement 13 17 (1) 12 1 - At 31 December 29 13 Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits from which the reversal of the underlying timing differences can be deducted. Deferred tax is recognised on timing differences arising in the Company's non-UK branch operations, including differences in relation to share based payments and pensions. The recognition accords with the Company's accounting policies, because it is more likely than not that there will be suitable taxable profits arising in these operations from which the future reversal of underlying timing differences can be deducted. The Company has not recognised a deferred tax asset of $347 million (2013: $379 million) in relation to carried forward losses and timing differences where the recoverability of potential benefits was not previously considered likely. This year the Company is profitable and, if this continues, the directors will reconsider whether recognition is appropriate on the basis that there is sufficient certainty around the future profitability of the Company to enable the use of the recognised deferred tax asset against future profits of the Company. 21. Creditors The following amounts are included within creditors. Included within ‘Other creditors and accruals’ is the accrual in respect of the bank levy. Amounts falling due within one year: Securities sold, but not yet purchased Derivatives (Note 18) Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral held Bank loans and overdrafts Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Payroll taxes Corporation tax payable Amounts falling due in greater than one year: Trade creditors 47 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 32,754 203,375 79,218 15,404 10,104 6,154 1,043 38 15 29,429 79,999 87,474 7,457 5,881 5,621 1,214 130 14 348,105 217,219 122 160 122 160 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 21 Creditors (continued) Included within creditors are the following balances due to group undertakings: Amounts falling due within one year: Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral held Bank loans and overdrafts Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Amounts falling due in greater than one year: Trade creditors 22. 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 13,221 5,407 9,960 573 354 9,124 2,623 5,591 930 423 29,515 18,691 122 160 Derecognition of financial assets and financial liabilities Transferred financial assets that are not derecognised in their entirety There are certain instances where the Company continues to recognise financial assets that it has transferred. The Company enters into collateralised financing transactions where it sells or lends debt or equity securities with a concurrent agreement to repurchase them. As significantly all of the risks and rewards of the underlying securities are retained, a collateralised financing liability is recognised and the securities remain on balance sheet. As at 31 December 2014 the Company recognised $44,893 million of assets (2013: $42,931 million), with an associated $41,916 million of collateralised financing liabilities (2013: $31,789 million). 23. Trading financial assets and liabilities Any initial gain or loss on financial instruments where valuation is dependent on valuation techniques using unobservable parameters are deferred over the life of the contract or until the instrument is redeemed, transferred or sold or the fair value becomes observable. The table below sets out the aggregate difference yet to be recognised in profit or loss at the beginning and end of the year with a reconciliation of the changes of the balance during the year for those financial assets and liabilities classified as trading. Unamortised balance at 1 January Deferral on new transactions Recognised in profit and loss during the period: - amortisation Unamortised balance at 31 December 48 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 35 34 28 15 (16) (8) 53 35 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 24. Subordinated loans The subordinated loans form part of the Company’s regulatory capital resources held to meet the capital adequacy requirements of the PRA and can only be repaid with their consent. The following amounts were included within subordinated loans: Amounts falling due after five years 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 4,080 4,200 4,080 4,200 The subordinated loans, on which interest is payable at market rates, are due to other group undertakings. On 10 September 2014 the Company repaid $1,300 million of subordinated loan borrowings to Citigroup Financial Products Inc. and simultaneously drew down EUR 1,000 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. On 27 October 2014 the Company repaid $700 million of subordinated loan borrowings to Citigroup Financial Products Inc. and simultaneously drew down EUR 550 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. These repayments and borrowings were made in order to enhance the efficient allocation of Citi’s resources. At 31 December 2014, the Company had in place the following subordinated loan facilities: Facilities with other group undertakings: Facilities expiring between one and five years 2014 Total facilities available $ Million 2013 Total facilities available $ Million - 5,000 - 5,000 On 4 February 2015 the Company drew down $800 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. On 10 March 2015 the Company drew down $750 million of subordinated loan borrowings from Citigroup Financial Products Inc. The $5 billion subordinated loan facility expired on 31 December 2014. The subordinated loan borrowings drawn in 2015 were borrowed under terms analogous to those contained in the expired facility. 49 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 25. Provisions for liabilities At 1 January 2014 Charge to profits Provisions utilised At 31 December 2014 Restructuring provision $ Million Litigation provisions $ Million Other provisions $ Million Total $ Million 14 56 (40) 14 14 (1) 28 36 (2) 56 106 (43) 30 27 62 119 The restructuring provision is in respect of the cost of staff redundancies. The full amount is expected to be utilised in 2014. There are no releases anticipated. No additional information is disclosed in respect of the litigation provision due to its sensitive nature. Other provisions are held in respect of accounting reconciliation and control procedures as part of the balance sheet substantiation process. 26. Called up share capital The Company’s share capital comprises: 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 Allotted, called-up and fully paid: 1,499,626,620 ordinary shares of $1 each 27. Reserves The Company’s reserves comprise: Capital reserve $ Million Profit and loss account $ Million Total $ Million At 1 January 2014 Profit for the year Net movement in STRGL in respect of pension scheme Share based payment transactions 9,989 - 1,265 110 5 (8) 11,254 110 5 (8) At 31 December 2014 9,989 1,372 11,361 The capital reserve includes capital contributions from the parent company, which are distributable. Further information on the Company’s regulatory capital is provided in Note 28. 50 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28. Financial instruments and risk management Objectives, policies and strategies Dealing in financial instruments is fundamental to the Company’s business. The risks associated with financial instruments are a significant component of the overall risk faced by the Company, particularly in turbulent financial markets. The Company maintains positions in financial instruments for four principal reasons: • • • • as a result of the sale or assignment of structured or derivative positions to its clients (usually in the over-the-counter market); to satisfy its clients’ requirements to buy or sell investments; as a result of underwriting activities; and to economically hedge positions on its books created by the business noted above. The Company also acts as agent for its customers in the purchase, sale and assignment of securities and derivatives listed on recognised investment exchanges. The Company’s derivative transactions are principally in the equity, interest rate, credit and commodity markets. Most of the counterparties to the Company’s derivative transactions are banks and other financial institutions. The risks involved in trading derivatives include market, liquidity, credit and operational risk. Market uncertainty places additional importance on the risk management policies and procedures which are outlined below. The Company believes that effective risk management is of primary importance to its overall operations. Accordingly, the Company seeks to maintain a comprehensive risk management process to monitor, evaluate and manage the principal risks it assumes in conducting its activities. These risks include market, liquidity, credit and operational risks. Citi’s risk management framework, as established by the Chief Risk Officer, is designed to balance business ownership and accountability for risks with well-defined independent risk management oversight and responsibility to monitor, evaluate and manage the principal risks it assumes in conducting its activities. Citi’s risk management framework, tailored as appropriate for the Company, is based on the following principles established by the Chief Risk Officer: • • • • • • a defined risk appetite, aligned with business strategy; accountability through a common framework to manage risks; risk decisions based on transparent, accurate and rigorous analytics; a common risk capital model to evaluate risks; expertise, stature, authority and independence of Risk Managers; and risk managers empowered to make decisions and escalate issues. The Company’s risk appetite framework includes principle-based qualitative boundaries to guide behaviour and quantitative boundaries within which the firm will operate, focusing on ensuring it has sufficient capital resources in light of the risks to which the entity could be exposed. The legal entity risk appetite for the Company is set by the its board, and incorporates management judgement regarding prudent risk taking and growth in light of the business environment within which the entity operates. The Company’s board of directors, with input from senior Citi and Company management, sets overarching expectations and holds management accountable for ensuring the risk profile remains within this appetite. In January 2014 a CGML Risk Committee was established, with the aim of assisting the Board in fulfilling its responsibility with respect to oversight of the risks the Company faces in managing its market, liquidity, credit, operational and certain other risks and their alignment with the Company’s strategy, capital adequacy and the macroeconomic environment and development of a strategy to manage these risks. This was pursued in order to 51 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Objectives, policies and strategies (continued) strengthen local risk governance and ensure prioritisation of local risk and regulatory objectives of the Company, while at the same time maintaining their alignment with Citi’s global risk strategy. The CGML Risk Committee meets not less than quarterly. Risk management Citi manages risk across three dimensions: businesses, regions and critical products. Each of the major business groups has a Business Chief Risk Officer who is the focal point for risk decisions (such as setting risk limits or approving transactions) in the business. There are also Regional Chief Risk Officers, accountable for the risks in their geographic area and who are the primary risk contact for the regional business heads and local regulators. In addition, there are Product Chief Risk Officers for those areas of critical importance to Citi such as real estate and fundamental credit. The Product Risk Officers are accountable for the risks within their specialities across businesses and regions. The Product Risk Officers serve as a resource to the Chief Risk Officer, as well as to the Business and Regional Chief Risk Officers, to better enable the Business and Regional Chief Risk Officers to focus on the day-to-day management of risks and respond in a timely manner to business needs. Risk management within the Company is overseen by the Regional Risk Manager along with the managers for the different risk types within the region, such as market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk and operational risk. The Citi risk organisation also includes a Business Management team who seek to ensure that the risk organisation has the appropriate infrastructure, processes and management reporting. This team, which supports risk management within the Company, includes the following groups: • • • • the risk capital group, which continues to enhance the risk capital model and its consistency across all business activities; the risk architecture group, which seeks to ensure integrated systems and common metrics, and thereby facilitates aggregation and stress testing of exposures across the institution; the operational risk management group, which focuses on improving the effectiveness of existing controls while increasing accountability and eliminating redundancy; and the office of Strategic Regulatory Relationships and the Chief Administrative Officer, which focuses on critical regulatory relationships as well as risk communications. The Company utilises Citi’s risk management model and organisation, with its multi-dimensional risk oversight and its people, processes and systems to ensure robust oversight of entity risks. In addition, the Company has entity specific risk management and controls, to facilitate local challenge to risk taking and to ensure that the Citi’s approach is appropriate for the Company. Risk aggregation and stress testing The Citi Chief Risk Officer, as noted above, is responsible for monitoring and controlling major risk exposures and concentrations across the organisation. This means aggregating risks, within and across businesses, as well as subjecting those risks to alternative stress scenarios in order to assess the potential economic impact they may have on Citi. This aggregation is also performed at a Company level. Stress tests are undertaken across Citi and the Company and cover mark-to-market, available-for-sale, and amortised cost portfolios. These firm-wide stress reports seek to measure the potential impact to Citi, the Company and its component businesses, of stresses such as the risk of very large movements in a number of key risk factors (e.g. interest rates, credit spreads), as well as the potential impact of a range of historical and hypothetical forward-looking systemic stress scenarios. Supplementing the stress testing described above, Risk Management works with input from the businesses and finance to provide periodic updates to senior management and the Board of Directors on significant potential exposures across the Company arising from risk concentrations, financial market participants and other systemic issues. These risk assessments are forward-looking exercises, intended to inform senior management and the 52 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Risk management (continued) Board of Directors about the potential economic impacts to the Company that may occur, directly or indirectly, as a result of hypothetical scenarios, based on judgmental analysis from independent risk managers. The stress testing and risk assessment exercises are a supplement to the standard limit-setting and risk capital exercises described later in this section, as these processes incorporate events in the marketplace and within the Company that impact the firm’s view of the form, magnitude, correlation and timing of identified risks that may arise. In addition to enhancing awareness and understanding of potential exposures within the Company, the results of these processes serve as the starting point for risk management and mitigation strategies. A Citi-wide (including an EMEA-based) Business Practices Committee (BPC) reviews practices involving potentially significant reputational or franchise issues. These committees review whether Citi’s business practices have been designed and implemented in a way that meets the highest standards of professionalism, integrity and ethical behaviour. Additional committees ensure that product risks are identified, evaluated and determined to be appropriate for Citi and its customers, and safeguard the existence of necessary approvals, controls and accountabilities. The New Product Approval Committee (NPAC) is designed to ensure that significant risks, including reputation and franchise risks, for all new ICG products, services or complex transactions, are identified and evaluated, determined to be appropriate, properly recorded for risk aggregation purposes, effectively controlled, and have accountabilities in place. The Investment Products Risk (IPR) Committee oversees two product approval committees that facilitate analysis and discussion of new retail investment products and services created and/or distributed by Citi. The Manufacturing Product Approval Committee is responsible for reviewing new or modified products or transactions created by Citi that are distributed to individual investors as well as third-party retail distributors. The Distribution Product Approval Committee (DPAC) approves new investment products and services, including those created by third parties as part of Citi’s “open architecture” distribution model, before they are offered to individual investors via Citi distribution businesses (e.g. private bank, consumer, etc.). Along with the processes described above, the following sections summarise the processes that were in place during 2014 for managing the Company's major risks. As summarised in the Strategic Report, Citi has identified the following as the key risks facing the Company. Market risk Market risk (and namely the price risk component) is the risk to earnings or capital from adverse changes in market factors such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, equity and commodity prices, as well as their implied volatilities and other higher order factors. The independent risk management is tasked with establishing an effective risk management process, including defining policies and procedures and suitable market risk controls and limits taking into account where appropriate business considerations. It is supplemented by appropriate senior Business and Corporate management risk oversight. Market risk limit structure clearly defines approved risk profiles and follows the principles and parameters of Citi's overall risk appetite. In addition the Company has a defined risk appetite framework supplemented by a daily Value at Risk (VaR) limit and regular stress testing, with monthly and quarterly reporting to senior management and the Board of Directors respectively. 53 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Market risk (continued) Management of this process begins with the employees who work most closely with the Group’s customers, products and markets and extends up to the senior executives who manage these businesses with a complementary aggregation up to the country level. In all cases, the businesses are ultimately responsible for the market risks they take and for remaining within their defined limits. Market risk is measured through a complementary set of tools, including factor sensitivities, VaR, and stress testing. Each of these is discussed in greater detail below. Each business has its own market risk limit framework, encompassing these measures and other controls, including permitted product lists and a new product approval process for complex products. The Company’s VaR reports are circulated daily for monitoring of: (i) the VaR usage against the overall VaR limit; (ii) the standalone VaR by market risk factor; (iii) the component Value at Risk (CVaR) contribution to total VaR; and (iv) the stressed VaR. As well as an overall VaR limit, the Company has factor sensitivity triggers in place for each market risk factor that are monitored daily. Factor sensitivities are defined as the change in the value of a position for a defined change in a market risk factor (e.g. the change in the value of a Treasury bill for a one basis point change in interest rates). It is the responsibility of each business to seek to ensure that factor sensitivities are calculated and reported for all relevant risks taken within a trading portfolio. Exposure that approaches or exceeds limit or trigger levels is escalated within market risk management and to the Company’s Market Risk Manager and Legal Entity Risk Manager, with necessary actions taken. Where the Equities business is concerned, an ex-ante stress loss based escalation framework has been put in place to cover all block trades, including accelerated equity offerings, equity underwritings, rights offerings and special situation (event-driven) transactions. Transactions with estimated stress losses above certain levels require escalation to the EMEA Chief Risk Officer, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and to the Company’s board. VaR methodology VaR estimates the potential decline in the value of a position or a portfolio, under normal market conditions, over a specified holding period and confidence level. The VaR methodology developed and applied at Citi at a global level is also used at subsidiary level, including the Company. The Citi standard is a one-day holding period, at a 99 per cent confidence level. The VaR methodology incorporates the factor sensitivities of the trading portfolio and the volatilities and correlations of those factors. The Company’s VaR is based on the volatilities of, and correlations between, a wide range of market risk factors, including factors that track the specific issuer risk in debt and equity securities. VaR statistics can be materially different across firms due to differences in portfolio composition, differences in VaR methodologies, and differences in model parameters. Citi believes that VaR statistics can be used more effectively as indicators of trends in risk taking within a firm, rather than as a basis for inferring differences in risk taking across firms. Citi and the Company use Monte Carlo simulation, which they believe is conservatively calibrated to incorporate the greater of short-term (most recent month) and long-term (three years) market volatility. The Monte Carlo simulation involves approximately 300,000 market factors, making use of 180,000 time series, with market factors updated daily and model parameters updated weekly. The conservative features of the VaR calibration contribute an approximate 20% add-on to what would be a VaR estimated under the assumption of stable and perfectly normally distributed markets. Under normal and stable market conditions, Citi would thus expect the number of days where trading losses exceed its VaR to be fewer than three exceptions per year. Periods of unstable market conditions could increase the frequency of these exceptions. 54 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Market risk (continued) VaR limitations Although extensive back-testing of VaR hypothetical portfolios is performed, with varying concentrations by industry, risk rating and other factors, the VaR measure cannot necessarily provide an indication of the potential size of loss when it occurs. Hence a varied set of factor sensitivity limits and stress tests are used, in addition to VaR limits. A VaR limit is in place for the Company, to ensure that any excesses are discussed and resolved between risk officers and the business and entity management. This limit is complemented by the factor sensitivity triggers defined above. Although it provides a valuable guide to risk, VaR should also be viewed in the context of its limitations: • • • • • the use of historical data as a proxy for estimating future events may not encompass all potential events, particularly those of an extreme nature; the use of a one day holding period assumes that all positions can be liquidated or their risks offset in one day. This may not fully reflect the market risk arising at times of severe illiquidity, when a one day holding period may be insufficient to fully liquidate or hedge positions; the use of a 99% confidence level, by definition, does not take into account losses that might occur beyond this confidence level; VaR is calculated on the basis of exposures outstanding at close of business and therefore does not necessarily reflect intra-day exposures; and VaR is unlikely to reflect loss potential on exposures that only arise under significant market movements. As set out above, stress testing is performed on portfolios on a weekly basis to estimate the impact of extreme market movements. Stress testing is performed on individual portfolios, as well as on aggregations of portfolios and businesses, as appropriate. It is the responsibility of independent market risk management, in conjunction with the businesses, to develop stress scenarios, review the output of periodic stress testing exercises, and use the information to make judgments concerning the on-going suitability of exposure levels and limits. The following table summarises market risk by disclosing the Company’s average VaR during the reporting period, together with the VaR as at 31 December, broken down into component Value at Risk (CVaR). CVaR represents the correlation or diversification adjusted standalone VaR contribution from a particular sub-portfolio to the total VaR: 2014 $ Million Foreign Equity Interest Overall exchange Commodity risk rate risk risk VaR risk Credit Risk Average As at 31 December Peak Average As at 31 December 9.7 6.3 24.2 20.1 9.9 32.3 Equity risk Interest rate risk 8.7 6.1 17.4 17.3 1.9 3.4 6.8 0.9 1.9 6.9 4.2 8.0 8.8 36.8 29.5 53.0 2013 $ Million Foreign exchange Commodity risk risk Credit Risk Overall VaR 4.7 0.8 55 2.5 0.5 2.5 5.5 35.8 30.1 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk The Company defines Liquidity risk as the risk that the Company will not be able to meet efficiently both expected and unexpected current and future cash flow and collateral needs without adversely affecting either daily operations or the financial condition of the Company. The Company’s funding and liquidity objectives aim to maintain liquidity, to fund the existing asset base and grow the core business, while at the same time conserving sufficient excess liquidity, structured appropriately, to continue operating under a wide variety of market conditions, including both short and long-term market disruptions. The UK forum for liquidity management is the UK Asset/Liability Management Committee (UK ALCO), which includes senior executives from within the Company and is chaired by the Chief Country Officer. This forum is composed of the UK CFO, EMEA CFO, UK legal entity Risk Manager, UK Treasurer, EMEA Regional Treasurer, the Financing Desk Heads and key business representatives. The UK ALCO reviews the current and prospective funding requirements of the Company, as well as its capital position and balance sheet. A liquidity plan is prepared annually and the liquidity profile is monitored on an on-going basis and reported daily. Liquidity risk is monitored using various ratios and limits in accordance with the Liquidity Risk Management Policy for Citi. The funding and liquidity plan includes analysis of the balance sheet as well as of the economic and business conditions impacting the major operating subsidiaries in the UK. As part of the funding and liquidity plan, liquidity limits, liquidity ratios and assumptions for periodic stress tests are reviewed and approved. In order to meet its liquidity stress testing requirements and liquidity ratio hurdles, the Company holds a pool of liquid assets including highly liquid government bonds. Stress testing and scenario analyses are intended to quantify the potential impact of a liquidity event on the Company’s balance sheet and liquidity position, and to identify viable funding alternatives that can be utilised. These scenarios include potential significant changes in key funding sources, market triggers (such as credit rating downgrades), uses of funding, and political and economic conditions, including standard and stressed market conditions as well as firm-specific events. Some tests span liquidity events over a full year while others may cover a more intense shock over a shorter period such as one month. These potential liquidity events can identify potential mismatches between liquidity sources and uses over a variety of time horizons, and liquidity limits are set accordingly. To monitor the liquidity of a unit, these stress tests and potential mismatches may be calculated with varying frequencies, with several important tests performed daily. Given the range of potential stresses, Citi maintains a series of contingency funding plans on a consolidated basis as well as for individual entities, including the Company. The plans specify a wide range of readily available actions under a variety of adverse market conditions or idiosyncratic disruptions. 56 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) The following table assigns the Company’s assets and liabilities to relevant maturity groupings based on the remaining period from the balance sheet date to the contractual maturity date. Note that in managing liquidity risk, management uses certain assumptions based on a combination of contractual and behavioural maturity profiles which differ from the contractual maturity dates shown below. Total $ Million On demand $ Million Cash Current asset investments Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments 1,571 45,133 203,894 111 45,133 203,894 1,460 - 93,054 28,220 11,482 9,459 281 40 Total financial assets 31 December 2014 Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Total financial liabilities Net liquidity gap Cumulative liquidity gap 3 months & less 3 - 12 months $ Million $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million - - - 61,287 2,820 264 463 - 11,482 9,459 281 - - - 40 364,914 277,358 83,969 2,820 264 Total $ Million On demand $ Million 3 months & less 3 - 12 months $ Million $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million 503 More than 5 years $ Million 10,104 1,310 3,922 841 2,675 1,356 79,218 19,617 51,282 7,252 1,067 - 203,375 15,404 203,375 15,404 - - - 32,754 - 32,754 - - - 6,276 1,043 4,080 - 6,154 1,043 - - 122 - 4,080 352,254 224,302 110,559 8,093 3,864 5,436 53,056 (26,590) (5,273) (3,600) (4,933) 53,056 26,466 21,193 17,593 12,660 12,660 57 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) 31 December 2013 Cash Current asset investments Derivatives Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments Total financial assets Bank loans and overdrafts Collateralised financing transactions Derivatives Cash collateral held Securities sold but not yet purchased Trade creditors Other creditors and accruals Subordinated loans Total financial liabilities Net liquidity gap Cumulative liquidity gap Total $ Million On demand $ Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million 2,805 41,926 77,648 1,367 41,926 77,648 1,438 - - - - 98,874 30,715 64,857 1,113 1,078 1,111 4,650 7,930 130 50 - 4,650 7,930 130 - - - 50 234,013 151,656 79,005 1,113 1,078 1,161 Total $ Million On demand $ Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million 5,881 1,090 617 1,087 3,087 - 87,474 23,179 55,111 8,818 366 - 79,999 7,457 79,999 7,457 - - - 29,429 - 29,429 - - - 5,781 1,214 4,200 - 5,621 1,214 - - 160 - 4,200 221,435 104,268 99,449 9,905 3,613 4,200 47,388 (20,444) (8,792) (2,535) (3,039) 47,388 26,944 18,152 15,617 12,578 12,578 The table below assigns the Company’s liabilities to relevant maturity groupings based on the remaining contractual future undiscounted cash flows up to maturity. The amounts disclosed in the table are the contractual undiscounted cash flows, whereas the Company manages the liquidity risk based on a combination of contractual and behavioural maturity profiles. Derivatives are excluded from the table because they are not held for settlement over the period of contractual maturity. 58 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Liquidity risk (continued) 31 December 2014 Contractual value $ Million On demand $Million Subordinated loans 4,610 - 14 42 225 4,329 Total financial liabilities 4,610 - 14 42 225 4,329 On demand $Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 months & less $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 3 - 12 months $ Million 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million 31 December 2013 Contractual value $ Million Subordinated loans 5,401 - 43 129 686 4,543 Total financial liabilities 5,401 - 43 129 686 4,543 1 – 5 years $ Million More than 5 years $ Million Credit risk Credit risk is the potential for financial loss resulting from the failure of a borrower or counterparty to honour its financial or contractual obligations. Credit risk arises in many of the Company’s business activities, including: • • • • • sales and trading; derivatives; securities transactions; settlement; and when Citi acts as an intermediary on behalf of its clients and other third parties. Credit risk is captured in the Company’s defined risk appetite framework, which is supplemented by regular stress testing and monitoring of exposures, with monthly and quarterly reporting to the senior management and the Board of Directors respectively. The credit process is grounded in a series of fundamental policies, including: • • • • • joint business and independent risk management responsibility for managing credit risks; a single centre of control for each credit relationship to coordinate credit activities with that client; a requirement for a minimum of two authorised-credit-officer signatures on extensions of credit, one of which must be from a sponsoring credit officer in the business and the other from a credit officer in independent credit risk management; consistent risk rating standards, applicable to every Citi obligor and facility; consistent standards for credit origination documentation and remedial management; and portfolio limits to ensure diversification and maintain risk/capital alignment. The Company uses derivatives both as an end-user for asset/liability management and in its client businesses. The Company enters into derivatives principally to enable customers to transfer, modify or reduce their credit, equity, interest rate and other market risks. In addition, the Company uses derivatives, and other instruments, as an end user to manage the risks to which the Company is exposed. The Company’s credit exposure on derivatives and foreign exchange contracts is primarily to professional counterparties in the global financial sector, including banks, investment banks, hedge funds, insurance companies and asset management companies. 59 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Credit risk (continued) Wrong-way risk is an aggravated form of concentration risk and arises when there is a strong correlation between the counterparty’s probability of default and the mark-to-market value of the underlying transaction. Citi uses a range of procedures to monitor and control wrong-way risk, including requiring entities to obtain prior approval before undertaking wrong-way risk transactions outside pre-agreed guidelines. This is monitored at a Company level, and includes circulation of a monthly report that identifies CDS based, OTC or securities finance transactions (SFT) that generate specific wrong-way risk. Wrong-way risk is mitigated through the use of enforceable netting agreements and margining. The Company seeks to restrict its exposure to credit losses by entering into master netting arrangements with most counterparties with which it undertakes a significant volume of transactions. Master netting arrangements do not generally result in an offset of balance sheet assets and liabilities, as transactions are usually settled on a gross basis. However, the credit risk associated with favourable contracts is reduced by a master netting arrangement to the extent that if an event of default occurs, all amounts with the counterparty are terminated and settled on a net basis. Many of these arrangements also provide for the calling and posting of variation margin or collateral, further reducing the Company’s exposures. The internal measurement of exposure on each credit facility takes into account legally enforceable netting and margining arrangements – both in terms of current exposure and in terms of the simulated calculation of potential future exposure. Large exposure limit reports are circulated daily that show the Company’s exposure to various counterparty groupings as a proportion of its own funds. Regulations require that the Company does not exceed specified limits for its non trading book exposures. Within a certain percentage below the maximum permitted level, the Regulatory Reporting group conducts initial analysis and provides a breakdown of exposures to credit risk management. At or above the maximum permitted level, the credit risk management team takes action and escalates to the front office in order to reduce exposure to that counterparty and thereby bring exposure back within permitted levels. Similar reporting is carried out against internal limits for the trading book exposures. The following table presents the maximum exposure to credit risk, before taking account of any collateral held or other credit enhancements (where such credit enhancements do not meet offsetting requirements). 31 December 2014 Cash Current asset investments Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments 31 December 2013 Cash Current asset investments Collateralised financing transactions Cash collateral pledged Trade debtors Other debtors Fixed asset investments 60 Maximum exposure $ Million 1,571 249,027 93,054 11,482 9,459 281 40 Offset $ Million (205,145) (11,552) - Exposure to credit risk (net) $ Million 1,571 43,882 81,502 11,482 9,459 281 40 364,914 (216,697) 148,217 Maximum exposure $ Million 2,805 119,574 98,874 4,650 7,930 130 50 Offset $ Million (67,170) (17,622) - Exposure to credit risk (net) $ Million 2,805 52,404 81,252 4,650 7,930 130 50 234,013 (84,792) 149,221 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Credit risk (continued) The current asset investments offset amount in the above table relates to exposures where the counterparty has an offsetting derivative exposure with the Company and a master netting agreement is in place. These amounts do not qualify for net presentation for accounting purposes as settlement may not actually be made on a net basis. The collateralised financing transactions offset adjustment relates to balances arising from repo and reverse repo transactions. The offsets relate to balances where there is a legally enforceable right of offset in the event of counterparty default and consequently a net exposure for credit risk management purposes. However as there is no intention to settle individual transactions on a net basis under normal circumstances, they do not qualify for net presentation for accounting purposes. Credit risk exposure is monitored on an asset basis except for positions which are specifically collateralised, normally in the form of cash. As at 31 December the Company’s third party credit exposure (mark to market plus potential future exposure as determined by the Company’s internal measure) in relation to collateralised financing transactions and derivatives was distributed as follows (these exposures do not include derivative and collateralised financing transactions with other group undertakings): Industry 2014 % 2013 % 37.4 29.4 5.9 27.3 45.6 16.2 5.0 33.2 100 100 Commercial and universal banks Insurance and fund management Brokers and investment banks Other (including Corporates, SPVs and Hedge Funds) The credit quality of the Company’s financial assets is maintained by adherence to Citi policies on the provision of credit to counterparties. The Company monitors the credit ratings of its counterparties with the table below presenting an analysis of the Company's current asset investments and derivative transactions by rating agency designation based on Standard & Poor, Moody’s and Fitch ratings as at 31 December: Government bonds 2013 2014 Eurobonds and corporate bonds 2014 2013 Derivatives 2014 2013 % % % % % % AAA / AA / A 54.0 57.7 81.0 74.7 47.6 76.9 BBB 32.0 36.8 8.0 12.1 3.9 1.8 BB / B 14.0 5.0 7.0 - - 1.0 0.5 - 0.9 CCC or below 8.8 1.6 Central counterparty clearing house (unrated) - - - - 26.8 - Unrated - 0.5 3.0 2.9 21.2 20.4 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 - As discussed above the maximum credit risk is mitigated through the use of collateral, netting arrangements and the application of credit limits. 61 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Country Risk Country risk is the risk that an event in a country (precipitated by developments within or external to that country) will impair the value of Citi’s franchise or will adversely affect the ability of obligors within that country to honour their obligations to Citi. Country risk events may include sovereign defaults, banking defaults or crises, currency crises and/or political events. The information below is based on Citi’s internal risk management measures. The country designation in Citi’s risk management systems is based on the country to which the client relationship, taken as a whole, is most directly exposed with regard to economic, financial, socio-political or legal risks. This includes exposure to subsidiaries within the client relationship that are domiciled outside of the country. Citi assesses the risk of loss associated with certain of the country exposures on a regular basis. These analyses take into consideration alternative scenarios that may unfold, as well as specific characteristics of the Company’s portfolio, such as transaction structure and collateral. The Company currently believes that the risk of loss associated with the exposures set forth below is likely to be materially lower than the exposure amounts disclosed below and is sized appropriately relative to its operations in these countries. The sovereign entities of all the countries disclosed below, as well as the financial institutions and corporations domiciled in these countries, are important clients both to the Company and to the global Citi franchise. Citi fully expects to maintain its presence in these markets to service all of its global customers. Hence the Company’s exposure in these countries may vary over time, based upon its franchise, client needs and transaction structures. The economic and fiscal situations of several European countries remain fragile, and geopolitical tensions throughout the region, including in Russia, have added to the uncertainties. Fiscal and monetary actions, or expected actions, throughout the region have further impacted the global financial markets. While concerns relating to sovereign defaults or a partial or complete break-up of the European Monetary Union (EMU), including potential accompanying redenomination risks and uncertainties, seemed to have abated during 2014, such concerns have resurfaced with the election of a new government in Greece in January 2015. The table below outlines the Group’s exposures to these countries as of 31 December: 2014 $ Millions Greece Ireland Italy Portugal Spain Russia Total - 125 282 8 14 44 473 Net trading exposure 45 162 1,308 356 1,502 (2) 3,371 Net current funded exposure 45 287 1,590 364 1,516 42 3,844 Net current funded credit exposure Net current funded credit exposure: Sovereigns - - 177 - - 20 197 Financial institutions - 125 101 - 5 24 255 Corporations - - 5 7 8 - 20 Total net current funded credit exposure - 125 283 7 13 44 472 2013 $ Millions Greece Ireland 1 39 177 Net trading exposure 104 372 Net current funded exposure 105 Sovereigns Spain Total - 5 222 1,278 86 2,282 4,122 411 1,455 86 2,287 4,344 - - 149 - - 149 Financial institutions 1 39 24 - 3 67 Corporations - - 4 - 2 6 Total net current funded credit exposure 1 39 177 - 5 221 Net current funded credit exposure Italy Portugal Net current funded credit exposure: 62 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Country Risk (continued) The exposures detailed above represent nominal levels of exposure without taking account of the benefit of any collateral, but including the benefits of margin and credit protection. The net trading exposures are marked to market daily, and levels of exposure vary as the positions are maintained consistent with customer needs. As discussed above, the Company’s net exposure is significantly lower than shown in this table. Operational risk (unaudited) Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, systems or human factors, or from external events. It includes the reputation and franchise risk associated with business practices or market conduct in which Citi is involved. Operational risk is inherent in the Company’s global business activities, as well as its internal processes that support those business activities, and can result in losses arising from events related to the following, among others: • • • • • fraud, theft and unauthorised activities; employment practices and workplace environment; clients, products and business practices; physical assets and infrastructure; and execution, delivery and process management. Where applicable, losses stemming from fines and regulatory penalties are included in the relevant categories above, which are consistent with the Basel framework. Framework Citi’s global operational risk is managed through an overall framework designed to balance strong corporate oversight with well-defined independent risk management. This framework includes: • • • recognised ownership of the risk by the businesses; oversight by Citi’s independent risk management and control functions; and independent assessment by Citi’s Internal Audit function. The goal is to keep operational risk at appropriate levels relative to the characteristics of the Company’s businesses, the markets in which it operates, its capital and liquidity, and the competitive, economic and regulatory environment. To anticipate, mitigate and control operational risk, Citi maintains a system of policies and has established a consistent framework for monitoring, assessing and communicating operational risks and the overall effectiveness of the internal control environment across Citi. As part of this framework, Citi has established a MCA programme to help managers self-assess key operational risks and controls and identify and address weaknesses in the design and/or effectiveness of internal controls that mitigate significant operational risks. MCAs are in place for all the major business lines and control areas impacting the Company. As noted above, each major business segment must implement an operational risk process consistent with the requirements of this framework. The process for operational risk management includes the following steps: • identify and assess key operational risks; • design controls to mitigate identified risks; • establish key risk and control indicators; • implement a process for early problem recognition and timely escalation; • produce a comprehensive operational risk report; and • ensure that sufficient resources are available actively to improve the operational risk environment and mitigate emerging risks. As new products and business activities are developed, processes are designed, modified or sourced through alternative means and operational risks are considered. 63 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Operational risk (continued) Framework (continued) In addition, Operational Risk Management, within Citi’s Franchise Risk and Strategy group, proactively assists the businesses, operations and technology and the other independent control groups in enhancing the effectiveness of controls and managing operational risks across products, business lines and regions, and facilitates the management of operational risk at a Citi and Company level. Operational risk is part of the Company’s defined risk appetite framework supplemented with regular reporting and updates to the senior management and the Board of Directors. Measurement To support advanced capital modelling and management, each business is required to capture relevant operational risk event information. An enhanced version of the Citi risk capital model for operational risk has been developed and applied across the major business segments. The PRA has approved this model, including the associated capital allocation, for use within the Company as an “Advanced Measurement Approach”. It uses a combination of internal and external loss data to support statistical modelling of capital requirement estimates, which are then adjusted to incorporate qualitative aspects of the operational risk and control environment. To enhance its operational risk management the Company has implemented a forward looking scenario analysis to identify and quantify emerging operational risks, through a systematic process of obtaining opinions from business managers and risk management experts to devise reasoned assessments of the likelihood and loss impact of plausible, high severity operational risk losses. This development has been integrated into the operational risk capital assessment for the Company. Anti Money Laundering and Sanctions Local and international Anti-Money Laundering (AML) and Sanctions requirements impact the activities carried out by the Company and its clients. The development of Sectoral Sanctions to address the political situation in Ukraine may restrict the Company’s ability to act for certain clients with respect to advisory services connected to longer term lending and capital raising activities by those clients. To facilitate Citi’s overall compliance with these requirements, including recent and upcoming changes, Citi has developed an enhanced control infrastructure around activities that may be affected by applicable Sanctions regimes. Regulatory requirements concerning AML controls may continue to cause elevated costs to the Company, particularly those associated with customer due diligence and suspicious activity monitoring, as Citi continues to implement enhancements in these programme areas. Conduct Risk Conduct risk is the risk that Citi’s employees or agents may – intentionally or through negligence – harm customers, clients, or the integrity of the markets, and thereby the integrity of the firm. Conduct risk is not limited to specific businesses or functions, but rather spans all conduct and behaviour at the firm. Consistent with Citi’s commitment to elevate the focus on conduct risks, Citi has continued to enhance the MCA process to enrich conduct risk considerations. In 2014, Citi proactively established a global Conduct Risk Program which is designed to identify, manage, minimize and mitigate Citi’s exposure to conduct risk and resulted in issuance of a Citi-wide Conduct Risk Policy. The Conduct Risk Policy describes framework through which Citi manages, minimizes, and mitigates its significant conduct risks, and the responsibilities of each of the three lines of defence for complying with the policy. 64 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Operational risk (continued) Client Assets Sourcebook (CASS) The FCA’s Client Assets Sourcebook (CASS) sets out the requirements with which firms must comply when holding or controlling client assets (client money and safe custody assets). Due to recent market activity and high profile insolvencies the FCA has published changes to its CASS rules, which all firms are expected to implement and be fully compliant with by 1 June 2015. The UK rules are designed to help ensure that clients’ assets are protected and returned to clients within a reasonable timeframe in the event of a firm’s failure and that the UK market is regarded as a safe place to conduct business. The rules also prescribe requirements for organisational arrangements, controls and governance. In line with this, Citi has a CASS Oversight Officer and continues to develop CASS governance arrangements and is working towards the implementation of the new CASS rules coming into force on 1 June 2015, which may result in elevated costs to the Company. Outsourcing Risk Third parties with which Citi does business may also be sources of cybersecurity or other technological risks. Citi outsources certain functions, such as uploading content on customer-facing websites, and developing software for new products and services. These relationships allow for the storage and processing of customer information by third-party hosting of or access to Citi websites, which could result in service disruptions or website defacements, and the potential to introduce vulnerable code, resulting in security breaches impacting Citi customers. While Citi engages in certain actions to reduce the exposure resulting from outsourcing, such as performing onsite security control assessments, limiting third-party access to the least privileged level necessary to perform job functions and restricting third-party processing to systems stored within Citi’s data centres, ongoing threats may result in unauthorized access, loss or destruction of data or other cyber incidents with increased costs and consequences to Citi such as those discussed above. Furthermore, because financial institutions are becoming increasingly interconnected with central agents, exchanges and clearing houses, partly because of the derivatives reforms over the last few years, Citi has increased exposure to operational failure or cyber attacks through third parties. Regulatory risk and developments Regulatory risk is the risk of failing to comply with regulatory requirements, regulatory change or regulators’ expectations. Failing to manage regulatory risk properly may result in regulatory sanctions and increased reputational and franchise risk. As the regulatory environment continues to evolve, Citi and the Company remain committed to implementing new regulations and to ensuring continuous compliance with forthcoming regulatory requirements. The most significant developments assessed by the Company are: • • • • • Capital Requirements Directive (CRD IV) Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (BRRD) Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank Act) European Market Infrastructure Regulation (EMIR) Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID) and Regulation on Markets in Financial Instruments (MiFIR) Implementation of CRD IV The EU CRD IV legislative package includes the Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR) and the Capital Requirements Directive (CRD) as approved by the European Parliament on 16 April 2013 and is directly applicable to banks and financial firms which are prudentially regulated in the United Kingdom. It became effective on 1 January 2014 and has introduced significant quantitative and qualitative changes to capital adequacy and the related governance processes throughout the financial sector in the European Union. The quantitative implications of this include higher capital requirements associated with counterparty credit risk and the introduction of additional capital buffers to cover cyclical and systemic risks as well as capital conservation concerns. A number of these requirements will be introduced on a phased basis between 2015 and 2019. There 65 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Regulatory risk and developments (continued) are also qualitative implications, such as more reliance on higher quality capital and expectations of improved risk management processes. Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive There is an increased focus from local regulators on ensuring that subsidiaries and branches of large international financial services companies are adequately capitalised and managed locally, such that in the event of a local market disruption they would be able to sustain their business and cover any losses incurred without an exaggerated reliance on offshore parental financial aid. As of 1 January 2015 all EU Member States have to apply a single rulebook for the resolution of banks and large investment firms, as prescribed by the BRRD, designed to harmonise and improve the tools for dealing with bank crises across the EU. Additionally, the Company has been identified as a Material Legal Entity in Citi’s Resolution Plan. Citi defines Material Legal Entities as those legal entities, including subsidiaries and foreign offices, with business lines, including associated operations, services, functions and support that upon failure would result in a material loss of revenue, profit or franchise value of Citi. Citi’s Resolution Plan can be found at : http://www.federalreserve.gov/bankinforeg/resolution-plans.htm. Dodd Frank Act The Dodd–Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and the Wall Street Transparency and Accountability Act (together commonly referred to as the Dodd-Frank Act) introduced an array of new regulations in respect of over-the-counter derivatives (swaps), and the activities of major institutions transacting in these products. These included registration and regulatory requirements for swap dealers, an enhanced risk management framework, segregation of initial margin for uncleared swaps, business conduct rules applicable when transacting swaps with certain types of counterparties, and rules on mandatory clearing and trade execution of certain swaps. Financial intermediaries that transact above certain thresholds with U.S. counterparties (or counterparties with US originated guarantees) were required to register with the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC). The directors and senior management of the Company accordingly elected to register the Company as a Swap Dealer, and the Company was provisionally registered by the CFTC as a non-US Swap Dealer in October 2013. A consequence of registering as a Swap Dealer is increased regulatory oversight by the CFTC and enhanced compliance obligations. 2014 represented the first full year of the Company operating as a CFTC-registered nonUS Swap Dealer for purposes of the Dodd-Frank Act. In December 2013 the CFTC granted limited relief from certain requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act for EUbased Swap Dealers, to the extent that Swap Dealers comply with comparable regulatory obligations under European law. The Company has elected to take advantage of certain elements of this relief. Whilst this CFTC relief has, to some extent, reduced the compliance burden of the Dodd-Frank Act upon the Company, it continues to be subject to significant aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act. A governance structure has therefore been implemented to assist the Board of Directors in overseeing ongoing compliance with the Company’s regulatory obligations under the Dodd-Frank Act. This includes the establishment of a Swap Dealer Governing Body (constituted by the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and senior representatives of the Business, Compliance, Risk, Finance, Legal, and Operations & Technology) and various sub-committees. The Chief Executive Officer and EMEA Chief Administrative Officer are responsible for updating the Company’s Board of Directors on a regular basis as to the Company’s compliance with the Dodd-Frank Act and any material breaches thereof. Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company’s Head of Compliance and CF10 Compliance Oversight Officer also produces an annual report addressed to the Chief Executive Officer, outlining the Company’s compliance with certain matters prescribed under the Dodd-Frank Act. EMIR Similarly to the Dodd-Frank Act in the US, the EU’s EMIR regulation introduces mandatory central clearing of transactions with certain counterparties that will impact the Company, with potential liquidity, expense and capital considerations. The regulation requires all counterparties to report details of contracts to an authorised trade repository (TR) and to comply with certain risk mitigation requirements for non-cleared derivatives. Exposure to Central Counterparty Clearing Houses (CCPs) will need to be carefully monitored and managed as any other 66 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Regulatory risk and developments (continued) relationship within the Company’s credit risk management framework. Final rules for client clearing of OTC derivatives and the implications of mandatory margin requirements for derivatives not cleared will continue to be closely monitored, as will the rules for intragroup trades with EU and non-EU affiliates. The Company is currently engaged in system developments to ensure implementation readiness once the final phases of the regulation come into effect. Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (MiFID) and Regulation on Markets in Financial Instruments (MiFIR) The new rules relating to MiFID II/MiFIR will start to apply to firms early in 2017. The MiFID II/MiFIR reforms will have a significant impact on a number of areas including market structure, transparency requirements, transaction reporting, algorithmic trading, commodities, the third country regime, investment research and supervision. Some key aspects of MiFID II/MiFIR include the introduction of a new multilateral, discretionary trading venue for non-equity instruments, the Organised Trading Facility (OTF), and an extension of the Systematic Internaliser (SI) regime to non-equity instruments. There will also be a requirement for investment firms to trade listed equities on a Regulated Market, Multilateral Trading Facility, OTF or SI. There are new systems and controls requirements for organised trading venues, trading controls for algorithmic trading activities, an obligation to trade clearable derivatives on organised trading platforms and the introduction of a harmonised EU regime for access to trading venues, CCPs and benchmarks. MiFID II/MiFIR will also cover structured deposits and commodities. The scope of transaction reporting obligations will be widened. There will additionally be an increase in the transparency requirements for the equities market and new transparency requirements for fixed income instruments and derivatives, with additional requirements including the submission of post-trade data to Authorised Reporting Mechanisms. There are increased conduct of business requirements aimed at increasing investor protection, including rules relating to inducements and the provision of investment research. Strengthened supervisory powers and administrative sanctions will also apply. Capital management The Company’s regulatory capital is held to ensure that sufficient loss-absorbing capital is available to meet unexpected losses and to meet minimum capital standards as set by the PRA. The composition and amount of capital takes full account of the regulations in force, including the recently implemented CRD IV package. Capital forecasts are prepared taking into account strategic growth plans, as set out in the Company’s Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) document. Capital forecasts are updated and reviewed monthly through the UK ALCO and the Company’s Basel Governance Oversight Committee. The Company’s capital adequacy position is managed and monitored in accordance with the prudential requirements of the PRA. The Company must at all times meet the applicable minimum capital requirements of the PRA. The Company has established processes and controls to monitor and manage its capital adequacy position, and has remained in compliance with these requirements throughout the year. The Company maintains an internal capital buffer in excess of the PRA’s minimum regulatory capital requirements. Regulatory capital (unaudited) Under the PRA’s minimum capital standards, the Company is required to maintain a prescribed excess of total capital resources over its capital requirements. For this purpose the Company calculates capital requirements for market risk, credit risk, concentration risk and operational risk based upon a number of internal models and recognises a number of credit risk mitigation techniques. The Company’s regulatory capital resources comprise two distinct elements: • • Tier 1 capital, which includes ordinary share capital, retained earnings and capital reserves; Tier 2 capital, which includes qualifying long-term subordinated liabilities. Various limits are applied to the Tier 2 element of the capital base. In particular, qualifying long-term subordinated loan capital may not exceed 75 per cent of Tier 1 capital. In addition, the CRR requires a number of 67 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 28 Financial instruments and risk management (continued) Regulatory capital (continued) deductions from Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) capital. These include intangible assets, certain deferred tax balances and, above certain thresholds, capital instruments issued by financial sector entities. Tier 3 capital, which included qualifying short-term subordinated liabilities, ceased to qualify as eligible capital from 1 January 2014 under the CRR. At 31 December 2013 Tier 3 capital comprised the unaudited loss for the year. The increase in capital deductions in 2014 was primarily driven by the deduction of holdings in other financial sector entities. The Company’s policy is to maintain a sufficient capital base in order to retain investor, counterparty, creditor and market confidence and to sustain the future development of the business. The impact of the level of capital on shareholders’ returns is also recognised, alongside the need to maintain a balance between the higher returns that might be possible with greater gearing and the advantages and security afforded by a sound capital position. The Company’s regulatory capital resources at 31 December were as follows: 2014 $ Million 2013 $ Million Tier 1 capital Tier 2 capital Tier 3 capital Deductions 12,754 4,080 (871) 12,794 4,086 (234) (265) Total regulatory capital resources 15,963 16,381 Under CRD IV’s framework of capital adequacy regulation, Pillar III mandates enhanced public disclosures in respect of capital, risk profile and remuneration. Further details on the Company’s Pillar III regulatory capital disclosures can be found at: http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/reg.htm 29. Other commitments a) Letters of credit As at 31 December 2014, the Company had $14 million (2013: $17 million) of unsecured letters of credit outstanding from banks to satisfy collateral requirements under securities borrowing agreements and margin requirements. b) Capital commitments As at 31 December 2014, the Company had no capital commitments (2013: $nil). 30. Registered charges The Company has granted to various banks and other entities a number of fixed and floating charges over certain holdings in securities, properties, collateral and monies held by or on behalf of such banks or other entities. 68 CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 31. Group structure The Company’s immediate parent undertaking is CGMEL, a company registered in England and Wales. The Company’s ultimate parent company and ultimate controlling party is Citigroup Inc, incorporated in the State of Delaware, United States of America. The audited consolidated financial statements of CGMEL are made available to the public annually in accordance with Companies House regulations and may be obtained from its registered office at Citigroup Centre, Canada Square, Canary Wharf, London E14 5LB. The audited consolidated financial statements of Citigroup Inc are made available to the public annually in accordance with Securities and Exchange Commission regulations and may be obtained from http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/overview.html 32. Segmental analysis As outlined in the Strategic Report, the Company is Citi’s international broker dealer and management reviews its performance by geography in the same way as Citigroup Inc. report its performance. It is organised into four regions, Asia Pacific, EMEA, Latin America and North America. Asia EMEA Latin America North America Total Regional Other / Corp Total $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million $ Million 2014 Revenues 192 1,439 15 63 1,709 1,352 3,061 2013 Revenues 258 1,711 (4) 95 2,060 743 2,803 Increase (decrease) compared to prior year (66) (272) 19 (32) (351) 609 258 Revenue by Region Asia EMEA Latin America North America Total Regional Other / Corp Total $ Billion $ Billion $ Billion $ Billion $ Billion $ Billion $ Billion 2014 Assets 34 295 2 34 365 - 365 2013 Assets 21 186 3 24 234 - 234 Increase (decrease) compared to prior year 13 109 (1) 10 131 - 131 Assets by Region * Other / Corporate items relate to Intercompany Revenues as mentioned in the Strategic Report. 33. Country by country reporting The information relating to Country-by-Country reporting, required by Article 89 of Directive 2013/36/EU (Capital Requirements Directive), will be published at http://www.citigroup.com/citi/investor/reg.htm. 69 SUBSCRIPTION AND SALE AND TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS The transfer restrictions under the heading “United States of America” set out in the section of the Base Prospectus entitled “Subscription and Sale and Transfer Restrictions” shall apply, subject to the amendments set out below: 1 The first paragraph shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “The Notes have not been and will not be registered under the Securities Act, no person has registered nor will register as a commodity pool operator of the Issuer under the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act of 1936, as amended (the “CEA”) and the rules of the U.S. Commodities Futures Trading Commission thereunder, and the Notes may not at any time be offered or sold, or, in the case of Bearer Notes, delivered, within the United States or to, or for the account or benefit of, any person who is (i) a U.S. person (as such term is defined under Rule 902(k)(1) of Regulation S), (ii) not a Non-United States person (as defined in Rule 4.7 under the CEA, but excluding, for the purposes of subsection (D) thereof, the exception to the extent that it would apply to persons who are not Non-United States persons (“CFTC Rule 4.7”)) or (iii) a U.S. person (as defined in the credit risk retention regulations issued under Section 15G of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934) (any person who is (i) not a U.S. person (as such term is defined under Rule 902(k)(1) of Regulation S), (ii) a Non-United States person (as such term is defined under CFTC Rule 4.7) and (iii) not a U.S. person (as defined in the credit risk retention regulations issued under Section 15G of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934), a “Permitted Purchaser”). Terms used in this section and not otherwise defined have the meanings given to them by Regulation S.” 2 Sub-paragraph (c) of the fourth paragraph shall be deleted and replaced with the following: “(c) 3 (i) it is (x) not a U.S. person (as such term is defined under Rule 902(k)(1) of Regulation S) and it is located outside the United States (within the meaning of Regulation S), (y) a Non-United States person (as such term is defined under CFTC Rule 4.7) and (z) not a U.S. person (as defined in the credit risk retention regulations issued under Section 15G of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934) (any person who satisfies the conditions set forth in the immediately preceding clauses (x), (y) and (z), a “Permitted Purchaser”), (ii) it is not an affiliate of the Issuer or a person acting on behalf of such an affiliate and (iii) if it is acting for the account or benefit of another person, such other person is also a Permitted Purchaser;” Sub-paragraph (h)(1) of the fourth paragraph shall be deleted and replaced with the following: (1) REPRESENTS THAT (A) IT ACQUIRED THIS NOTE OR SUCH BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION (AS SUCH TERM IS DEFINED UNDER REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT (“REGULATION S”)); (B) IT IS (X) NOT A U.S. PERSON (AS SUCH TERM IS DEFINED UNDER RULE 902(K)(1) OF REGULATION S), (Y) A NON-UNITED STATES PERSON (AS SUCH TERM IS DEFINED IN RULE 4.7 UNDER THE U.S. COMMODITY EXCHANGE ACT OF 1936, BUT EXCLUDING, FOR THE PURPOSES OF SUBSECTION (D) THEREOF, THE EXCEPTION TO THE EXTENT THAT IT WOULD APPLY TO PERSONS WHO ARE NOT NON-UNITED STATES PERSONS) AND (Z) NOT A U.S. PERSON (AS DEFINED IN THE CREDIT RISK RETENTION REGULATIONS ISSUED UNDER SECTION 15G OF THE U.S. 77 SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934) (ANY PERSON SATISFYING (X), (Y) AND (Z) IMMEDIATELY ABOVE, A “PERMITTED PURCHASER”); AND (C) IF IT IS ACQUIRING THIS NOTE OR A BENEFICIAL INTEREST HEREIN FOR THE ACCOUNT OR BENEFIT OF ANOTHER PERSON, SUCH OTHER PERSON IS ALSO A PERMITTED PURCHASER;” 78 GENERAL INFORMATION 1. From the date of this Series Prospectus and for so long as the Notes remain outstanding, the following documents will be available for inspection in physical format during usual business hours on any weekday (Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays excepted) at the office of the Issuing and Paying Agent: (a) this Series Prospectus; (b) the Supplemental Trust Deed in relation to the Notes; and (c) the audited financial statements of the Issuer in respect of its financial years ending 31 December 2014 and 31 December 2015. 2. The issue of the Notes was authorised by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the Issuer passed on 8 May 2017. 3. There has been no material adverse change in the financial position or prospects of the Issuer since 31 December 2015 (such date being the date of the Issuer’s latest audited financial statements) which is material or significant. 4. The Issuer has not been involved in any litigation, arbitration or governmental proceedings (including such proceedings which are pending or threatened or of which the Issuer is aware during the 12 months preceding the date of this Series Prospectus) which may have or have had in the recent past, significant effects on the financial position or profitability of the Issuer. 5. The Issuer does not intend to provide any post issuance transactional information on the Notes or the Initial Collateral (as described in the Terms and Conditions above). 6. Arthur Cox Listing Services Limited has been appointed by the Issuer to act as its listing agent and as such is not seeking admission to listing of the Notes on the regulated market of the Irish Stock Exchange for the purposes of the Prospectus Directive on its own behalf, but as an agent on behalf of the Issuer. 7. References to any web or internet addresses in this document do not form part of this Series Prospectus for the purpose of its approval or the listing of the Notes. 79 REGISTERED OFFICE OF THE ISSUER 3rd Floor, Kilmore House Park Lane Spencer Dock Dublin 1 Ireland TRUSTEE Citicorp Trustee Company Limited Citigroup Centre Canada Square Canary Wharf London E14 5LB REGISTRAR Citigroup Global Markets Deutschland AG Reuterweg 16 60323 Frankfurt Germany ISSUING AND PAYING AGENT, TRANSFER AGENT, CALCULATION AGENT AND CUSTODIAN Citibank, N.A., London Branch Citigroup Centre Canada Square Canary Wharf London E14 5LB DEALER, CALCULATION AGENT, DISPOSAL AGENT AND SWAP COUNTERPARTY Citigroup Global Markets Limited Citigroup Centre Canada Square Canary Wharf London E14 5LB IRISH LISTING AGENT Arthur Cox Listing Services Limited Earlsfort Centre Earlsfort Terrace Dublin 2 Ireland LEGAL ADVISERS to the Issuer as to Irish law to the Arranger and Dealer as to English law A & L Goodbody International Financial Services Centre North Wall Quay Dublin 1 Ireland Linklaters LLP One Silk Street London EC2Y 8HQ United Kingdom 80 This Series Prospectus is hereby executed by or on behalf of the Issuer. EMERALD CAPITAL DESIGNATED ACTIVITY COMPANY By: Delegated Signatory 81